* NEWS: Add note on "info sharedlibrary".
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
178 how you can copy and share GDB
179 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
180 * Index:: Index
181 @end menu
182
183 @end ifnottex
184
185 @contents
186
187 @node Summary
188 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
189
190 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
191 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
192 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
193
194 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
195 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
196
197 @itemize @bullet
198 @item
199 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
200
201 @item
202 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
203
204 @item
205 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
206
207 @item
208 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
209 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
210 @end itemize
211
212 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
213 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
214 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
215
216 @cindex Modula-2
217 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
218 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
219
220 @cindex Pascal
221 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
222 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
223 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
224 syntax.
225
226 @cindex Fortran
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
228 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
229 underscore.
230
231 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
232 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
233
234 @menu
235 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
236 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
237 @end menu
238
239 @node Free Software
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software
241
242 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
243 General Public License
244 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
245 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
246 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
247 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
248 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
249 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
250
251 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
252 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
253 from anyone else.
254
255 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256
257 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
258 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
259 include with the free software. Many of our most important
260 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
261 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
262 when an important free software package does not come with a free
263 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
264 gaps today.
265
266 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
267 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
268 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
269 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
270 them from the free software world.
271
272 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
273 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
274 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
275 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
276 contract to make it non-free.
277
278 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
279 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
280 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
281 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
282 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
283 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
284 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
285
286 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
287 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
288 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
289 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
290
291 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
292 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
293 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
294 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
295 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
296 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
297 community.
298
299 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
300 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
301 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
302 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
303 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
304 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
305 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
306 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
307 of the manual.
308
309 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
310 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
311 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
312 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
313 manual to replace it.
314
315 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
316 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
317 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
318 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
319 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
320 the free software community.
321
322 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
323 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
324 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
325 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
326 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
327 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
328 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
329 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
330 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
331
332 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
333 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
334 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
335 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
336 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
337 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
338 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
339 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
340
341 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
342 published by other publishers, at
343 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
344
345 @node Contributors
346 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
347
348 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
349 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
350 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
351 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
352 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
353 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
354 blow-by-blow account.
355
356 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
357
358 @quotation
359 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
360 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
361 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
362 @end quotation
363
364 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
365 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
366 releases:
367 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
368 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
369 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
370 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
371 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
372 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
373 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
374 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
375 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
376
377 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
378 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
379
380 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
381 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
382 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
383 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
384 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
385
386 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
387 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
388 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
389
390 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
391 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
392
393 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
394
395 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
396 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
397 support.
398 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
399 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
400 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
401 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
402 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
403 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
404 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
405 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
406 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
407 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
408 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
409 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
410 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
411 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
412 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
413 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
414
415 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
416
417 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
418 libraries.
419
420 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
421 about several machine instruction sets.
422
423 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
424 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
425 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
426 and RDI targets, respectively.
427
428 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
429 command-line editing and command history.
430
431 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
432 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
433
434 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
435 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
436 symbols.
437
438 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
439 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
440
441 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
442
443 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
444 processors.
445
446 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
447
448 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
449
450 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
451
452 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
453 watchpoints.
454
455 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
456
457 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
458
459 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
460 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
461
462 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
463 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
464 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
465 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
466 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
467 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
468 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
469
470 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
471 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
472
473 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
474 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
475 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
476 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
477 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
478 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
479 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
480 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
481 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
482 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
483 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
484 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
485 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
486 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
487 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
488
489 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
490 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
491
492 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
493 Hat.
494
495 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
496 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
497 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
498 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
499 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
500 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
501
502 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
503 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
504 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
505 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
506 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
507 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
508 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
509 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
510 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
511 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
512 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
513 Weigand.
514
515 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
516 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
517 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
518 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
519
520 @node Sample Session
521 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
522
523 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
524 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
525 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
526
527 @iftex
528 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
529 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
530 @end iftex
531
532 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
533 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
534
535 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
536 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
537 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
538 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
539 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
540 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
541 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
542 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
543 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
544
545 @smallexample
546 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
547 $ @b{./m4}
548 @b{define(foo,0000)}
549
550 @b{foo}
551 0000
552 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
553
554 @b{bar}
555 0000
556 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
557
558 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
559 @b{baz}
560 @b{Ctrl-d}
561 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
562 @end smallexample
563
564 @noindent
565 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
566
567 @smallexample
568 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
569 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
570 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
571 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
572 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
573 the conditions.
574 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
575 for details.
576
577 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
578 (@value{GDBP})
579 @end smallexample
580
581 @noindent
582 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
583 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
584 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
585 that examples fit in this manual.
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
589 @end smallexample
590
591 @noindent
592 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
593 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
594 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
595 @code{break} command.
596
597 @smallexample
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
599 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
600 @end smallexample
601
602 @noindent
603 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
604 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
605 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
606
607 @smallexample
608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
609 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
610 @b{define(foo,0000)}
611
612 @b{foo}
613 0000
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
618 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
619 context where it stops.
620
621 @smallexample
622 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
623
624 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
625 at builtin.c:879
626 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
627 @end smallexample
628
629 @noindent
630 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
631 the next line of the current function.
632
633 @smallexample
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
635 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
636 : nil,
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
641 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
642 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
643 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
647 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
648 at input.c:530
649 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
650 @end smallexample
651
652 @noindent
653 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
654 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
655 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
656 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
657 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
658 stack frame for each active subroutine.
659
660 @smallexample
661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
662 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
663 at input.c:530
664 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:882
666 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
667 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
668 at macro.c:71
669 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
670 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
675 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
676 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
677
678 @smallexample
679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
680 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
682 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
683 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
686 : xstrdup(rq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
689 @end smallexample
690
691 @noindent
692 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
693 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
694 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
695 (@code{print}) to see their values.
696
697 @smallexample
698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
699 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
700 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
701 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
702 @end smallexample
703
704 @noindent
705 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
706 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
707 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
708
709 @smallexample
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
711 533 xfree(rquote);
712 534
713 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
714 : xstrdup (lq);
715 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
716 : xstrdup (rq);
717 537
718 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
719 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
720 540 @}
721 541
722 542 void
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
727 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
728
729 @smallexample
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
731 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
733 540 @}
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
735 $3 = 9
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
737 $4 = 7
738 @end smallexample
739
740 @noindent
741 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
742 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
743 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
744 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
745 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
746 assignments.
747
748 @smallexample
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
750 $5 = 7
751 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
752 $6 = 9
753 @end smallexample
754
755 @noindent
756 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
757 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
758 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
759 example that caused trouble initially:
760
761 @smallexample
762 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
763 Continuing.
764
765 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
766
767 baz
768 0000
769 @end smallexample
770
771 @noindent
772 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
773 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
774 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
775
776 @smallexample
777 @b{Ctrl-d}
778 Program exited normally.
779 @end smallexample
780
781 @noindent
782 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
783 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
784 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
785
786 @smallexample
787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
788 @end smallexample
789
790 @node Invocation
791 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
792
793 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
794 The essentials are:
795 @itemize @bullet
796 @item
797 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
798 @item
799 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
800 @end itemize
801
802 @menu
803 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
804 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
805 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
806 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
807 @end menu
808
809 @node Invoking GDB
810 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
811
812 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
813 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
814
815 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
816 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
817
818 The command-line options described here are designed
819 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
820 options may effectively be unavailable.
821
822 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
823 specifying an executable program:
824
825 @smallexample
826 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
827 @end smallexample
828
829 @noindent
830 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
831 specified:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
835 @end smallexample
836
837 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
838 to debug a running process:
839
840 @smallexample
841 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
842 @end smallexample
843
844 @noindent
845 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
846 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
847
848 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
849 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
850 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
851 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
852 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
853
854 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
855 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
856 option processing.
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
859 @end smallexample
860 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
861 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
862
863 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
864 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
865
866 @smallexample
867 @value{GDBP} -silent
868 @end smallexample
869
870 @noindent
871 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
872 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
873
874 @noindent
875 Type
876
877 @smallexample
878 @value{GDBP} -help
879 @end smallexample
880
881 @noindent
882 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
883 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
884
885 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
886 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
887 @samp{-x} option is used.
888
889
890 @menu
891 * File Options:: Choosing files
892 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
893 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
894 @end menu
895
896 @node File Options
897 @subsection Choosing Files
898
899 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
900 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
901 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
902 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
903 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
904 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
905 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
906 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
907 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
908 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
909 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
910 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
911 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
912
913 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
914 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
915 argument and ignore it.
916
917 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
918 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
919 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
920 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
921 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
922
923 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
924 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
925 @c it.
926
927 @table @code
928 @item -symbols @var{file}
929 @itemx -s @var{file}
930 @cindex @code{--symbols}
931 @cindex @code{-s}
932 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
933
934 @item -exec @var{file}
935 @itemx -e @var{file}
936 @cindex @code{--exec}
937 @cindex @code{-e}
938 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
939 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
940
941 @item -se @var{file}
942 @cindex @code{--se}
943 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
944 file.
945
946 @item -core @var{file}
947 @itemx -c @var{file}
948 @cindex @code{--core}
949 @cindex @code{-c}
950 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
951
952 @item -pid @var{number}
953 @itemx -p @var{number}
954 @cindex @code{--pid}
955 @cindex @code{-p}
956 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
957
958 @item -command @var{file}
959 @itemx -x @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--command}
961 @cindex @code{-x}
962 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
963 Files,, Command files}.
964
965 @item -eval-command @var{command}
966 @itemx -ex @var{command}
967 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
968 @cindex @code{-ex}
969 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
970
971 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
972 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
973
974 @smallexample
975 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
976 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
977 @end smallexample
978
979 @item -directory @var{directory}
980 @itemx -d @var{directory}
981 @cindex @code{--directory}
982 @cindex @code{-d}
983 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
984
985 @item -r
986 @itemx -readnow
987 @cindex @code{--readnow}
988 @cindex @code{-r}
989 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
990 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
991 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
992
993 @end table
994
995 @node Mode Options
996 @subsection Choosing Modes
997
998 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
999 batch mode or quiet mode.
1000
1001 @table @code
1002 @item -nx
1003 @itemx -n
1004 @cindex @code{--nx}
1005 @cindex @code{-n}
1006 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1007 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1008 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1009 Files}.
1010
1011 @item -quiet
1012 @itemx -silent
1013 @itemx -q
1014 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1015 @cindex @code{--silent}
1016 @cindex @code{-q}
1017 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1018 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1019
1020 @item -batch
1021 @cindex @code{--batch}
1022 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1023 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1024 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1025 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1026 in the command files.
1027
1028 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1029 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1030 make this more useful, the message
1031
1032 @smallexample
1033 Program exited normally.
1034 @end smallexample
1035
1036 @noindent
1037 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1038 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1039 mode.
1040
1041 @item -batch-silent
1042 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1043 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1044 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1045 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1046 for an interactive session.
1047
1048 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1049 messages, for example.
1050
1051 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1052 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1053
1054 @item -return-child-result
1055 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1056 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1057 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1058
1059 @itemize @bullet
1060 @item
1061 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1062 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1063 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1064 @item
1065 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1066 @item
1067 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1068 the exit code will be -1.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1072 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1073 interface.
1074
1075 @item -nowindows
1076 @itemx -nw
1077 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1078 @cindex @code{-nw}
1079 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1080 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1081 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1082
1083 @item -windows
1084 @itemx -w
1085 @cindex @code{--windows}
1086 @cindex @code{-w}
1087 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1088 used if possible.
1089
1090 @item -cd @var{directory}
1091 @cindex @code{--cd}
1092 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1093 instead of the current directory.
1094
1095 @item -fullname
1096 @itemx -f
1097 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1098 @cindex @code{-f}
1099 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1100 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1101 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1102 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1103 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1104 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1105 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1106 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1107 frame.
1108
1109 @item -epoch
1110 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1111 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1112 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1113 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1114 separate window.
1115
1116 @item -annotate @var{level}
1117 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1118 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1119 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1120 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1121 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1122 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1123 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1124 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1125 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1126
1127 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1128 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1129
1130 @item --args
1131 @cindex @code{--args}
1132 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1133 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1134 This option stops option processing.
1135
1136 @item -baud @var{bps}
1137 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1138 @cindex @code{--baud}
1139 @cindex @code{-b}
1140 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1141 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1142
1143 @item -l @var{timeout}
1144 @cindex @code{-l}
1145 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1146 for remote debugging.
1147
1148 @item -tty @var{device}
1149 @itemx -t @var{device}
1150 @cindex @code{--tty}
1151 @cindex @code{-t}
1152 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1153 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1154
1155 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1156 @item -tui
1157 @cindex @code{--tui}
1158 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1159 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1160 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1161 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1162 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1163 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1164 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1165
1166 @c @item -xdb
1167 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1168 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1169 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1170 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1171 @c systems.
1172
1173 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1174 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1175 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1176 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1177 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1178 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1179
1180 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1181 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1182 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1183 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1184 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1185 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1186
1187 @item -write
1188 @cindex @code{--write}
1189 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1190 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1191 (@pxref{Patching}).
1192
1193 @item -statistics
1194 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1195 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1196 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1197
1198 @item -version
1199 @cindex @code{--version}
1200 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1201 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1202
1203 @end table
1204
1205 @node Startup
1206 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1207 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1208
1209 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1210
1211 @enumerate
1212 @item
1213 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1214 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1215
1216 @item
1217 @cindex init file
1218 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1219 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1220 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1221 that file.
1222
1223 @item
1224 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1225 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1226 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1227 that file.
1228
1229 @item
1230 Processes command line options and operands.
1231
1232 @item
1233 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1234 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1235 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1236 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1237 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1238 @value{GDBN}.
1239
1240 @item
1241 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1242 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1243
1244 @item
1245 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1246 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1247 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1248 @end enumerate
1249
1250 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1251 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1252 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1253 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1254 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1255 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1256
1257 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1258 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1259
1260 @cindex init file name
1261 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1262 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1263 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1264 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1265 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1266 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1267 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1268 the file to the standard name.
1269
1270
1271 @node Quitting GDB
1272 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1273 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1274 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1275
1276 @table @code
1277 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1278 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1279 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1280 @itemx q
1281 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1282 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1283 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1284 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1285 error code.
1286 @end table
1287
1288 @cindex interrupt
1289 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1290 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1291 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1292 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1293 until a time when it is safe.
1294
1295 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1296 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1297 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1298
1299 @node Shell Commands
1300 @section Shell Commands
1301
1302 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1303 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1304 just use the @code{shell} command.
1305
1306 @table @code
1307 @kindex shell
1308 @cindex shell escape
1309 @item shell @var{command string}
1310 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1311 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1312 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1313 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1314 @end table
1315
1316 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1317 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1318 @value{GDBN}:
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex make
1322 @cindex calling make
1323 @item make @var{make-args}
1324 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1325 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1326 @end table
1327
1328 @node Logging Output
1329 @section Logging Output
1330 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1331 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1332
1333 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1334 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1335
1336 @table @code
1337 @kindex set logging
1338 @item set logging on
1339 Enable logging.
1340 @item set logging off
1341 Disable logging.
1342 @cindex logging file name
1343 @item set logging file @var{file}
1344 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1345 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1346 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1347 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1348 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1350 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1351 @kindex show logging
1352 @item show logging
1353 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1354 @end table
1355
1356 @node Commands
1357 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1358
1359 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1360 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1361 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1362 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1363 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1364
1365 @menu
1366 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1367 * Completion:: Command completion
1368 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1369 @end menu
1370
1371 @node Command Syntax
1372 @section Command Syntax
1373
1374 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1375 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1376 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1377 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1378 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1379 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1380
1381 @cindex abbreviation
1382 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1383 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1384 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1385 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1386 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1387 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1388 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1389
1390 @cindex repeating commands
1391 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1392 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1393 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1394 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1395 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1396 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1397 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1398
1399 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1400 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1401 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1402
1403 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1404 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1405 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1406 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1407 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1408
1409 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1410 @cindex comment
1411 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1412 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1413 Files,,Command Files}).
1414
1415 @cindex repeating command sequences
1416 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1417 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1418 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1419 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1420 for editing.
1421
1422 @node Completion
1423 @section Command Completion
1424
1425 @cindex completion
1426 @cindex word completion
1427 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1428 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1429 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1430 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1431
1432 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1433 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1434 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1435 enter it). For example, if you type
1436
1437 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1438 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1439 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1440 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1441 @smallexample
1442 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1443 @end smallexample
1444
1445 @noindent
1446 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1447 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1448
1449 @smallexample
1450 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1451 @end smallexample
1452
1453 @noindent
1454 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1455 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1456 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1457 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1458 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1459 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1460
1461 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1462 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1463 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1464 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1465 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1466 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1467 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1468 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1469 example:
1470
1471 @smallexample
1472 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1473 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1474 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1475 make_abs_section make_function_type
1476 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1477 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1478 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1479 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1480 @end smallexample
1481
1482 @noindent
1483 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1484 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1485 command.
1486
1487 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1488 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1489 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1490 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1491 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1492
1493 @cindex quotes in commands
1494 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1495 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1496 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1497 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1498 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1499 @value{GDBN} commands.
1500
1501 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1502 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1503 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1504 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1505 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1506 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1507 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1508 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1509 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1510 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1511 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1512
1513 @smallexample
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1515 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1516 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1517 @end smallexample
1518
1519 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1520 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1521 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1522 place:
1523
1524 @smallexample
1525 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1526 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1527 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1528 @end smallexample
1529
1530 @noindent
1531 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1532 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1533 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1534
1535 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1536 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1537 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1538 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1539
1540 @cindex completion of structure field names
1541 @cindex structure field name completion
1542 @cindex completion of union field names
1543 @cindex union field name completion
1544 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1545 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1546 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1547 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1548 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1549 left-hand-side:
1550
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1553 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1554 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1555 @end smallexample
1556
1557 @noindent
1558 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1559 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1560 follows:
1561
1562 @smallexample
1563 struct ui_file
1564 @{
1565 int *magic;
1566 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1567 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1568 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1569 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1570 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1571 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1572 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1573 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1574 void *to_data;
1575 @}
1576 @end smallexample
1577
1578
1579 @node Help
1580 @section Getting Help
1581 @cindex online documentation
1582 @kindex help
1583
1584 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1585 using the command @code{help}.
1586
1587 @table @code
1588 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1589 @item help
1590 @itemx h
1591 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1592 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) help
1596 List of classes of commands:
1597
1598 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1599 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1600 data -- Examining data
1601 files -- Specifying and examining files
1602 internals -- Maintenance commands
1603 obscure -- Obscure features
1604 running -- Running the program
1605 stack -- Examining the stack
1606 status -- Status inquiries
1607 support -- Support facilities
1608 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1609 stopping the program
1610 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1611
1612 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1613 commands in that class.
1614 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1615 documentation.
1616 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1617 (@value{GDBP})
1618 @end smallexample
1619 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1620
1621 @item help @var{class}
1622 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1623 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1624 help display for the class @code{status}:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1628 Status inquiries.
1629
1630 List of commands:
1631
1632 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1633 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1634 info -- Generic command for showing things
1635 about the program being debugged
1636 show -- Generic command for showing things
1637 about the debugger
1638
1639 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1640 documentation.
1641 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1642 (@value{GDBP})
1643 @end smallexample
1644
1645 @item help @var{command}
1646 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1647 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1648
1649 @kindex apropos
1650 @item apropos @var{args}
1651 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1652 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1653 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1654
1655 @smallexample
1656 apropos reload
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 @noindent
1660 results in:
1661
1662 @smallexample
1663 @c @group
1664 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1665 multiple times in one run
1666 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1667 multiple times in one run
1668 @c @end group
1669 @end smallexample
1670
1671 @kindex complete
1672 @item complete @var{args}
1673 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1674 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1675 command you want completed. For example:
1676
1677 @smallexample
1678 complete i
1679 @end smallexample
1680
1681 @noindent results in:
1682
1683 @smallexample
1684 @group
1685 if
1686 ignore
1687 info
1688 inspect
1689 @end group
1690 @end smallexample
1691
1692 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1693 @end table
1694
1695 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1696 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1697 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1698 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1699 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1700 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1701
1702 @c @group
1703 @table @code
1704 @kindex info
1705 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1706 @item info
1707 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1708 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1709 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1710 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1711 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1712 @w{@code{help info}}.
1713
1714 @kindex set
1715 @item set
1716 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1717 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1718 @code{set prompt $}.
1719
1720 @kindex show
1721 @item show
1722 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1723 @value{GDBN} itself.
1724 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1725 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1726 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1727 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1728
1729 @kindex info set
1730 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1731 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1732 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1733 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1734 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1735 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1736 @end table
1737 @c @end group
1738
1739 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1740 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1741
1742 @table @code
1743 @kindex show version
1744 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1745 @item show version
1746 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1747 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1748 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1749 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1750 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1751 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1752 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1753 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1754 @value{GDBN}.
1755
1756 @kindex show copying
1757 @kindex info copying
1758 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1759 @item show copying
1760 @itemx info copying
1761 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1762
1763 @kindex show warranty
1764 @kindex info warranty
1765 @item show warranty
1766 @itemx info warranty
1767 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1768 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1769
1770 @end table
1771
1772 @node Running
1773 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1774
1775 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1776 debugging information when you compile it.
1777
1778 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1779 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1780 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1781 kill a child process.
1782
1783 @menu
1784 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1785 * Starting:: Starting your program
1786 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1787 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1788
1789 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1790 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1791 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1792 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1793
1794 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1795 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1796 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1797 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1798 @end menu
1799
1800 @node Compilation
1801 @section Compiling for Debugging
1802
1803 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1804 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1805 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1806 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1807 and addresses in the executable code.
1808
1809 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1810 the compiler.
1811
1812 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1813 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1814 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1815 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1816 executables containing debugging information.
1817
1818 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1819 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1820 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1821 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1822 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1823
1824 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1825 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1826 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1827
1828 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1829 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1830 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1831 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1832 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1833 provides macro information if you specify the options
1834 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1835 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1836 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1837 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1838 @option{-g} alone.
1839
1840 @need 2000
1841 @node Starting
1842 @section Starting your Program
1843 @cindex starting
1844 @cindex running
1845
1846 @table @code
1847 @kindex run
1848 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1849 @item run
1850 @itemx r
1851 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1852 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1853 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1854 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1855 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1856
1857 @end table
1858
1859 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1860 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1861 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1862 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1863 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1864 message like this one:
1865
1866 @smallexample
1867 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1868 Try "help target" or "continue".
1869 @end smallexample
1870
1871 @noindent
1872 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1873 first (@pxref{load}).
1874
1875 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1876 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1877 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1878 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1879 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1880 divided into four categories:
1881
1882 @table @asis
1883 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1884 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1885 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1886 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1887 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1888 the arguments.
1889 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1890 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1891 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1892
1893 @item The @emph{environment.}
1894 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1895 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1896 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1897 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1898
1899 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1900 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1901 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1902 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1903
1904 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1905 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1906 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1907 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1908 set a different device for your program.
1909 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1910
1911 @cindex pipes
1912 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1913 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1914 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1915 wrong program.
1916 @end table
1917
1918 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1919 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1920 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1921 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1922 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1923
1924 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1925 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1926 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1927 your current breakpoints.
1928
1929 @table @code
1930 @kindex start
1931 @item start
1932 @cindex run to main procedure
1933 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1934 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1935 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1936 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1937 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1938 procedure, depending on the language used.
1939
1940 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1941 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1942 the @samp{run} command.
1943
1944 @cindex elaboration phase
1945 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1946 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1947 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1948 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1949 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1950 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1951 will remain to halt execution.
1952
1953 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1954 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1955 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1956 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1957 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1958
1959 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1960 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1961 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1962 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1963 elaboration code before running your program.
1964
1965 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1966 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1967 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1968 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1969 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1970 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1971 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1972 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1973 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1974 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1975 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1976
1977 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1978 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1979 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1980 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1981
1982 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1983 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1984 environment:
1985
1986 @smallexample
1987 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1988 (@value{GDBP}) run
1989 @end smallexample
1990
1991 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1992 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1993
1994 @kindex set disable-randomization
1995 @item set disable-randomization
1996 @itemx set disable-randomization on
1997 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
1998 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
1999 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2000 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2001
2002 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2003 behavior using
2004
2005 @smallexample
2006 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2007 @end smallexample
2008
2009 @item set disable-randomization off
2010 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2011 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2012 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2013 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2014 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2015 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2016
2017 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2018 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2019 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2020 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2021 a code at its expected addresses.
2022
2023 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2024 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2025 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2026 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2027 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2028 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2029 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2030 a randomly chosen address.
2031
2032 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2033 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2034 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2035 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2036 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2037
2038 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2039 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2040
2041 @item show disable-randomization
2042 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2043 the virtual address space of the started program.
2044
2045 @end table
2046
2047 @node Arguments
2048 @section Your Program's Arguments
2049
2050 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2051 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2052 @code{run} command.
2053 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2054 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2055 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2056 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2057 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2058
2059 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2060 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2061 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2062 the program, not by the shell.
2063
2064 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2065 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2066
2067 @table @code
2068 @kindex set args
2069 @item set args
2070 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2071 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2072 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2073 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2074 it again without arguments.
2075
2076 @kindex show args
2077 @item show args
2078 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2079 @end table
2080
2081 @node Environment
2082 @section Your Program's Environment
2083
2084 @cindex environment (of your program)
2085 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2086 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2087 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2088 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2089 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2090 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2091 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2092
2093 @table @code
2094 @kindex path
2095 @item path @var{directory}
2096 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2097 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2098 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2099 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2100 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2101 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2102 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2103
2104 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2105 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2106 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2107 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2108 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2109 @var{directory} to the search path.
2110 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2111 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2112
2113 @kindex show paths
2114 @item show paths
2115 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2116 environment variable).
2117
2118 @kindex show environment
2119 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2120 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2121 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2122 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2123 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2124
2125 @kindex set environment
2126 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2127 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2128 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2129 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2130 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2131 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2132 null value.
2133 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2134 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2135
2136 For example, this command:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 set env USER = foo
2140 @end smallexample
2141
2142 @noindent
2143 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2144 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2145 are not actually required.)
2146
2147 @kindex unset environment
2148 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2149 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2150 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2151 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2152 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2153 @end table
2154
2155 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2156 the shell indicated
2157 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2158 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2159 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2160 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2161 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2162 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2163 @file{.profile}.
2164
2165 @node Working Directory
2166 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2167
2168 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2169 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2170 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2171 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2172 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2173 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2174
2175 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2176 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2177 Specify Files}.
2178
2179 @table @code
2180 @kindex cd
2181 @cindex change working directory
2182 @item cd @var{directory}
2183 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2184
2185 @kindex pwd
2186 @item pwd
2187 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2188 @end table
2189
2190 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2191 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2192 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2193 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2194 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2195 current working directory of the debuggee.
2196
2197 @node Input/Output
2198 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2199
2200 @cindex redirection
2201 @cindex i/o
2202 @cindex terminal
2203 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2204 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2205 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2206 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2207 running your program.
2208
2209 @table @code
2210 @kindex info terminal
2211 @item info terminal
2212 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2213 program is using.
2214 @end table
2215
2216 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2217 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2218
2219 @smallexample
2220 run > outfile
2221 @end smallexample
2222
2223 @noindent
2224 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2225
2226 @kindex tty
2227 @cindex controlling terminal
2228 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2229 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2230 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2231 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2232 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2233
2234 @smallexample
2235 tty /dev/ttyb
2236 @end smallexample
2237
2238 @noindent
2239 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2240 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2241 that as their controlling terminal.
2242
2243 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2244 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2245 terminal.
2246
2247 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2248 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2249 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2250 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2251
2252 @cindex inferior tty
2253 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2254 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2255 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2256 program.
2257
2258 @table @code
2259 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2260 @kindex set inferior-tty
2261 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2262
2263 @item show inferior-tty
2264 @kindex show inferior-tty
2265 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2266 @end table
2267
2268 @node Attach
2269 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2270 @kindex attach
2271 @cindex attach
2272
2273 @table @code
2274 @item attach @var{process-id}
2275 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2276 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2277 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2278 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2279 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2280
2281 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2282 executing the command.
2283 @end table
2284
2285 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2286 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2287 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2288 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2289
2290 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2291 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2292 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2293 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2294 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2295 Specify Files}.
2296
2297 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2298 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2299 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2300 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2301 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2302 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2303 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2304
2305 @table @code
2306 @kindex detach
2307 @item detach
2308 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2309 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2310 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2311 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2312 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2313 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2314 executing the command.
2315 @end table
2316
2317 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2318 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2319 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2320 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2321 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2322 Messages}).
2323
2324 @node Kill Process
2325 @section Killing the Child Process
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex kill
2329 @item kill
2330 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2331 @end table
2332
2333 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2334 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2335 is running.
2336
2337 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2338 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2339 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2340 outside the debugger.
2341
2342 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2343 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2344 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2345 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2346 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2347 breakpoint settings).
2348
2349 @node Inferiors
2350 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2351
2352 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2353 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2354 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2355 protocol.
2356
2357 @cindex inferior
2358 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2359 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2360 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2361 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2362 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2363 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2364 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2365 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2366 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2367 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2368 different parts of a single space.
2369
2370 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2371
2372 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2373
2374 @table @code
2375 @kindex info inferiors
2376 @item info inferiors
2377 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2378
2379 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2380
2381 @enumerate
2382 @item
2383 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2384
2385 @item
2386 the target system's inferior identifier
2387 @end enumerate
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2391 indicates the current inferior.
2392
2393 For example,
2394 @end table
2395 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2399 Num Description
2400 * 1 process 2307
2401 2 process 3401
2402 @end smallexample
2403
2404 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2405
2406 @table @code
2407 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2408 @item inferior @var{infno}
2409 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2410 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2411 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2412 @end table
2413
2414 To quit debugging one of the inferiors, you can either detach from it
2415 by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it to run
2416 independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2417
2418 @table @code
2419 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2420 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2421 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2422 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2423
2424 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2425 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2426 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2427 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2428 @end table
2429
2430 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2431 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2432
2433 @table @code
2434 @kindex set print inferior-events
2435 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2436 @item set print inferior-events
2437 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2438 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2439 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2440 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2441 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2442 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2443
2444 @kindex show print inferior-events
2445 @item show print inferior-events
2446 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2447 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2448 @end table
2449
2450 @node Threads
2451 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2452
2453 @cindex threads of execution
2454 @cindex multiple threads
2455 @cindex switching threads
2456 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2457 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2458 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2459 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2460 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2461 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2462 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2463
2464 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2465 programs:
2466
2467 @itemize @bullet
2468 @item automatic notification of new threads
2469 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2470 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2471 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2472 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2473 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2474 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2475 messages on thread start and exit.
2476 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2477 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2478 isn't compatible with the program.
2479 @end itemize
2480
2481 @quotation
2482 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2483 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2484 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2485 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2486 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2487 like this:
2488
2489 @smallexample
2490 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2491 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2492 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2493 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2494 @end smallexample
2495 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2496 @c doesn't support threads"?
2497 @end quotation
2498
2499 @cindex focus of debugging
2500 @cindex current thread
2501 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2502 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2503 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2504 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2505 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2506
2507 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2508 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2509 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2510 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2511 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2512 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2513 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2514 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2515 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2516 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2517
2518 @smallexample
2519 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2520 @end smallexample
2521
2522 @noindent
2523 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2524 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2525 further qualifier.
2526
2527 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2528 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2529 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2530 @c program?
2531 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2532 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2533 @c threads ab initio?
2534
2535 @cindex thread number
2536 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2537 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2538 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @kindex info threads
2542 @item info threads
2543 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2544 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2545
2546 @enumerate
2547 @item
2548 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2549
2550 @item
2551 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2552
2553 @item
2554 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2555 @end enumerate
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2559 indicates the current thread.
2560
2561 For example,
2562 @end table
2563 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2564
2565 @smallexample
2566 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2567 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2568 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2569 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2570 at threadtest.c:68
2571 @end smallexample
2572
2573 On HP-UX systems:
2574
2575 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2576 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2577 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2578 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2579 thread in your program.
2580
2581 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2582 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2583 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2584 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2585 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2586 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2587 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2588 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2589 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2590 HP-UX, you see
2591
2592 @smallexample
2593 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2594 @end smallexample
2595
2596 @noindent
2597 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2598
2599 @table @code
2600 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2601 @item info threads
2602 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2603 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2604
2605 @enumerate
2606 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2607
2608 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2609
2610 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2611 @end enumerate
2612
2613 @noindent
2614 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2615 indicates the current thread.
2616
2617 For example,
2618 @end table
2619 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2620
2621 @smallexample
2622 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2623 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2624 at quicksort.c:137
2625 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2626 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2627 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2628 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2632 Solaris-specific command:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @item maint info sol-threads
2636 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2637 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2638 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2639 @end table
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2643 @item thread @var{threadno}
2644 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2645 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2646 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2647 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2648 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2649
2650 @smallexample
2651 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2652 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2653 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2654 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2655 @end smallexample
2656
2657 @noindent
2658 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2659 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2660 threads.
2661
2662 @kindex thread apply
2663 @cindex apply command to several threads
2664 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2665 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2666 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2667 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2668 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2669 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2670 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2671 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2672
2673 @kindex set print thread-events
2674 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2675 @item set print thread-events
2676 @itemx set print thread-events on
2677 @itemx set print thread-events off
2678 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2679 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2680 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2681 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2682 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2683
2684 @kindex show print thread-events
2685 @item show print thread-events
2686 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2687 have started and exited.
2688 @end table
2689
2690 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2691 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2692 programs with multiple threads.
2693
2694 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2695 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2696
2697 @table @code
2698 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2699 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2700 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2701 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2702 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2703 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2704 an empty list.
2705
2706 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2707 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2708 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2709 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2710 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2711 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2712
2713 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2714 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2715 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2716 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2717 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2718 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2719 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2720
2721 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2722 only on some platforms.
2723
2724 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2725 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2726 Display current libthread_db search path.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 @node Processes
2730 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2731
2732 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2733 @cindex multiple processes
2734 @cindex processes, multiple
2735 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2736 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2737 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2738 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2739 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2740 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2741 will cause it to terminate.
2742
2743 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2744 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2745 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2746 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2747 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2748 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2749 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2750 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2751 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2752 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2753
2754 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2755 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2756 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2757 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2758
2759 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2760 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2761
2762 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2763 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2767 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2768 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2769 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2770 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2771
2772 @table @code
2773 @item parent
2774 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2775 unimpeded. This is the default.
2776
2777 @item child
2778 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2779 unimpeded.
2780
2781 @end table
2782
2783 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2784 @item show follow-fork-mode
2785 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2786 @end table
2787
2788 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2789 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2790 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2791
2792 @table @code
2793 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2794 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2795 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2796 retain debugger control over them both.
2797
2798 @table @code
2799 @item on
2800 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2801 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2802 independently. This is the default.
2803
2804 @item off
2805 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2806 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2807 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2808 is held suspended.
2809
2810 @end table
2811
2812 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2813 @item show detach-on-fork
2814 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2815 @end table
2816
2817 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2818 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2819 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2820 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2821 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors,
2822 ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors}).
2823
2824 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2825 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2826 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2827 command. @xref{Inferiors, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors}.
2828
2829 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2830 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2831 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2832 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2833 the child process's @code{main}.
2834
2835 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2836 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2837
2838 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2839 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2840 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2841 argument.
2842
2843 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2844 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2845 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2846
2847 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2848 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2849
2850 @cindex checkpoint
2851 @cindex restart
2852 @cindex bookmark
2853 @cindex snapshot of a process
2854 @cindex rewind program state
2855
2856 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2858 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2859 later.
2860
2861 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2862 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2863 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2864 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2865 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2866
2867 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2868 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2869 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2870 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2871 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2872 start again from there.
2873
2874 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2875 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2876
2877 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2878
2879 @table @code
2880 @kindex checkpoint
2881 @item checkpoint
2882 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2883 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2884 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2885
2886 @kindex info checkpoints
2887 @item info checkpoints
2888 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2889 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2890 listed:
2891
2892 @table @code
2893 @item Checkpoint ID
2894 @item Process ID
2895 @item Code Address
2896 @item Source line, or label
2897 @end table
2898
2899 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2900 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2901 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2902 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2903 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2904 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2905 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2906
2907 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2908 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2909 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2910 the debugger.
2911
2912 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2913 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2914 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2915
2916 @end table
2917
2918 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2919 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2920 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2921 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2922 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2923 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2924 previously read data can be read again.
2925
2926 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2927 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2928 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2929 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2930 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2931 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2932
2933 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2934 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2935 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2936 different execution path this time.
2937
2938 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2939 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2940 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2941 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2942 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2943 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2944 potentially pose a problem.
2945
2946 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2947
2948 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2949 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2950 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2951 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2952 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2953 next.
2954
2955 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2956 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2957 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2958 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2959 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2960
2961 @node Stopping
2962 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2963
2964 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2965 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2966 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2967
2968 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2969 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2970 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2971 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2972 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2973 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2974 explicitly request this information at any time.
2975
2976 @table @code
2977 @kindex info program
2978 @item info program
2979 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2980 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2981 @end table
2982
2983 @menu
2984 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2985 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2986 * Signals:: Signals
2987 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2988 @end menu
2989
2990 @node Breakpoints
2991 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2992
2993 @cindex breakpoints
2994 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2995 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2996 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2997 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2998 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2999 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3000 program.
3001
3002 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3003 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3004 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3005 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3006 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3007 call).
3008
3009 @cindex watchpoints
3010 @cindex data breakpoints
3011 @cindex memory tracing
3012 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3013 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3014 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3015 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3016 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3017 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3018 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3019 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3020 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3021 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3022 same commands.
3023
3024 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3025 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3026 Automatic Display}.
3027
3028 @cindex catchpoints
3029 @cindex breakpoint on events
3030 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3031 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3032 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3033 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3034 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3035 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3036 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3037
3038 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3039 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3040 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3041 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3042 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3043 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3044 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3045 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3046 enable it again.
3047
3048 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3049 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3050 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3051 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3052 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3053 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3054 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3055
3056 @menu
3057 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3058 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3059 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3060 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3061 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3062 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3063 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3064 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3065 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3066 @end menu
3067
3068 @node Set Breaks
3069 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3070
3071 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3072 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3073 @c
3074 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3075
3076 @kindex break
3077 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3078 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3079 @cindex latest breakpoint
3080 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3081 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3082 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3083 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3084 convenience variables.
3085
3086 @table @code
3087 @item break @var{location}
3088 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3089 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3090 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3091 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3092 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3093
3094 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3095 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3096 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3097 that situation.
3098
3099 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3100 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3101 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3102
3103 @item break
3104 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3105 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3106 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3107 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3108 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3109 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3110 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3111 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3112 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3113 inside loops.
3114
3115 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3116 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3117 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3118 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3119 existed when your program stopped.
3120
3121 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3122 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3123 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3124 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3125 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3126 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3127 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3128
3129 @kindex tbreak
3130 @item tbreak @var{args}
3131 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3132 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3133 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3134 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3135
3136 @kindex hbreak
3137 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3138 @item hbreak @var{args}
3139 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3140 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3141 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3142 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3143 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3144 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3145 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3146 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3147 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3148 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3149 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3150 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3151 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3152 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3153 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3154 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3155 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3156 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3157
3158 @kindex thbreak
3159 @item thbreak @var{args}
3160 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3161 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3162 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3163 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3164 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3165 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3166 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3167 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3168
3169 @kindex rbreak
3170 @cindex regular expression
3171 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3172 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3173 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3174 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3175 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3176 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3177 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3178 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3179 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3180
3181 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3182 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3183 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3184 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3185 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3186 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3187
3188 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3189 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3190 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3191 classes.
3192
3193 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3194 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3195 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3196
3197 @smallexample
3198 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3199 @end smallexample
3200
3201 @kindex info breakpoints
3202 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3203 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3204 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3205 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3206 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3207 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3208 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3209 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3210
3211 @table @emph
3212 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3213 @item Type
3214 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3215 @item Disposition
3216 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3217 @item Enabled or Disabled
3218 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3219 that are not enabled.
3220 @item Address
3221 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3222 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3223 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3224 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3225 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3226 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3227 @item What
3228 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3229 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3230 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3231 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3232 @end table
3233
3234 @noindent
3235 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3236 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3237 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3238 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3239 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3240 valid location.
3241
3242 @noindent
3243 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3244 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3245 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3246 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3247 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3248
3249 @noindent
3250 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3251 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3252 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3253 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3254 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3255 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3256 @end table
3257
3258 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3259 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3260 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3261 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3262
3263 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3264 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3265 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3266 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3267
3268 @itemize @bullet
3269 @item
3270 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3271 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3272
3273 @item
3274 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3275 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3276
3277 @item
3278 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3279 several places where that function is inlined.
3280 @end itemize
3281
3282 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3283 the relevant locations@footnote{
3284 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3285 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3286 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3287 info with line numbers for them.}.
3288
3289 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3290 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3291 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3292 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3293 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3294 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3295 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3296
3297 For example:
3298
3299 @smallexample
3300 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3301 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3302 stop only if i==1
3303 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3304 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3305 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3306 @end smallexample
3307
3308 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3309 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3310 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3311 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3312 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3313 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3314 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3315 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3316 that belong to that breakpoint.
3317
3318 @cindex pending breakpoints
3319 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3320 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3321 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3322 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3323 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3324 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3325 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3326 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3327 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3328 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3329 is not yet resolved.
3330
3331 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3332 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3333 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3334 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3335 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3336 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3337
3338 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3339 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3340 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3341 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3342
3343 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3344 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3345 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3346
3347 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3348 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3349 address specification to an address:
3350
3351 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3352 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3353 @table @code
3354 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3355 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3356 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3357
3358 @item set breakpoint pending on
3359 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3360 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3361
3362 @item set breakpoint pending off
3363 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3364 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3365 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3366
3367 @item show breakpoint pending
3368 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3369 @end table
3370
3371 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3372 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3373 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3374
3375 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3376 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3377 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3378 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3379 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3380 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3381 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3382 breakpoints.
3383
3384 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3385
3386 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3387 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3388 @table @code
3389 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3390 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3391 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3392 breakpoint must be used.
3393
3394 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3395 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3396 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3397 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3398 @end table
3399
3400 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3401 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3402 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3403 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3404 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3405 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3406 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3407 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3408 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3409
3410 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3411 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3412 @table @code
3413 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3414 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3415 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3416 removed from the target when it stops.
3417
3418 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3419 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3420 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3421 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3422 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3423
3424 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3425 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3426 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3427 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3428 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3429 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3430 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3431 @end table
3432
3433 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3434 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3435 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3436 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3437 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3438 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3439 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3440 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3441
3442
3443 @node Set Watchpoints
3444 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3445
3446 @cindex setting watchpoints
3447 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3448 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3449 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3450 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3451 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3452
3453 @itemize @bullet
3454 @item
3455 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3456
3457 @item
3458 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3459 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3460 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3461
3462 @item
3463 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3464 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3465 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3466 @end itemize
3467
3468 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3469 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3470 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3471 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3472 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3473 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3474 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3475 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3476 the expression changes.
3477
3478 @cindex software watchpoints
3479 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3480 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3481 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3482 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3483 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3484 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3485 culprit.)
3486
3487 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3488 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3489 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3490
3491 @table @code
3492 @kindex watch
3493 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3494 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3495 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3496 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3497 to watch the value of a single variable:
3498
3499 @smallexample
3500 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3501 @end smallexample
3502
3503 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3504 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3505 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3506 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3507 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3508 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3509
3510 @kindex rwatch
3511 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3512 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3513 by the program.
3514
3515 @kindex awatch
3516 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3517 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3518 or written into by the program.
3519
3520 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3521 @item info watchpoints
3522 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3523 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3527 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3528 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3529 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3530 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3531 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3532
3533 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3534 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3535 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3536 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3537 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3538 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3539 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3540 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3541
3542 @table @code
3543 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3544 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3545 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3546
3547 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3548 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3549 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3550 @end table
3551
3552 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3553 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3554 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3555
3556 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3557
3558 @smallexample
3559 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3560 @end smallexample
3561
3562 @noindent
3563 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3564
3565 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3566 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3567 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3568 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3569 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3570 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3571 will print a message like this:
3572
3573 @smallexample
3574 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3575 @end smallexample
3576
3577 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3578 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3579 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3580 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3581 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3582 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3583 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3584 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3585
3586 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3587 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3588 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3589 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3590 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3591 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3592
3593 @smallexample
3594 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3595 @end smallexample
3596
3597 @noindent
3598 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3599
3600 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3601 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3602 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3603 expression with separately allocated resources.
3604
3605 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3606 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3607 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3608
3609 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3610 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3611 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3612 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3613 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3614 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3615 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3616 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3617 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3618
3619 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3620 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3621 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3622 watched expression from every thread.
3623
3624 @quotation
3625 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3626 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3627 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3628 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3629 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3630 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3631 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3632 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3633 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3634 @end quotation
3635
3636 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3637
3638 @node Set Catchpoints
3639 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3640 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3641 @cindex exception handlers
3642 @cindex event handling
3643
3644 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3645 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3646 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3647
3648 @table @code
3649 @kindex catch
3650 @item catch @var{event}
3651 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3652 @table @code
3653 @item throw
3654 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3655 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3656
3657 @item catch
3658 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3659
3660 @item exception
3661 @cindex Ada exception catching
3662 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3663 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3664 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3665 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3666 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3667
3668 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3669 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3670 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3671 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3672 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3673 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3674 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3675 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3676
3677 @item exception unhandled
3678 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3679
3680 @item assert
3681 A failed Ada assertion.
3682
3683 @item exec
3684 @cindex break on fork/exec
3685 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3686 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3687
3688 @item fork
3689 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3690 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3691
3692 @item vfork
3693 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3694 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3695
3696 @end table
3697
3698 @item tcatch @var{event}
3699 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3700 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3701
3702 @end table
3703
3704 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3705
3706 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3707 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3708
3709 @itemize @bullet
3710 @item
3711 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3712 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3713 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3714 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3715 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3716 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3717 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3718 disabled within interactive calls.
3719
3720 @item
3721 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3722
3723 @item
3724 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3725 @end itemize
3726
3727 @cindex raise exceptions
3728 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3729 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3730 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3731 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3732 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3733 out where the exception was raised.
3734
3735 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3736 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3737 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3738 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3739
3740 @smallexample
3741 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3742 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3743 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3744 @end smallexample
3745
3746 @noindent
3747 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3748 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3749 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3750
3751 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3752 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3753 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3754 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3755 raised.
3756
3757
3758 @node Delete Breaks
3759 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3760
3761 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3762 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3763 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3764 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3765 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3766 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3767
3768 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3769 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3770 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3771 their breakpoint numbers.
3772
3773 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3774 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3775 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3776
3777 @table @code
3778 @kindex clear
3779 @item clear
3780 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3781 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3782 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3783 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3784
3785 @item clear @var{location}
3786 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3787 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3788 most useful ones are listed below:
3789
3790 @table @code
3791 @item clear @var{function}
3792 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3793 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3794
3795 @item clear @var{linenum}
3796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3797 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3798 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3799 @end table
3800
3801 @cindex delete breakpoints
3802 @kindex delete
3803 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3804 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3805 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3806 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3807 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3808 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3809 @end table
3810
3811 @node Disabling
3812 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3813
3814 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3815 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3816 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3817 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3818 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3819
3820 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3821 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3822 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3823 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3824 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3825
3826 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3827 affects all of its locations.
3828
3829 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3830 states of enablement:
3831
3832 @itemize @bullet
3833 @item
3834 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3835 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3836 @item
3837 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3838 @item
3839 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3840 disabled.
3841 @item
3842 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3843 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3844 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3845 @end itemize
3846
3847 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3848 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3849
3850 @table @code
3851 @kindex disable
3852 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3853 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3854 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3855 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3856 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3857 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3858 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3859
3860 @kindex enable
3861 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3862 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3863 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3864
3865 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3866 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3867 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3868
3869 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3870 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3871 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3872 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3873 @end table
3874
3875 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3876 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3877 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3878 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3879 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3880 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3881 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3882 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3883 Stepping}.)
3884
3885 @node Conditions
3886 @subsection Break Conditions
3887 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3888 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3889
3890 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3891 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3892 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3893 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3894 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3895 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3896 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3897 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3898
3899 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3900 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3901 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3902 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3903 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3904
3905 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3906 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3907 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3908 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3909 one.
3910
3911 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3912 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3913 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3914 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3915 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3916 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3917 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3918 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3919 conditions for the
3920 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3921 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3922
3923 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3924 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3925 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3926 with the @code{condition} command.
3927
3928 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3929 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3930 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3931 catchpoint.
3932
3933 @table @code
3934 @kindex condition
3935 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3936 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3937 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3938 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3939 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3940 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3941 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3942 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3943 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3944 prints an error message:
3945
3946 @smallexample
3947 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3948 @end smallexample
3949
3950 @noindent
3951 @value{GDBN} does
3952 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3953 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3954 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3955
3956 @item condition @var{bnum}
3957 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3958 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3959 @end table
3960
3961 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3962 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3963 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3964 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3965 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3966 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3967 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3968 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3969 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3970 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3971 your program reaches it.
3972
3973 @table @code
3974 @kindex ignore
3975 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3976 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3977 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3978 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3979 takes no action.
3980
3981 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3982 a count of zero.
3983
3984 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3985 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3986 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3987 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3988
3989 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3990 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3991 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3992
3993 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3994 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3995 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3996 Variables}.
3997 @end table
3998
3999 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4000
4001
4002 @node Break Commands
4003 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4004
4005 @cindex breakpoint commands
4006 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4007 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4008 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4009 enable other breakpoints.
4010
4011 @table @code
4012 @kindex commands
4013 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4014 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
4015 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4016 @itemx end
4017 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
4018 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4019 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4020
4021 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4022 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4023
4024 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
4025 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
4026 recently encountered).
4027 @end table
4028
4029 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4030 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4031
4032 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4033 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4034 that resumes execution.
4035
4036 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4037 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4038 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4039 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4040 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4041
4042 @kindex silent
4043 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4044 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4045 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4046 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4047 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4048 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4049
4050 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4051 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4052 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4053
4054 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4055 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4056
4057 @smallexample
4058 break foo if x>0
4059 commands
4060 silent
4061 printf "x is %d\n",x
4062 cont
4063 end
4064 @end smallexample
4065
4066 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4067 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4068 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4069 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4070 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4071 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4072 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4073
4074 @smallexample
4075 break 403
4076 commands
4077 silent
4078 set x = y + 4
4079 cont
4080 end
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4084 @node Error in Breakpoints
4085 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4086
4087 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4088 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4089
4090 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4091 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4092 @smallexample
4093 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4094 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4095 @end smallexample
4096
4097 @noindent
4098 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4099 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4100 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4101
4102 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4103 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4104
4105 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4106 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4107 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4108
4109 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4110 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4111 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4112 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4113
4114 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4115 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4116 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4117 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4118 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4119 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4120 first in the bundle.
4121
4122 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4123 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4124 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4125 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4126 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4127 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4128 is hit.
4129
4130 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4131 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4132
4133 @smallexample
4134 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4135 @end smallexample
4136
4137 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4138 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4139 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4140 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4141 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4142 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4143 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4144 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4145
4146 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4147 adjusted breakpoints:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4151 to 0x00010410.
4152 @end smallexample
4153
4154 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4155 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4156 frequently than expected.
4157
4158 @node Continuing and Stepping
4159 @section Continuing and Stepping
4160
4161 @cindex stepping
4162 @cindex continuing
4163 @cindex resuming execution
4164 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4165 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4166 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4167 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4168 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4169 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4170 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4171 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4172
4173 @table @code
4174 @kindex continue
4175 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4176 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4177 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4178 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4179 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4180 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4181 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4182 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4183 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4184 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4185
4186 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4187 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4188 @code{continue} is ignored.
4189
4190 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4191 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4192 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4193 @code{continue}.
4194 @end table
4195
4196 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4197 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4198 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4199 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4200
4201 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4202 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4203 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4204 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4205 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4206 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4207
4208 @table @code
4209 @kindex step
4210 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4211 @item step
4212 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4213 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4214 abbreviated @code{s}.
4215
4216 @quotation
4217 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4218 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4219 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4220 @c distinction here.
4221 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4222 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4223 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4224 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4225 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4226 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4227 below.
4228 @end quotation
4229
4230 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4231 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4232 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4233 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4234 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4235 called within the line.
4236
4237 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4238 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4239 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4240 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4241 was any debugging information about the routine.
4242
4243 @item step @var{count}
4244 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4245 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4246 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4247
4248 @kindex next
4249 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4250 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4251 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4252 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4253 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4254 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4255 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4256 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4257
4258 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4259
4260
4261 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4262 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4263 @c
4264 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4265 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4266 @c function are executed without stopping.
4267
4268 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4269 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4270 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4271
4272 @kindex set step-mode
4273 @item set step-mode
4274 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4275 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4276 @itemx set step-mode on
4277 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4278 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4279 information rather than stepping over it.
4280
4281 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4282 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4283 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4284
4285 @item set step-mode off
4286 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4287 debug information. This is the default.
4288
4289 @item show step-mode
4290 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4291 source line debug information.
4292
4293 @kindex finish
4294 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4295 @item finish
4296 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4297 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4298 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4299
4300 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4301 ,Returning from a Function}).
4302
4303 @kindex until
4304 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4305 @cindex run until specified location
4306 @item until
4307 @itemx u
4308 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4309 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4310 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4311 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4312 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4313 than the address of the jump.
4314
4315 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4316 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4317 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4318 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4319 through the next iteration.
4320
4321 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4322 stack frame.
4323
4324 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4325 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4326 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4327 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4328 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 (@value{GDBP}) f
4332 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4333 206 expand_input();
4334 (@value{GDBP}) until
4335 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4336 @end smallexample
4337
4338 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4339 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4340 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4341 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4342 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4343 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4344 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4345
4346 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4347 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4348 argument.
4349
4350 @item until @var{location}
4351 @itemx u @var{location}
4352 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4353 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4354 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4355 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4356 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4357 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4358 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4359 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4360 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4361 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4362 invocations have returned.
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 94 int factorial (int value)
4366 95 @{
4367 96 if (value > 1) @{
4368 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4369 98 @}
4370 99 return (value);
4371 100 @}
4372 @end smallexample
4373
4374
4375 @kindex advance @var{location}
4376 @itemx advance @var{location}
4377 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4378 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4379 @ref{Specify Location}.
4380 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4381 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4382 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4383 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4384
4385
4386 @kindex stepi
4387 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4388 @item stepi
4389 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4390 @itemx si
4391 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4392
4393 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4394 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4395 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4396 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4397
4398 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4399
4400 @need 750
4401 @kindex nexti
4402 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4403 @item nexti
4404 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4405 @itemx ni
4406 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4407 proceed until the function returns.
4408
4409 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4410 @end table
4411
4412 @node Signals
4413 @section Signals
4414 @cindex signals
4415
4416 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4417 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4418 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4419 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4420 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4421 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4422 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4423 requested an alarm).
4424
4425 @cindex fatal signals
4426 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4427 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4428 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4429 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4430 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4431 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4432
4433 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4434 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4435 signal.
4436
4437 @cindex handling signals
4438 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4439 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4440 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4441 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4442 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex info signals
4446 @kindex info handle
4447 @item info signals
4448 @itemx info handle
4449 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4450 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4451 the defined types of signals.
4452
4453 @item info signals @var{sig}
4454 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4455
4456 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4457
4458 @kindex handle
4459 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4460 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4461 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4462 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4463 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4464 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4465 say what change to make.
4466 @end table
4467
4468 @c @group
4469 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4470 Their full names are:
4471
4472 @table @code
4473 @item nostop
4474 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4475 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4476
4477 @item stop
4478 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4479 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4480
4481 @item print
4482 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4483
4484 @item noprint
4485 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4486 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4487
4488 @item pass
4489 @itemx noignore
4490 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4491 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4492 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4493
4494 @item nopass
4495 @itemx ignore
4496 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4497 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4498 @end table
4499 @c @end group
4500
4501 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4502 program until you
4503 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4504 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4505 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4506 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4507 program sees that signal when you continue.
4508
4509 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4510 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4511 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4512 erroneous signals.
4513
4514 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4515 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4516 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4517 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4518 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4519 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4520 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4521 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4522 Program a Signal}.
4523
4524 @cindex extra signal information
4525 @anchor{extra signal information}
4526
4527 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4528 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4529 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4530 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4531 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4532 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4533 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4534 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4535 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4536 system header.
4537
4538 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4539 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4540
4541 @smallexample
4542 @group
4543 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4544 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4545 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4546 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4547 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4548 type = struct @{
4549 int si_signo;
4550 int si_errno;
4551 int si_code;
4552 union @{
4553 int _pad[28];
4554 struct @{...@} _kill;
4555 struct @{...@} _timer;
4556 struct @{...@} _rt;
4557 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4558 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4559 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4560 @} _sifields;
4561 @}
4562 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4563 type = struct @{
4564 void *si_addr;
4565 @}
4566 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4567 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4568 @end group
4569 @end smallexample
4570
4571 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4572
4573 @node Thread Stops
4574 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4575
4576 @cindex stopped threads
4577 @cindex threads, stopped
4578
4579 @cindex continuing threads
4580 @cindex threads, continuing
4581
4582 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4583 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4584 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4585 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4586 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4587 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4588 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4589 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4590 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4591
4592 @menu
4593 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4594 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4595 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4596 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4597 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4598 @end menu
4599
4600 @node All-Stop Mode
4601 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4602
4603 @cindex all-stop mode
4604
4605 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4606 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4607 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4608 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4609 underfoot.
4610
4611 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4612 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4613 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4614
4615 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4616 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4617 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4618 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4619 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4620 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4621 stops.
4622
4623 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4624 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4625 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4626 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4627
4628 @cindex automatic thread selection
4629 @cindex switching threads automatically
4630 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4631 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4632 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4633 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4634 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4635 thread.
4636
4637 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4638 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4639
4640 @table @code
4641 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4642 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4643 @cindex lock scheduler
4644 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4645 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4646 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4647 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4648 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4649 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4650 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4651 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4652 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4653 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4654 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4655 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4656
4657 @item show scheduler-locking
4658 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4659 @end table
4660
4661 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
4662 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
4663 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
4664 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
4665 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
4666 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
4667 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
4668 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
4669 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
4670 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
4671 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
4672 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
4673 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
4674 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
4675
4676 @table @code
4677 @kindex set schedule-multiple
4678 @item set schedule-multiple
4679 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
4680 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
4681 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
4682 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
4683 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
4684 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
4685
4686 @item show schedule-multiple
4687 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
4688 multiple processes.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @node Non-Stop Mode
4692 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4693
4694 @cindex non-stop mode
4695
4696 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4697 @c with more details.
4698
4699 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4700 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4701 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4702 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4703 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4704 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4705
4706 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4707 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4708 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4709 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4710 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4711 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4712 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4713 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4714 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4715 independently and simultaneously.
4716
4717 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4718 or attach to your program:
4719
4720 @smallexample
4721 # Enable the async interface.
4722 set target-async 1
4723
4724 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4725 set pagination off
4726
4727 # Finally, turn it on!
4728 set non-stop on
4729 @end smallexample
4730
4731 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4732
4733 @table @code
4734 @kindex set non-stop
4735 @item set non-stop on
4736 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4737 @item set non-stop off
4738 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4739 @kindex show non-stop
4740 @item show non-stop
4741 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4745 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4746 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4747 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4748 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4749 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4750 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4751 default.
4752
4753 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4754 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4755 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4756
4757 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4758 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4759 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4760 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4761 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4762
4763 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4764 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4765 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4766 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4767 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4768
4769 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4770
4771 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4772 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4773 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4774 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4775 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4776 previously current thread.
4777
4778 @node Background Execution
4779 @subsection Background Execution
4780
4781 @cindex foreground execution
4782 @cindex background execution
4783 @cindex asynchronous execution
4784 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4785
4786 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4787 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4788 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4789 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4790 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4791 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4792
4793 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
4794 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
4795 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
4796
4797 @table @code
4798 @kindex set target-async
4799 @item set target-async on
4800 Enable asynchronous mode.
4801 @item set target-async off
4802 Disable asynchronous mode.
4803 @kindex show target-async
4804 @item show target-async
4805 Show the current target-async setting.
4806 @end table
4807
4808 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
4809 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4810
4811 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4812 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4813 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4814 are:
4815
4816 @table @code
4817 @kindex run&
4818 @item run
4819 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4820
4821 @item attach
4822 @kindex attach&
4823 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4824
4825 @item step
4826 @kindex step&
4827 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4828
4829 @item stepi
4830 @kindex stepi&
4831 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4832
4833 @item next
4834 @kindex next&
4835 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4836
4837 @item nexti
4838 @kindex nexti&
4839 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4840
4841 @item continue
4842 @kindex continue&
4843 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4844
4845 @item finish
4846 @kindex finish&
4847 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4848
4849 @item until
4850 @kindex until&
4851 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4852
4853 @end table
4854
4855 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4856 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4857 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4858 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4859 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4860 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4861
4862 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4863 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4864
4865 @table @code
4866 @kindex interrupt
4867 @item interrupt
4868 @itemx interrupt -a
4869
4870 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4871 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4872 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4873 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4874 @end table
4875
4876 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4877 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4878
4879 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4880 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4881 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4882
4883 @table @code
4884 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4885 @cindex thread breakpoints
4886 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4887 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4888 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4889 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4890 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4891 specify some source line.
4892
4893 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4894 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4895 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4896 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4897 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4898
4899 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4900 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4901 program.
4902
4903 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4904 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4905 breakpoint condition, like this:
4906
4907 @smallexample
4908 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4909 @end smallexample
4910
4911 @end table
4912
4913 @node Interrupted System Calls
4914 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4915
4916 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4917 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4918 @cindex premature return from system calls
4919 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4920 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4921 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4922 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4923 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4924 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4925 stop execution.
4926
4927 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4928 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4929 style anyways.
4930
4931 For example, do not write code like this:
4932
4933 @smallexample
4934 sleep (10);
4935 @end smallexample
4936
4937 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4938 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4939
4940 Instead, write this:
4941
4942 @smallexample
4943 int unslept = 10;
4944 while (unslept > 0)
4945 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4946 @end smallexample
4947
4948 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4949 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4950 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4951 @value{GDBN}.
4952
4953 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4954 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4955 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4956 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4957
4958
4959 @node Reverse Execution
4960 @chapter Running programs backward
4961 @cindex reverse execution
4962 @cindex running programs backward
4963
4964 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4965 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4966 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4967 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4968
4969 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4970 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4971 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4972 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4973 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4974 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4975
4976 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4977 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4978 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4979 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4980 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4981 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4982 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4983 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4984 prior values@footnote{
4985 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4986 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4987 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4988
4989 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4990 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4991 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4992 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4993 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4994 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4995 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4996 }.
4997
4998 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4999 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex reverse-continue
5003 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5004 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5005 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5006 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5007 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5008 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5009 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5010
5011 @kindex reverse-step
5012 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5013 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5014 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5015 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5016
5017 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5018 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5019 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5020 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5021 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5022 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5023
5024 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5025 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5026
5027 @kindex reverse-stepi
5028 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5029 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5030 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5031 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5032 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5033 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5034 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5035
5036 @kindex reverse-next
5037 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5038 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5039 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5040 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5041 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5042 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5043 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5044 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5045 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5046 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5047
5048 @kindex reverse-nexti
5049 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5050 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5051 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5052 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5053 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5054 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5055 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5056 frame) is reached.
5057
5058 @kindex reverse-finish
5059 @item reverse-finish
5060 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5061 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5062 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5063 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5064
5065 @kindex set exec-direction
5066 @item set exec-direction
5067 Set the direction of target execution.
5068 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5069 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5070 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5071 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5072 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5073 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5074 @item set exec-direction forward
5075 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5076 This is the default.
5077 @end table
5078
5079
5080 @node Process Record and Replay
5081 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5082 @cindex process record and replay
5083 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5084
5085 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5086 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5087 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5088
5089 @cindex replay mode
5090 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5091 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5092 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5093 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5094 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5095 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5096 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5097 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5098 execution log.
5099
5100 @cindex record mode
5101 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5102 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5103 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5104 for future replay.
5105
5106 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5107 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5108 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5109 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5110 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5111 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5112
5113 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5114 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5115 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5116 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5117
5118 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5119 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5120
5121 @table @code
5122 @kindex target record
5123 @kindex record
5124 @kindex rec
5125 @item target record
5126 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5127 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5128 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5129 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5130 the @kbd{target record} command.
5131
5132 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5133
5134 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5135 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5136 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5137 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5138 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5139
5140 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5141 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5142 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5143 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5144 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5145 support these two modes.
5146
5147 @kindex record stop
5148 @kindex rec s
5149 @item record stop
5150 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5151 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5152 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5153
5154 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5155 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5156 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5157 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5158 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5159
5160 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5161 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5162 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5163 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5164 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5165
5166 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5167 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5168
5169 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5170 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5171 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5172
5173 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5174 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5175 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5176 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5177 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5178 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5179 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5180 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5181
5182 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5183 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5184 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5185
5186 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5187 @item show record insn-number-max
5188 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5189
5190 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5191 @item set record stop-at-limit
5192 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5193 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5194 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5195 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5196 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5197 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5198
5199 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5200 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5201
5202 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5203 @item show record stop-at-limit
5204 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5205
5206 @kindex info record insn-number
5207 @item info record insn-number
5208 Show the current number of recorded instructions.
5209
5210 @kindex record delete
5211 @kindex rec del
5212 @item record delete
5213 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5214 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5215 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5216 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5217 @end table
5218
5219
5220 @node Stack
5221 @chapter Examining the Stack
5222
5223 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5224 stopped and how it got there.
5225
5226 @cindex call stack
5227 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5228 is generated.
5229 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5230 the arguments of the call,
5231 and the local variables of the function being called.
5232 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5233 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5234 stack}.
5235
5236 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5237 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5238
5239 @cindex selected frame
5240 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5241 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5242 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5243 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5244 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5245 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5246
5247 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5248 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5249 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5250
5251 @menu
5252 * Frames:: Stack frames
5253 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5254 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5255 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5256
5257 @end menu
5258
5259 @node Frames
5260 @section Stack Frames
5261
5262 @cindex frame, definition
5263 @cindex stack frame
5264 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5265 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5266 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5267 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5268 which the function is executing.
5269
5270 @cindex initial frame
5271 @cindex outermost frame
5272 @cindex innermost frame
5273 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5274 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5275 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5276 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5277 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5278 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5279 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5280 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5281
5282 @cindex frame pointer
5283 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5284 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5285 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5286 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5287 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5288 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5289
5290 @cindex frame number
5291 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5292 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5293 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5294 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5295 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5296
5297 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5298 @c underflow problems.
5299 @cindex frameless execution
5300 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5301 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5302 @smallexample
5303 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5304 @end smallexample
5305 generates functions without a frame.)
5306 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5307 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5308 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5309 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5310 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5311 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5312 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5313
5314 @table @code
5315 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5316 @cindex current stack frame
5317 @item frame @var{args}
5318 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5319 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5320 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5321 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5322
5323 @kindex select-frame
5324 @cindex selecting frame silently
5325 @item select-frame
5326 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5327 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5328 @code{frame}.
5329 @end table
5330
5331 @node Backtrace
5332 @section Backtraces
5333
5334 @cindex traceback
5335 @cindex call stack traces
5336 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5337 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5338 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5339 stack.
5340
5341 @table @code
5342 @kindex backtrace
5343 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5344 @item backtrace
5345 @itemx bt
5346 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5347 frames in the stack.
5348
5349 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5350 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5351
5352 @item backtrace @var{n}
5353 @itemx bt @var{n}
5354 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5355
5356 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5357 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5358 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5359
5360 @item backtrace full
5361 @itemx bt full
5362 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5363 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5364 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5365 number of frames to print, as described above.
5366 @end table
5367
5368 @kindex where
5369 @kindex info stack
5370 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5371 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5372
5373 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5374 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5375 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5376 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5377 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5378 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5379 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5380 multi-threaded program.
5381
5382 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5383 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5384 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5385 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5386 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5387 line number.
5388
5389 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5390 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5391
5392 @smallexample
5393 @group
5394 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5395 at builtin.c:993
5396 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5397 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5398 at macro.c:71
5399 (More stack frames follow...)
5400 @end group
5401 @end smallexample
5402
5403 @noindent
5404 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5405 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5406 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5407
5408 @noindent
5409 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5410 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5411 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5412 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5413 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5414
5415 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5416 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5417 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5418 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5419 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5420 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5421 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5422 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5423 such a backtrace might look like:
5424
5425 @smallexample
5426 @group
5427 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5428 at builtin.c:993
5429 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5430 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5431 at macro.c:71
5432 (More stack frames follow...)
5433 @end group
5434 @end smallexample
5435
5436 @noindent
5437 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5438 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5439
5440 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5441 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5442 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5443
5444 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5445 @cindex program entry point
5446 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5447 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5448 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5449 @code{main}@footnote{
5450 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5451 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5452 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5453 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5454 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5455 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5456
5457 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5458 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5459
5460 @table @code
5461 @item set backtrace past-main
5462 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5463 @kindex set backtrace
5464 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5465
5466 @item set backtrace past-main off
5467 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5468 default.
5469
5470 @item show backtrace past-main
5471 @kindex show backtrace
5472 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5473
5474 @item set backtrace past-entry
5475 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5476 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5477 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5478 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5479
5480 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5481 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5482 application. This is the default.
5483
5484 @item show backtrace past-entry
5485 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5486
5487 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5488 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5489 @cindex backtrace limit
5490 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5491 unlimited.
5492
5493 @item show backtrace limit
5494 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5495 @end table
5496
5497 @node Selection
5498 @section Selecting a Frame
5499
5500 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5501 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5502 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5503 of the stack frame just selected.
5504
5505 @table @code
5506 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5507 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5508 @item frame @var{n}
5509 @itemx f @var{n}
5510 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5511 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5512 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5513 @code{main}.
5514
5515 @item frame @var{addr}
5516 @itemx f @var{addr}
5517 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5518 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5519 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5520 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5521 switches between them.
5522
5523 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5524 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5525
5526 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5527 pointer and a program counter.
5528
5529 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5530 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5531
5532 @kindex up
5533 @item up @var{n}
5534 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5535 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5536 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5537
5538 @kindex down
5539 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5540 @item down @var{n}
5541 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5542 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5543 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5544 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5545 @end table
5546
5547 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5548 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5549 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5550 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5551
5552 @need 1000
5553 For example:
5554
5555 @smallexample
5556 @group
5557 (@value{GDBP}) up
5558 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5559 at env.c:10
5560 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5561 @end group
5562 @end smallexample
5563
5564 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5565 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5566 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5567 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5568 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5569 for details.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex down-silently
5573 @kindex up-silently
5574 @item up-silently @var{n}
5575 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5576 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5577 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5578 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5579 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5580 distracting.
5581 @end table
5582
5583 @node Frame Info
5584 @section Information About a Frame
5585
5586 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5587 stack frame.
5588
5589 @table @code
5590 @item frame
5591 @itemx f
5592 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5593 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5594 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5595 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5596 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5597
5598 @kindex info frame
5599 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5600 @item info frame
5601 @itemx info f
5602 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5603 including:
5604
5605 @itemize @bullet
5606 @item
5607 the address of the frame
5608 @item
5609 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5610 @item
5611 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5612 @item
5613 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5614 @item
5615 the address of the frame's arguments
5616 @item
5617 the address of the frame's local variables
5618 @item
5619 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5620 @item
5621 which registers were saved in the frame
5622 @end itemize
5623
5624 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5625 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5626 the usual conventions.
5627
5628 @item info frame @var{addr}
5629 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5630 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5631 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5632 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5633 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5634 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5635
5636 @kindex info args
5637 @item info args
5638 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5639
5640 @item info locals
5641 @kindex info locals
5642 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5643 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5644 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5645
5646 @kindex info catch
5647 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5648 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5649 @item info catch
5650 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5651 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5652 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5653 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5654 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5655
5656 @end table
5657
5658
5659 @node Source
5660 @chapter Examining Source Files
5661
5662 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5663 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5664 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5665 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5666 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5667 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5668 source files by explicit command.
5669
5670 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5671 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5672 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5673
5674 @menu
5675 * List:: Printing source lines
5676 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5677 * Edit:: Editing source files
5678 * Search:: Searching source files
5679 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5680 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5681 @end menu
5682
5683 @node List
5684 @section Printing Source Lines
5685
5686 @kindex list
5687 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5688 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5689 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5690 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5691 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5692
5693 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5694
5695 @table @code
5696 @item list @var{linenum}
5697 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5698 current source file.
5699
5700 @item list @var{function}
5701 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5702 @var{function}.
5703
5704 @item list
5705 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5706 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5707 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5708 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5709 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5710
5711 @item list -
5712 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5713 @end table
5714
5715 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5716 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5717 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5718
5719 @table @code
5720 @kindex set listsize
5721 @item set listsize @var{count}
5722 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5723 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5724
5725 @kindex show listsize
5726 @item show listsize
5727 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5728 @end table
5729
5730 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5731 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5732 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5733 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5734 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5735
5736 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5737 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5738 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5739 to specify some source line.
5740
5741 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5742
5743 @table @code
5744 @item list @var{linespec}
5745 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5746
5747 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5748 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5749 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5750 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5751 the same source file as the first linespec.
5752
5753 @item list ,@var{last}
5754 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5755
5756 @item list @var{first},
5757 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5758
5759 @item list +
5760 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5761
5762 @item list -
5763 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5764
5765 @item list
5766 As described in the preceding table.
5767 @end table
5768
5769 @node Specify Location
5770 @section Specifying a Location
5771 @cindex specifying location
5772 @cindex linespec
5773
5774 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5775 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5776 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5777 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5778
5779 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5780 @value{GDBN} understands:
5781
5782 @table @code
5783 @item @var{linenum}
5784 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5785
5786 @item -@var{offset}
5787 @itemx +@var{offset}
5788 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5789 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5790 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5791 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5792 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5793 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5794 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5795 linespec.
5796
5797 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5798 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5799
5800 @item @var{function}
5801 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5802 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5803
5804 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5805 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5806 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5807 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5808 functions in different source files.
5809
5810 @item *@var{address}
5811 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5812 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5813 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5814 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5815 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5816 source files.
5817
5818 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5819 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5820 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5821 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5822 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5823 of @var{address}:
5824
5825 @table @code
5826 @item @var{expression}
5827 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5828
5829 @item @var{funcaddr}
5830 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5831 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5832 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5833 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5834 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5835 (although the Pascal form also works).
5836
5837 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5838 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5839
5840 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5841 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5842 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5843 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5844 functions with identical names in different source files.
5845 @end table
5846
5847 @end table
5848
5849
5850 @node Edit
5851 @section Editing Source Files
5852 @cindex editing source files
5853
5854 @kindex edit
5855 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5856 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5857 The editing program of your choice
5858 is invoked with the current line set to
5859 the active line in the program.
5860 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5861 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5862
5863 @table @code
5864 @item edit @var{location}
5865 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5866 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5867 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5868 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5869 command most commonly used:
5870
5871 @table @code
5872 @item edit @var{number}
5873 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5874
5875 @item edit @var{function}
5876 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5877 @end table
5878
5879 @end table
5880
5881 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5882 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5883 @footnote{
5884 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5885 following command-line syntax:
5886 @smallexample
5887 ex +@var{number} file
5888 @end smallexample
5889 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5890 the file where to start editing.}.
5891 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5892 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5893 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5894 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5895 @smallexample
5896 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5897 export EDITOR
5898 gdb @dots{}
5899 @end smallexample
5900 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5901 @smallexample
5902 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5903 gdb @dots{}
5904 @end smallexample
5905
5906 @node Search
5907 @section Searching Source Files
5908 @cindex searching source files
5909
5910 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5911 regular expression.
5912
5913 @table @code
5914 @kindex search
5915 @kindex forward-search
5916 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5917 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5918 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5919 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5920 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5921 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5922 @code{fo}.
5923
5924 @kindex reverse-search
5925 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5926 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5927 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5928 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5929 this command as @code{rev}.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 @node Source Path
5933 @section Specifying Source Directories
5934
5935 @cindex source path
5936 @cindex directories for source files
5937 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5938 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5939 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5940 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5941 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5942 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5943 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5944
5945 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5946 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5947 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5948 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5949 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5950 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5951 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5952 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5953 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5954 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5955 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5956
5957 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5958 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5959 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5960 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5961 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5962 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5963
5964 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5965 source files.
5966
5967 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5968 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5969 each line is in the file.
5970
5971 @kindex directory
5972 @kindex dir
5973 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5974 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5975 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5976
5977 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5978 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5979
5980 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5981 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5982 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5983 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5984 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5985 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5986 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5987 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5988 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5989 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5990 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5991 name to look up the sources.
5992
5993 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5994 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5995 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5996 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5997 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5998 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5999 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6000 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6001
6002 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6003 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6004 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6005 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6006 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6007 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6008 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6009
6010 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6011 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6012 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6013 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6014 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6015 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6016 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6017 command.
6018
6019 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6020 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6021 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6022 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6023 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6024 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6025 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6026
6027 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6028 @cindex default source path substitution
6029 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6030 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6031 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6032 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6033 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6034 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6035 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6036 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6037 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6038 together.
6039
6040 @table @code
6041 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6042 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6043 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6044 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6045 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6046 part of absolute file names) or
6047 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6048 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6049
6050 @kindex cdir
6051 @kindex cwd
6052 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6053 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6054 @cindex compilation directory
6055 @cindex current directory
6056 @cindex working directory
6057 @cindex directory, current
6058 @cindex directory, compilation
6059 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6060 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6061 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6062 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6063 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6064 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6065
6066 @item directory
6067 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6068
6069 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6070 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6071
6072 @item show directories
6073 @kindex show directories
6074 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6075
6076 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6077 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6078 @kindex set substitute-path
6079 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6080 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6081 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6082
6083 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6084 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6085
6086 @smallexample
6087 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @noindent
6091 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6092 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6093 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6094
6095 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6096 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6097 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6098 the substitution.
6099
6100 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6101
6102 @smallexample
6103 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6104 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6105 @end smallexample
6106
6107 @noindent
6108 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6109 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6110 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6111 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6112
6113
6114 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6115 @kindex unset substitute-path
6116 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6117 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6118 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6119
6120 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6121
6122 @item show substitute-path [path]
6123 @kindex show substitute-path
6124 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6125 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6126
6127 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6128 rules.
6129
6130 @end table
6131
6132 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6133 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6134 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6135
6136 @enumerate
6137 @item
6138 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6139
6140 @item
6141 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6142 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6143 directories in one command.
6144 @end enumerate
6145
6146 @node Machine Code
6147 @section Source and Machine Code
6148 @cindex source line and its code address
6149
6150 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6151 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6152 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6153 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6154 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6155 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6156 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6157 well as hex.
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex info line
6161 @item info line @var{linespec}
6162 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6163 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6164 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6165 @end table
6166
6167 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6168 the object code for the first line of function
6169 @code{m4_changequote}:
6170
6171 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6172 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6173 @smallexample
6174 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6175 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6176 @end smallexample
6177
6178 @noindent
6179 @cindex code address and its source line
6180 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6181 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6182 @smallexample
6183 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6184 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6185 @end smallexample
6186
6187 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6188 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6189 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6190 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6191 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6192 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6193 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6194 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6195 Variables}).
6196
6197 @table @code
6198 @kindex disassemble
6199 @cindex assembly instructions
6200 @cindex instructions, assembly
6201 @cindex machine instructions
6202 @cindex listing machine instructions
6203 @item disassemble
6204 @itemx disassemble /m
6205 @itemx disassemble /r
6206 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6207 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6208 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6209 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6210 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6211 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6212 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6213 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
6214 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
6215 @end table
6216
6217 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6218 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6219
6220 @smallexample
6221 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
6222 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6223 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6224 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6225 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6226 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6227 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6228 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6229 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6230 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6231 End of assembler dump.
6232 @end smallexample
6233
6234 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
6235
6236 @smallexample
6237 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6238 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6239 5 @{
6240 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
6241 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6242 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6243 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6244 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6245
6246 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6247 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6248 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6249
6250 7 return 0;
6251 8 @}
6252 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6253 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
6254 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
6255
6256 End of assembler dump.
6257 @end smallexample
6258
6259 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6260 mnemonics or other syntax.
6261
6262 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6263 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6264 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6265 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6266 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6267
6268 @table @code
6269 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6270 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6271 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6272 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6273 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6274 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6275
6276 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6277 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6278 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6279 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6280
6281 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6282 @item show disassembly-flavor
6283 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6284 @end table
6285
6286 @table @code
6287 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6288 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6289 @item set disassemble-next-line
6290 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6291 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6292 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6293 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6294 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6295 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6296 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6297 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6298 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6299 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6300 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6301 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6302 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6303 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6304 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6305 instruction.
6306 @end table
6307
6308
6309 @node Data
6310 @chapter Examining Data
6311
6312 @cindex printing data
6313 @cindex examining data
6314 @kindex print
6315 @kindex inspect
6316 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6317 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6318 @c different window or something like that.
6319 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6320 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6321 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6322 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6323 Different Languages}).
6324
6325 @table @code
6326 @item print @var{expr}
6327 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6328 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6329 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6330 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6331 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6332 Formats}.
6333
6334 @item print
6335 @itemx print /@var{f}
6336 @cindex reprint the last value
6337 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6338 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6339 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6340 @end table
6341
6342 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6343 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6344 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6345
6346 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6347 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6348 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6349 Table}.
6350
6351 @menu
6352 * Expressions:: Expressions
6353 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6354 * Variables:: Program variables
6355 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6356 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6357 * Memory:: Examining memory
6358 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6359 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6360 * Value History:: Value history
6361 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6362 * Registers:: Registers
6363 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6364 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6365 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6366 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6367 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6368 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6369 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6370 character set than GDB does
6371 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6372 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6373 @end menu
6374
6375 @node Expressions
6376 @section Expressions
6377
6378 @cindex expressions
6379 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6380 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6381 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6382 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6383 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6384 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6385 @ref{Compilation}.
6386
6387 @cindex arrays in expressions
6388 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6389 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6390 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6391 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6392 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6393 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6394
6395 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6396 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6397 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6398 languages.
6399
6400 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6401 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6402
6403 @cindex casts, in expressions
6404 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6405 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6406 at that address in memory.
6407 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6408
6409 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6410 to programming languages:
6411
6412 @table @code
6413 @item @@
6414 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6415 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6416
6417 @item ::
6418 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6419 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6420
6421 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6422 @cindex type casting memory
6423 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6424 @cindex casts, to view memory
6425 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6426 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6427 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6428 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6429 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6430 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6431 @end table
6432
6433 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6434 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6435 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6436
6437 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6438 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6439 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6440 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6441 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6442 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6443 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6444
6445 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6446 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6447 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6448 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6449 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6450 as well.
6451
6452 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6453 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6454 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6455 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6456 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6457 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6458 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6459 choices.
6460
6461 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6462 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6463 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6464
6465 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6466 @smallexample
6467 @group
6468 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6469 [0] cancel
6470 [1] all
6471 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6472 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6473 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6474 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6475 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6476 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6477 > 2 4 6
6478 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6479 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6480 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6481 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6482 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6483 breakpoints.
6484 (@value{GDBP})
6485 @end group
6486 @end smallexample
6487
6488 @table @code
6489 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6490 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6491 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6492
6493 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6494 is ambiguous.
6495
6496 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6497 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6498 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6499 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6500 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6501 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6502 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6503 in the use of the menu.
6504
6505 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6506 when an ambiguity is detected.
6507
6508 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6509 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6510
6511 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6512 @item show multiple-symbols
6513 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6514 @end table
6515
6516 @node Variables
6517 @section Program Variables
6518
6519 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6520 in your program.
6521
6522 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6523 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6524
6525 @itemize @bullet
6526 @item
6527 global (or file-static)
6528 @end itemize
6529
6530 @noindent or
6531
6532 @itemize @bullet
6533 @item
6534 visible according to the scope rules of the
6535 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6536 @end itemize
6537
6538 @noindent This means that in the function
6539
6540 @smallexample
6541 foo (a)
6542 int a;
6543 @{
6544 bar (a);
6545 @{
6546 int b = test ();
6547 bar (b);
6548 @}
6549 @}
6550 @end smallexample
6551
6552 @noindent
6553 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6554 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6555 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6556 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6557
6558 @cindex variable name conflict
6559 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6560 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6561 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6562 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6563 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6564 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6565 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6566
6567 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6568 @ifnotinfo
6569 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6570 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6571 @end ifnotinfo
6572 @smallexample
6573 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6574 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6575 @end smallexample
6576
6577 @noindent
6578 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6579 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6580 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6581 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6582
6583 @smallexample
6584 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6585 @end smallexample
6586
6587 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6588 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6589 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6590 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6591 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6592 @c conflict?? --mew
6593
6594 @cindex wrong values
6595 @cindex variable values, wrong
6596 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6597 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6598 @quotation
6599 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6600 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6601 scope, and just before exit.
6602 @end quotation
6603 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6604 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6605 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6606 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6607 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6608 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6609 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6610 variable definitions may be gone.
6611
6612 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6613 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6614 when compiling.
6615
6616 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6617 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6618 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6619 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6620 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6621 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6622 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6623
6624 @smallexample
6625 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6626 @end smallexample
6627
6628 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6629 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6630 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6631 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6632 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6633 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6634 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6635 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6636 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6637 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6638 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6639
6640 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6641 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6642 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6643 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6644
6645 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6646 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6647 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6648 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6649 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6650 For program code
6651
6652 @smallexample
6653 char var0[] = "A";
6654 signed char var1[] = "A";
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 You get during debugging
6658 @smallexample
6659 (gdb) print var0
6660 $1 = "A"
6661 (gdb) print var1
6662 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6663 @end smallexample
6664
6665 @node Arrays
6666 @section Artificial Arrays
6667
6668 @cindex artificial array
6669 @cindex arrays
6670 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6671 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6672 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6673 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6674 program.
6675
6676 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6677 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6678 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6679 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6680 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6681 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6682 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6683 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6684 example. If a program says
6685
6686 @smallexample
6687 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6688 @end smallexample
6689
6690 @noindent
6691 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6692
6693 @smallexample
6694 p *array@@len
6695 @end smallexample
6696
6697 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6698 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6699 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6700 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6701 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6702
6703 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6704 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6705 The value need not be in memory:
6706 @smallexample
6707 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6708 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6709 @end smallexample
6710
6711 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6712 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6713 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6714 @smallexample
6715 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6716 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6717 @end smallexample
6718
6719 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6720 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6721 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6722 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6723 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6724 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6725 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6726 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6727 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6728 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6729
6730 @smallexample
6731 set $i = 0
6732 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6733 @key{RET}
6734 @key{RET}
6735 @dots{}
6736 @end smallexample
6737
6738 @node Output Formats
6739 @section Output Formats
6740
6741 @cindex formatted output
6742 @cindex output formats
6743 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6744 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6745 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6746 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6747 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6748
6749 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6750 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6751 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6752 letters supported are:
6753
6754 @table @code
6755 @item x
6756 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6757 hexadecimal.
6758
6759 @item d
6760 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6761
6762 @item u
6763 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6764
6765 @item o
6766 Print as integer in octal.
6767
6768 @item t
6769 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6770 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6771 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6772 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6773
6774 @item a
6775 @cindex unknown address, locating
6776 @cindex locate address
6777 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6778 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6779 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6780
6781 @smallexample
6782 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6783 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6784 @end smallexample
6785
6786 @noindent
6787 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6788 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6789
6790 @item c
6791 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6792 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6793 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6794 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6795
6796 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6797 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6798 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6799 data.
6800
6801 @item f
6802 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6803 using typical floating point syntax.
6804
6805 @item s
6806 @cindex printing strings
6807 @cindex printing byte arrays
6808 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6809 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6810 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6811 natural types.
6812
6813 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6814 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6815 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6816 array.
6817
6818 @item r
6819 @cindex raw printing
6820 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
6821 use a type-specific pretty-printer. The @samp{r} format bypasses any
6822 pretty-printer which might exist for the value's type.
6823 @end table
6824
6825 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6826
6827 @smallexample
6828 p/x $pc
6829 @end smallexample
6830
6831 @noindent
6832 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6833 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6834
6835 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6836 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6837 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6838
6839 @node Memory
6840 @section Examining Memory
6841
6842 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6843 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6844
6845 @cindex examining memory
6846 @table @code
6847 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6848 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6849 @itemx x @var{addr}
6850 @itemx x
6851 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6852 @end table
6853
6854 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6855 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6856 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6857 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6858 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6859
6860 @table @r
6861 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6862 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6863 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6864 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6865 @c 4.1.2.
6866
6867 @item @var{f}, the display format
6868 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6869 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6870 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6871 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6872 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6873
6874 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6875 The unit size is any of
6876
6877 @table @code
6878 @item b
6879 Bytes.
6880 @item h
6881 Halfwords (two bytes).
6882 @item w
6883 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6884 @item g
6885 Giant words (eight bytes).
6886 @end table
6887
6888 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6889 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6890 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6891
6892 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6893 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6894 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6895 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6896 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6897 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6898 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6899 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6900 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6901 a value from memory).
6902 @end table
6903
6904 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6905 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6906 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6907 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6908 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6909
6910 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6911 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6912 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6913 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6914 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6915
6916 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6917 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6918 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6919 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6920 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6921 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6922 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6923 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6924 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6925
6926 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6927 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6928 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6929 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6930 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6931 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6932 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6933
6934 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6935 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6936 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6937 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6938 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6939 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6940 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6941 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6942 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6943
6944 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6945 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6946 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6947
6948 @cindex remote memory comparison
6949 @cindex verify remote memory image
6950 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6951 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6952 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6953 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6954 situations.
6955
6956 @table @code
6957 @kindex compare-sections
6958 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6959 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6960 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6961 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6962 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6963 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6964 remote request.
6965 @end table
6966
6967 @node Auto Display
6968 @section Automatic Display
6969 @cindex automatic display
6970 @cindex display of expressions
6971
6972 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6973 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6974 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6975 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6976 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6977 The automatic display looks like this:
6978
6979 @smallexample
6980 2: foo = 38
6981 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6982 @end smallexample
6983
6984 @noindent
6985 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6986 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6987 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6988 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6989 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6990 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6991
6992 @table @code
6993 @kindex display
6994 @item display @var{expr}
6995 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6996 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6997
6998 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6999
7000 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7001 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7002 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7003 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7004 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7005
7006 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7007 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7008 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7009 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7010 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7011 @end table
7012
7013 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7014 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7015 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7016
7017 @table @code
7018 @kindex delete display
7019 @kindex undisplay
7020 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7021 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7022 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7023
7024 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7025 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7026
7027 @kindex disable display
7028 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7029 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7030 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7031 enabled again later.
7032
7033 @kindex enable display
7034 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7035 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7036 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7037
7038 @item display
7039 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7040 done when your program stops.
7041
7042 @kindex info display
7043 @item info display
7044 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7045 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7046 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7047 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7048 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7049 @end table
7050
7051 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7052 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7053 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7054 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7055 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7056 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7057 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7058 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7059 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7060 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7061 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7062
7063 @node Print Settings
7064 @section Print Settings
7065
7066 @cindex format options
7067 @cindex print settings
7068 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7069 and symbols are printed.
7070
7071 @noindent
7072 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7073
7074 @table @code
7075 @kindex set print
7076 @item set print address
7077 @itemx set print address on
7078 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7079 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7080 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7081 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7082 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7083 @code{set print address on}:
7084
7085 @smallexample
7086 @group
7087 (@value{GDBP}) f
7088 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7089 at input.c:530
7090 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7091 @end group
7092 @end smallexample
7093
7094 @item set print address off
7095 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7096 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7097
7098 @smallexample
7099 @group
7100 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7101 (@value{GDBP}) f
7102 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7103 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7104 @end group
7105 @end smallexample
7106
7107 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7108 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7109 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7110 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7111
7112 @kindex show print
7113 @item show print address
7114 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7115 @end table
7116
7117 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7118 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7119 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7120 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7121 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7122 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7123 it prints a symbolic address:
7124
7125 @table @code
7126 @item set print symbol-filename on
7127 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7128 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7129 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7130 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7131
7132 @item set print symbol-filename off
7133 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7134 default.
7135
7136 @item show print symbol-filename
7137 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7138 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7139 @end table
7140
7141 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7142 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7143 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7144
7145 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7146 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7147
7148 @table @code
7149 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7150 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7151 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7152 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7153 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7154 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7155
7156 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7157 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7158 symbolic address.
7159 @end table
7160
7161 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7162 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7163 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7164 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7165 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7166 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7167 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7168 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7169
7170 @smallexample
7171 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7172 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7173 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7174 @end smallexample
7175
7176 @quotation
7177 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7178 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7179 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7180 @end quotation
7181
7182 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7183
7184 @table @code
7185 @item set print array
7186 @itemx set print array on
7187 @cindex pretty print arrays
7188 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7189 but uses more space. The default is off.
7190
7191 @item set print array off
7192 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7193
7194 @item show print array
7195 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7196 arrays.
7197
7198 @cindex print array indexes
7199 @item set print array-indexes
7200 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7201 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7202 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7203 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7204
7205 @item set print array-indexes off
7206 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7207
7208 @item show print array-indexes
7209 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7210 arrays.
7211
7212 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7213 @cindex number of array elements to print
7214 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7215 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7216 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7217 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7218 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7219 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7220 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7221
7222 @item show print elements
7223 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7224 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7225
7226 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7227 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7228 @cindex printing frame argument values
7229 @cindex print all frame argument values
7230 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7231 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7232 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7233 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7234 values are:
7235
7236 @table @code
7237 @item all
7238 The values of all arguments are printed.
7239
7240 @item scalars
7241 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7242 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7243 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7244 only scalar arguments are shown:
7245
7246 @smallexample
7247 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7248 at frame-args.c:23
7249 @end smallexample
7250
7251 @item none
7252 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7253 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7254
7255 @smallexample
7256 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7257 at frame-args.c:23
7258 @end smallexample
7259 @end table
7260
7261 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7262 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7263 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7264 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7265 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7266 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7267 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7268 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7269 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7270 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7271
7272 @item show print frame-arguments
7273 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7274
7275 @item set print repeats
7276 @cindex repeated array elements
7277 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7278 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7279 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7280 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7281 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7282 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7283 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7284
7285 @item show print repeats
7286 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7287 elements.
7288
7289 @item set print null-stop
7290 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7291 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7292 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7293 contain only short strings.
7294 The default is off.
7295
7296 @item show print null-stop
7297 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7298 @sc{null} character.
7299
7300 @item set print pretty on
7301 @cindex print structures in indented form
7302 @cindex indentation in structure display
7303 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7304 per line, like this:
7305
7306 @smallexample
7307 @group
7308 $1 = @{
7309 next = 0x0,
7310 flags = @{
7311 sweet = 1,
7312 sour = 1
7313 @},
7314 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7315 @}
7316 @end group
7317 @end smallexample
7318
7319 @item set print pretty off
7320 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7321
7322 @smallexample
7323 @group
7324 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7325 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7326 @end group
7327 @end smallexample
7328
7329 @noindent
7330 This is the default format.
7331
7332 @item show print pretty
7333 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7334
7335 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7336 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7337 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7338 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7339 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7340 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7341 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7342 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7343
7344 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7345 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7346 international character sets, and is the default.
7347
7348 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7349 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7350
7351 @item set print union on
7352 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7353 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7354 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7355
7356 @item set print union off
7357 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7358 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7359 instead.
7360
7361 @item show print union
7362 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7363 structures and other unions.
7364
7365 For example, given the declarations
7366
7367 @smallexample
7368 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7369 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7370 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7371 Bug_forms;
7372
7373 struct thing @{
7374 Species it;
7375 union @{
7376 Tree_forms tree;
7377 Bug_forms bug;
7378 @} form;
7379 @};
7380
7381 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7382 @end smallexample
7383
7384 @noindent
7385 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7386
7387 @smallexample
7388 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7389 @end smallexample
7390
7391 @noindent
7392 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7393
7394 @smallexample
7395 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7396 @end smallexample
7397
7398 @noindent
7399 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7400 and in Pascal.
7401 @end table
7402
7403 @need 1000
7404 @noindent
7405 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7406
7407 @table @code
7408 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7409 @item set print demangle
7410 @itemx set print demangle on
7411 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7412 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7413 linkage. The default is on.
7414
7415 @item show print demangle
7416 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7417
7418 @item set print asm-demangle
7419 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7420 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7421 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7422 The default is off.
7423
7424 @item show print asm-demangle
7425 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7426 or demangled form.
7427
7428 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7429 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7430 @kindex set demangle-style
7431 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7432 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7433 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7434
7435 @table @code
7436 @item auto
7437 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7438
7439 @item gnu
7440 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7441 This is the default.
7442
7443 @item hp
7444 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7445
7446 @item lucid
7447 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7448
7449 @item arm
7450 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7451 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7452 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7453 require further enhancement to permit that.
7454
7455 @end table
7456 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7457
7458 @item show demangle-style
7459 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7460
7461 @item set print object
7462 @itemx set print object on
7463 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7464 @cindex display derived types
7465 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7466 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7467 the virtual function table.
7468
7469 @item set print object off
7470 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7471 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7472
7473 @item show print object
7474 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7475
7476 @item set print static-members
7477 @itemx set print static-members on
7478 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7479 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7480
7481 @item set print static-members off
7482 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7483
7484 @item show print static-members
7485 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7486
7487 @item set print pascal_static-members
7488 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7489 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7490 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7491 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7492
7493 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7494 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7495
7496 @item show print pascal_static-members
7497 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7498
7499 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7500 @item set print vtbl
7501 @itemx set print vtbl on
7502 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7503 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7504 @cindex VTBL display
7505 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7506 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7507 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7508
7509 @item set print vtbl off
7510 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7511
7512 @item show print vtbl
7513 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7514 @end table
7515
7516 @node Value History
7517 @section Value History
7518
7519 @cindex value history
7520 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7521 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7522 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7523 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7524 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7525 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7526 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7527 symbol table.
7528
7529 @cindex @code{$}
7530 @cindex @code{$$}
7531 @cindex history number
7532 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7533 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7534 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7535 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7536 history number.
7537
7538 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7539 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7540 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7541 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7542 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7543 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7544 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7545
7546 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7547 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7548
7549 @smallexample
7550 p *$
7551 @end smallexample
7552
7553 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7554 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 p *$.next
7558 @end smallexample
7559
7560 @noindent
7561 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7562 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7563
7564 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7565 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7566
7567 @smallexample
7568 print x
7569 set x=5
7570 @end smallexample
7571
7572 @noindent
7573 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7574 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7575
7576 @table @code
7577 @kindex show values
7578 @item show values
7579 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7580 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7581 values} does not change the history.
7582
7583 @item show values @var{n}
7584 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7585
7586 @item show values +
7587 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7588 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7589 @end table
7590
7591 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7592 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7593
7594 @node Convenience Vars
7595 @section Convenience Variables
7596
7597 @cindex convenience variables
7598 @cindex user-defined variables
7599 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7600 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7601 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7602 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7603 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7604
7605 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7606 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7607 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7608 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7609 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7610
7611 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7612 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7613 For example:
7614
7615 @smallexample
7616 set $foo = *object_ptr
7617 @end smallexample
7618
7619 @noindent
7620 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7621 @code{object_ptr}.
7622
7623 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7624 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7625 value with another assignment at any time.
7626
7627 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7628 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7629 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7630 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7631
7632 @table @code
7633 @kindex show convenience
7634 @cindex show all user variables
7635 @item show convenience
7636 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7637 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7638
7639 @kindex init-if-undefined
7640 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7641 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7642 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7643 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7644 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7645 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7646 override default values used in a command script.
7647
7648 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7649 any side-effects do not occur.
7650 @end table
7651
7652 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7653 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7654 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7655
7656 @smallexample
7657 set $i = 0
7658 print bar[$i++]->contents
7659 @end smallexample
7660
7661 @noindent
7662 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7663
7664 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7665 values likely to be useful.
7666
7667 @table @code
7668 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7669 @item $_
7670 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7671 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7672 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7673 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7674 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7675 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7676 to the type of @code{$__}.
7677
7678 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7679 @item $__
7680 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7681 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7682 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7683
7684 @item $_exitcode
7685 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7686 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7687 the program being debugged terminates.
7688
7689 @item $_siginfo
7690 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
7691 The variable @code{$_siginfo} is bound to extra signal information
7692 inspection (@pxref{extra signal information}).
7693 @end table
7694
7695 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7696 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7697 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7698
7699 @cindex convenience functions
7700 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
7701 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
7702 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
7703 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
7704 @value{GDBN}.
7705
7706 @table @code
7707 @item help function
7708 @kindex help function
7709 @cindex show all convenience functions
7710 Print a list of all convenience functions.
7711 @end table
7712
7713 @node Registers
7714 @section Registers
7715
7716 @cindex registers
7717 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7718 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7719 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7720 your machine.
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @kindex info registers
7724 @item info registers
7725 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7726 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7727
7728 @kindex info all-registers
7729 @cindex floating point registers
7730 @item info all-registers
7731 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7732 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7733
7734 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7735 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7736 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7737 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7738 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7739 @end table
7740
7741 @cindex stack pointer register
7742 @cindex program counter register
7743 @cindex process status register
7744 @cindex frame pointer register
7745 @cindex standard registers
7746 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7747 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7748 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7749 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7750 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7751 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7752 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7753 you could print the program counter in hex with
7754
7755 @smallexample
7756 p/x $pc
7757 @end smallexample
7758
7759 @noindent
7760 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7761
7762 @smallexample
7763 x/i $pc
7764 @end smallexample
7765
7766 @noindent
7767 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7768 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7769 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7770 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7771 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7772 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7773 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7774
7775 @smallexample
7776 set $sp += 4
7777 @end smallexample
7778
7779 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7780 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7781 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7782 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7783 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7784 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7785 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7786
7787 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7788 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7789 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7790 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7791 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7792 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7793 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7794
7795 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7796 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7797 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7798 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7799 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7800 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7801 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7802 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7803 prints the data in both formats.
7804
7805 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7806 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7807 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7808 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7809 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7810 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7811 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7812
7813 @smallexample
7814 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7815 $1 = @{
7816 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7817 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7818 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7819 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7820 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7821 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7822 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7823 @}
7824 @end smallexample
7825
7826 @noindent
7827 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7828 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7829 value to a @code{struct} member:
7830
7831 @smallexample
7832 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7833 @end smallexample
7834
7835 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7836 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7837 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7838 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7839 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7840 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7841
7842 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7843 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7844 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7845 frame makes no difference.
7846
7847 @node Floating Point Hardware
7848 @section Floating Point Hardware
7849 @cindex floating point
7850
7851 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7852 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7853
7854 @table @code
7855 @kindex info float
7856 @item info float
7857 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7858 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7859 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7860 the ARM and x86 machines.
7861 @end table
7862
7863 @node Vector Unit
7864 @section Vector Unit
7865 @cindex vector unit
7866
7867 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7868 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7869
7870 @table @code
7871 @kindex info vector
7872 @item info vector
7873 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7874 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7875 @end table
7876
7877 @node OS Information
7878 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7879 @cindex OS information
7880
7881 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7882 you debug your program.
7883
7884 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7885 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7886 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7887 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7888 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7889 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7890 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7891 structure.
7892
7893 @table @code
7894 @item info udot
7895 @kindex info udot
7896 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7897 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7898 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7899 the @code{examine} command.
7900 @end table
7901
7902 @cindex auxiliary vector
7903 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7904 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7905 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7906 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7907 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7908 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7909 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7910 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7911 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7912 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7913 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7914 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7915
7916 @table @code
7917 @kindex info auxv
7918 @item info auxv
7919 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7920 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7921 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7922 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7923 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7924 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7925 an unrecognized tag.
7926 @end table
7927
7928 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7929 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7930 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7931 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7932
7933 @table @code
7934 @kindex info os processes
7935 @item info os processes
7936 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7937 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7938 the command corresponding to the process.
7939 @end table
7940
7941 @node Memory Region Attributes
7942 @section Memory Region Attributes
7943 @cindex memory region attributes
7944
7945 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7946 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7947 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7948 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7949 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7950 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7951 user can override the fetched regions.
7952
7953 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7954 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7955 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7956 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7957 all memory.
7958
7959 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7960 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7961
7962 @table @code
7963 @kindex mem
7964 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7965 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7966 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7967 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7968 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7969 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7970
7971 @item mem auto
7972 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7973 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7974
7975 @kindex delete mem
7976 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7977 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7978 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7979
7980 @kindex disable mem
7981 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7982 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7983 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7984 It may be enabled again later.
7985
7986 @kindex enable mem
7987 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7988 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7989
7990 @kindex info mem
7991 @item info mem
7992 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7993 for each region:
7994
7995 @table @emph
7996 @item Memory Region Number
7997 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7998 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7999 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8000
8001 @item Lo Address
8002 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8003
8004 @item Hi Address
8005 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8006
8007 @item Attributes
8008 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8009 @end table
8010 @end table
8011
8012
8013 @subsection Attributes
8014
8015 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8016 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8017 write accesses to a memory region.
8018
8019 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8020 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8021 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8022
8023 @table @code
8024 @item ro
8025 Memory is read only.
8026 @item wo
8027 Memory is write only.
8028 @item rw
8029 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8030 @end table
8031
8032 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8033 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8034 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8035 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8036 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8037
8038 @table @code
8039 @item 8
8040 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8041 @item 16
8042 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8043 @item 32
8044 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8045 @item 64
8046 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8047 @end table
8048
8049 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8050 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8051 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8052 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8053 @c
8054 @c @table @code
8055 @c @item hwbreak
8056 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8057 @c @item swbreak (default)
8058 @c @end table
8059
8060 @subsubsection Data Cache
8061 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8062 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8063 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8064 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8065 registers.
8066
8067 @table @code
8068 @item cache
8069 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8070 @item nocache
8071 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8072 @end table
8073
8074 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8075 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8076 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8077 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8078 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8079
8080 @table @code
8081 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8082 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8083 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8084 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8085 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8086 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8087 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8088 The default value is @code{on}.
8089 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8090 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8091 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8092 @end table
8093
8094
8095 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8096 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8097 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8098 @c
8099 @c @table @code
8100 @c @item verify
8101 @c @item noverify (default)
8102 @c @end table
8103
8104 @node Dump/Restore Files
8105 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8106 @cindex dump/restore files
8107 @cindex append data to a file
8108 @cindex dump data to a file
8109 @cindex restore data from a file
8110
8111 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8112 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8113 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8114 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8115 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8116 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8117 files.
8118
8119 @table @code
8120
8121 @kindex dump
8122 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8123 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8124 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8125 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8126
8127 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8128 @table @code
8129 @item binary
8130 Raw binary form.
8131 @item ihex
8132 Intel hex format.
8133 @item srec
8134 Motorola S-record format.
8135 @item tekhex
8136 Tektronix Hex format.
8137 @end table
8138
8139 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8140 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8141 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8142 form.
8143
8144 @kindex append
8145 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8146 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8147 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8148 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8149 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8150
8151 @kindex restore
8152 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8153 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8154 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8155 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8156 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8157
8158 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8159 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8160 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8161 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8162 from that location.
8163
8164 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8165 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8166 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8167 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8168
8169 @end table
8170
8171 @node Core File Generation
8172 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8173 @cindex dump core from inferior
8174
8175 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8176 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8177 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8178 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8179 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8180 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8181 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8182
8183 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8184 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8185 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8186
8187 @table @code
8188 @kindex gcore
8189 @kindex generate-core-file
8190 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8191 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8192 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8193 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8194 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8195 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8196
8197 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8198 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8199 @end table
8200
8201 @node Character Sets
8202 @section Character Sets
8203 @cindex character sets
8204 @cindex charset
8205 @cindex translating between character sets
8206 @cindex host character set
8207 @cindex target character set
8208
8209 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8210 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8211 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8212 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8213 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8214 @dfn{target character set}.
8215
8216 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8217 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8218 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8219 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8220 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8221 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8222 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8223 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8224 character and string literals in expressions.
8225
8226 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8227 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8228 target-charset} command, described below.
8229
8230 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8231 support:
8232
8233 @table @code
8234 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8235 @kindex set target-charset
8236 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8237 list of supported target character sets, type
8238 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8239
8240 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8241 @kindex set host-charset
8242 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8243
8244 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8245 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8246 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8247 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8248 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8249
8250 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8251 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8252 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8253
8254 @item set charset @var{charset}
8255 @kindex set charset
8256 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8257 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8258 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8259 for both host and target.
8260
8261 @item show charset
8262 @kindex show charset
8263 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8264
8265 @item show host-charset
8266 @kindex show host-charset
8267 Show the name of the current host character set.
8268
8269 @item show target-charset
8270 @kindex show target-charset
8271 Show the name of the current target character set.
8272
8273 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8274 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8275 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8276 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8277 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8278 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8279
8280 @item show target-wide-charset
8281 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8282 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8283 @end table
8284
8285 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8286 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8287 @file{charset-test.c}:
8288
8289 @smallexample
8290 #include <stdio.h>
8291
8292 char ascii_hello[]
8293 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8294 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8295 char ibm1047_hello[]
8296 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8297 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8298
8299 main ()
8300 @{
8301 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8302 @}
8303 @end smallexample
8304
8305 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8306 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8307 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8308
8309 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8310
8311 @smallexample
8312 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8313 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8314 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8315 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8316 @dots{}
8317 (@value{GDBP})
8318 @end smallexample
8319
8320 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8321 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8322 strings:
8323
8324 @smallexample
8325 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8326 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8327 (@value{GDBP})
8328 @end smallexample
8329
8330 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8331 initial character set:
8332 @smallexample
8333 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8334 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8335 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8336 (@value{GDBP})
8337 @end smallexample
8338
8339 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8340 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8341 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8342 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8343 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8344
8345 @smallexample
8346 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8347 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8348 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8349 $2 = 72 'H'
8350 (@value{GDBP})
8351 @end smallexample
8352
8353 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8354 literals you use in expressions:
8355
8356 @smallexample
8357 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8358 $3 = 43 '+'
8359 (@value{GDBP})
8360 @end smallexample
8361
8362 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8363 character.
8364
8365 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8366 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8367 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8368
8369 @smallexample
8370 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8371 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8372 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8373 $5 = 200 '\310'
8374 (@value{GDBP})
8375 @end smallexample
8376
8377 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8378 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8379
8380 @smallexample
8381 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8382 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8383 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8384 @end smallexample
8385
8386 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8387 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8388 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8389 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8390 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8391
8392 @smallexample
8393 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8394 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8395 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8396 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8397 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8398 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8399 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8400 $7 = 72 '\110'
8401 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8402 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8403 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8404 $9 = 200 'H'
8405 (@value{GDBP})
8406 @end smallexample
8407
8408 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8409 string literals you use in expressions:
8410
8411 @smallexample
8412 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8413 $10 = 78 '+'
8414 (@value{GDBP})
8415 @end smallexample
8416
8417 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8418 character.
8419
8420 @node Caching Remote Data
8421 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8422 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8423
8424 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8425 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8426 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8427 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8428 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8429 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8430 volatile registers are in use.
8431
8432 @table @code
8433 @kindex set remotecache
8434 @item set remotecache on
8435 @itemx set remotecache off
8436 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8437 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8438
8439 @kindex show remotecache
8440 @item show remotecache
8441 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8442
8443 @kindex info dcache
8444 @item info dcache
8445 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8446 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8447 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8448 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8449 the data cache operation.
8450 @end table
8451
8452 @node Searching Memory
8453 @section Search Memory
8454 @cindex searching memory
8455
8456 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8457 @code{find} command.
8458
8459 @table @code
8460 @kindex find
8461 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8462 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8463 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8464 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8465 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8466 @end table
8467
8468 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8469 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8470
8471 @table @r
8472 @item @var{s}, search query size
8473 The size of each search query value.
8474
8475 @table @code
8476 @item b
8477 bytes
8478 @item h
8479 halfwords (two bytes)
8480 @item w
8481 words (four bytes)
8482 @item g
8483 giant words (eight bytes)
8484 @end table
8485
8486 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8487 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8488 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8489
8490 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8491 value's type in the current language.
8492 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8493 pattern as a mixture of types.
8494 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8495 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8496 which is typically four bytes.
8497
8498 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8499 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8500 @end table
8501
8502 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8503 (@code{"}).
8504 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8505 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8506
8507 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8508 number of matches found.
8509
8510 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8511 @samp{$_}.
8512 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8513
8514 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8515
8516 @smallexample
8517 void
8518 hello ()
8519 @{
8520 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8521 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8522 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8523 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8524 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8525 @}
8526 @end smallexample
8527
8528 @noindent
8529 you get during debugging:
8530
8531 @smallexample
8532 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8533 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8534 1 pattern found
8535 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8536 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8537 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8538 2 patterns found
8539 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8540 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8541 1 pattern found
8542 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8543 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8544 1 pattern found
8545 (gdb) print $numfound
8546 $1 = 1
8547 (gdb) print $_
8548 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8549 @end smallexample
8550
8551 @node Optimized Code
8552 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
8553 @cindex optimized code, debugging
8554 @cindex debugging optimized code
8555
8556 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
8557 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
8558 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
8559 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
8560 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
8561 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
8562 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
8563
8564 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
8565 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
8566 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
8567 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
8568
8569 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
8570 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
8571 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
8572 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
8573 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
8574 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
8575
8576 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
8577 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
8578 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
8579 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
8580 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
8581
8582 @menu
8583 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
8584 @end menu
8585
8586 @node Inline Functions
8587 @section Inline Functions
8588 @cindex inline functions, debugging
8589
8590 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
8591 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
8592 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
8593 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
8594 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
8595 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
8596 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
8597 @code{info frame} command.
8598
8599 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
8600 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
8601 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
8602 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
8603 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
8604 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
8605 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
8606 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
8607 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
8608 local variables in the caller.
8609
8610 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
8611 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
8612 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
8613 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
8614 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
8615 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
8616 instructions are executed.
8617
8618 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
8619 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
8620 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
8621 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
8622
8623 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
8624 function calls are the same as normal calls:
8625
8626 @itemize @bullet
8627 @item
8628 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
8629 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
8630 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
8631 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
8632 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
8633 function instead.
8634
8635 @item
8636 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
8637 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
8638 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
8639 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
8640 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
8641 or inside the inlined function instead.
8642
8643 @item
8644 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
8645 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
8646 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
8647 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
8648
8649 @end itemize
8650
8651
8652 @node Macros
8653 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8654
8655 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8656 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8657 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8658 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8659 where it was defined.
8660
8661 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8662 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8663 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8664 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8665
8666 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8667 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8668 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8669 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8670 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8671 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8672 see @ref{List}.
8673
8674 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8675 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8676 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8677
8678 @table @code
8679
8680 @kindex macro expand
8681 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8682 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8683 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8684 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8685 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8686 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8687 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8688 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8689 it can be any string of tokens.
8690
8691 @kindex macro exp1
8692 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8693 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8694 @cindex expand macro once
8695 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8696 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8697 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8698 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8699 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8700 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8701 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8702 can be any string of tokens.
8703
8704 @kindex info macro
8705 @cindex macro definition, showing
8706 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8707 @item info macro @var{macro}
8708 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8709 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
8710
8711 @kindex macro define
8712 @cindex user-defined macros
8713 @cindex defining macros interactively
8714 @cindex macros, user-defined
8715 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8716 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8717 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8718 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8719 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8720 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8721 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8722 @var{arglist}.
8723
8724 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8725 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8726 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8727 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8728 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8729
8730 @kindex macro undef
8731 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8732 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8733 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8734 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8735 in the program being debugged.
8736
8737 @kindex macro list
8738 @item macro list
8739 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8740 @end table
8741
8742 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8743 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8744 show our source files:
8745
8746 @smallexample
8747 $ cat sample.c
8748 #include <stdio.h>
8749 #include "sample.h"
8750
8751 #define M 42
8752 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8753
8754 main ()
8755 @{
8756 #define N 28
8757 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8758 #undef N
8759 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8760 #define N 1729
8761 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8762 @}
8763 $ cat sample.h
8764 #define Q <
8765 $
8766 @end smallexample
8767
8768 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8769 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8770 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8771 information.
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8775 $
8776 @end smallexample
8777
8778 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8779
8780 @smallexample
8781 $ gdb -nw sample
8782 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8783 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8784 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8785 (@value{GDBP})
8786 @end smallexample
8787
8788 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8789 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8790 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8794 3
8795 4 #define M 42
8796 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8797 6
8798 7 main ()
8799 8 @{
8800 9 #define N 28
8801 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8802 11 #undef N
8803 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8804 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8805 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8806 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8807 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8808 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8809 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8810 #define Q <
8811 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8812 expands to: (42 + 1)
8813 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8814 expands to: once (M + 1)
8815 (@value{GDBP})
8816 @end smallexample
8817
8818 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8819 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8820 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8821 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8822
8823 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8824 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8825
8826 @smallexample
8827 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8828 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8829 (@value{GDBP}) run
8830 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8831
8832 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8833 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8834 (@value{GDBP})
8835 @end smallexample
8836
8837 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8838
8839 @smallexample
8840 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8841 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8842 #define N 28
8843 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8844 expands to: 28 < 42
8845 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8846 $1 = 1
8847 (@value{GDBP})
8848 @end smallexample
8849
8850 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8851 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8852 thereof) in force at each point:
8853
8854 @smallexample
8855 (@value{GDBP}) next
8856 Hello, world!
8857 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8858 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8859 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8860 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8861 (@value{GDBP}) next
8862 We're so creative.
8863 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8864 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8865 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8866 #define N 1729
8867 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8868 expands to: 1729 < 42
8869 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8870 $2 = 0
8871 (@value{GDBP})
8872 @end smallexample
8873
8874 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
8875 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
8876 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
8877 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
8878
8879 @smallexample
8880 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
8881 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
8882 -D__STDC__=1
8883 (@value{GDBP})
8884 @end smallexample
8885
8886
8887 @node Tracepoints
8888 @chapter Tracepoints
8889 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8890 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8891
8892 @cindex tracepoints
8893 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8894 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8895 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8896 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8897 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8898 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8899 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8900
8901 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8902 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8903 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8904 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8905 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8906 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8907 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8908 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8909 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8910 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8911 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8912
8913 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8914 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8915 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8916 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8917 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8918 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8919 Packets}.
8920
8921 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8922
8923 @menu
8924 * Set Tracepoints::
8925 * Analyze Collected Data::
8926 * Tracepoint Variables::
8927 @end menu
8928
8929 @node Set Tracepoints
8930 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8931
8932 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8933 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
8934 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
8935 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
8936 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
8937 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
8938 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
8939
8940 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8941 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8942 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8943 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8944 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8945 tracepoint was hit.
8946
8947 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
8948 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
8949 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
8950 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
8951
8952 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8953 conditions and actions.
8954
8955 @menu
8956 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8957 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8958 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8959 * Tracepoint Conditions::
8960 * Tracepoint Actions::
8961 * Listing Tracepoints::
8962 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8963 @end menu
8964
8965 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8966 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8967
8968 @table @code
8969 @cindex set tracepoint
8970 @kindex trace
8971 @item trace @var{location}
8972 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8973 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
8974 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
8975 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
8976 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
8977 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
8978 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
8979 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
8980 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
8981
8982 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8983
8984 @smallexample
8985 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8986
8987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8988
8989 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8990
8991 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8992
8993 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8994 @end smallexample
8995
8996 @noindent
8997 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8998
8999 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9000 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9001 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9002 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9003 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9004 information on tracepoint conditions.
9005
9006 @vindex $tpnum
9007 @cindex last tracepoint number
9008 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9009 @cindex tracepoint number
9010 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9011 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9012
9013 @kindex delete tracepoint
9014 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9015 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9016 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9017 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9018 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9019
9020 Examples:
9021
9022 @smallexample
9023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9024
9025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9026 @end smallexample
9027
9028 @noindent
9029 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9030 @end table
9031
9032 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9033 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9034
9035 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9036
9037 @table @code
9038 @kindex disable tracepoint
9039 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9040 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9041 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9042 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9043 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9044
9045 @kindex enable tracepoint
9046 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9047 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9048 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9049 run.
9050 @end table
9051
9052 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9053 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9054
9055 @table @code
9056 @kindex passcount
9057 @cindex tracepoint pass count
9058 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9059 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9060 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9061 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9062 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9063 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
9064 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
9065 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
9066 user.
9067
9068 Examples:
9069
9070 @smallexample
9071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
9072 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
9073
9074 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
9075 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
9076 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9077 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
9078 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
9079 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
9080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
9081 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
9082 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
9083 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
9084 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
9085 @end smallexample
9086 @end table
9087
9088 @node Tracepoint Conditions
9089 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
9090 @cindex conditional tracepoints
9091 @cindex tracepoint conditions
9092
9093 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
9094 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
9095 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
9096 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
9097 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
9098 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
9099 is true.
9100
9101 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
9102 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
9103 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
9104 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
9105 just as with breakpoints.
9106
9107 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
9108 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
9109 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
9110 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
9111 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
9112 accesses, and so forth.
9113
9114 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
9115 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
9116 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
9117 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
9118 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
9119 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
9120 search through.
9121
9122 @smallexample
9123 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
9124 @end smallexample
9125
9126 @node Tracepoint Actions
9127 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
9128
9129 @table @code
9130 @kindex actions
9131 @cindex tracepoint actions
9132 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9133 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
9134 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
9135 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
9136 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
9137 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
9138 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
9139 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
9140 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
9141 @code{while-stepping}.
9142
9143 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
9144 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
9145 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
9146
9147 @smallexample
9148 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
9149
9150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
9151
9152 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
9156 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
9157 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
9158 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
9159 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
9160 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
9161 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
9162 @code{end} command.
9163
9164 @smallexample
9165 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9167 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
9168 > collect bar,baz
9169 > collect $regs
9170 > while-stepping 12
9171 > collect $fp, $sp
9172 > end
9173 end
9174 @end smallexample
9175
9176 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
9177 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9178 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
9179 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
9180 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
9181 special arguments are supported:
9182
9183 @table @code
9184 @item $regs
9185 collect all registers
9186
9187 @item $args
9188 collect all function arguments
9189
9190 @item $locals
9191 collect all local variables.
9192 @end table
9193
9194 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9195 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9196 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
9197
9198 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9199 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9200
9201 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9202 @item while-stepping @var{n}
9203 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
9204 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9205 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
9206 its own @code{end} command):
9207
9208 @smallexample
9209 > while-stepping 12
9210 > collect $regs, myglobal
9211 > end
9212 >
9213 @end smallexample
9214
9215 @noindent
9216 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9217 @code{stepping}.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 @node Listing Tracepoints
9221 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
9222
9223 @table @code
9224 @kindex info tracepoints
9225 @kindex info tp
9226 @cindex information about tracepoints
9227 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9228 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9229 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9230 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9231 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9232 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9233
9234 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9235 tracing:
9236
9237 @itemize @bullet
9238 @item
9239 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9240 @item
9241 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
9242 @item
9243 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
9244 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
9245 @end itemize
9246
9247 @smallexample
9248 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9249 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
9250 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9251 pass count 1200
9252 step count 20
9253 A while-stepping 20
9254 A collect globfoo, $regs
9255 A end
9256 A collect globfoo2
9257 A end
9258 (@value{GDBP})
9259 @end smallexample
9260
9261 @noindent
9262 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9263 @end table
9264
9265 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9266 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9267
9268 @table @code
9269 @kindex tstart
9270 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9271 @cindex collected data discarded
9272 @item tstart
9273 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9274 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9275 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9276 experiment.
9277
9278 @kindex tstop
9279 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9280 @item tstop
9281 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9282 stops collecting data.
9283
9284 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9285 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9286 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9287
9288 @kindex tstatus
9289 @cindex status of trace data collection
9290 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9291 @item tstatus
9292 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9293 collection.
9294 @end table
9295
9296 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9297
9298 @smallexample
9299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9301 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9302 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9303 > while-stepping 11
9304 > collect $regs
9305 > end
9306 > end
9307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9308 [time passes @dots{}]
9309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312
9313 @node Analyze Collected Data
9314 @section Using the Collected Data
9315
9316 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
9317 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
9318 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
9319 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
9320 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
9321 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
9322 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
9323 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
9324 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
9325 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
9326 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
9327 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
9328 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
9329 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
9330 the buffer will fail.
9331
9332 @menu
9333 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
9334 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
9335 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
9336 @end menu
9337
9338 @node tfind
9339 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
9340
9341 @kindex tfind
9342 @cindex select trace snapshot
9343 @cindex find trace snapshot
9344 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
9345 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
9346 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
9347 snapshot is selected.
9348
9349 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
9350
9351 @table @code
9352 @item tfind start
9353 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
9354 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
9355
9356 @item tfind none
9357 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
9358
9359 @item tfind end
9360 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
9361
9362 @item tfind
9363 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
9364
9365 @item tfind -
9366 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
9367 retracing earlier steps.
9368
9369 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
9370 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
9371 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
9372 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
9373 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
9374
9375 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
9376 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
9377 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
9378 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
9379 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
9380
9381 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9382 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
9383 addresses.
9384
9385 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9386 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
9387 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
9388
9389 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
9390 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9391 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9392 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9393 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9394 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9395 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9396 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9397 @end table
9398
9399 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9400 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9401 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9402 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9403 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9404 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9405 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9406 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9407 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9408 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9409 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9410 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9411 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9412 tracepoint as the current one.
9413
9414 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9415 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9416 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9417 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9418 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9419
9420 @smallexample
9421 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9422 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9423 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9424 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9425 > tfind
9426 > end
9427
9428 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9429 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9430 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9431 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9432 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9433 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9434 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9435 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9436 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9437 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9438 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9439 @end smallexample
9440
9441 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9442 the buffer:
9443
9444 @smallexample
9445 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9446 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9447 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9448 > tfind line
9449 > end
9450
9451 Frame 0, X = 1
9452 Frame 7, X = 2
9453 Frame 13, X = 255
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @node tdump
9457 @subsection @code{tdump}
9458 @kindex tdump
9459 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9460 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9461
9462 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9463 the current trace snapshot.
9464
9465 @smallexample
9466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9467 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9468 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9469 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9470 > end
9471
9472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9473
9474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9475 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9476 at gdb_test.c:444
9477 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9478
9479 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9480 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9481 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9482 d1 0x18 24
9483 d2 0x80 128
9484 d3 0x33 51
9485 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9486 d5 0x22 34
9487 d6 0xe0 224
9488 d7 0x380035 3670069
9489 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9490 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9491 a2 0x100 256
9492 a3 0x322000 3284992
9493 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9494 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9495 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9496 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9497 ps 0x0 0
9498 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9499 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9500 fpstatus 0x0 0
9501 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9502 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9503 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9504 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9505 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9506 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9507 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9508 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9509 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9510
9511 (@value{GDBP})
9512 @end smallexample
9513
9514 @node save-tracepoints
9515 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9516 @kindex save-tracepoints
9517 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9518
9519 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9520 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9521 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9522 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9523 Files}).
9524
9525 @node Tracepoint Variables
9526 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9527 @cindex tracepoint variables
9528 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9529
9530 @table @code
9531 @vindex $trace_frame
9532 @item (int) $trace_frame
9533 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9534 snapshot is selected.
9535
9536 @vindex $tracepoint
9537 @item (int) $tracepoint
9538 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9539
9540 @vindex $trace_line
9541 @item (int) $trace_line
9542 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9543
9544 @vindex $trace_file
9545 @item (char []) $trace_file
9546 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9547
9548 @vindex $trace_func
9549 @item (char []) $trace_func
9550 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9551 @end table
9552
9553 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9554 use @code{output} instead.
9555
9556 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9557 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9558 data.
9559
9560 @smallexample
9561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9562
9563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9564 > output $trace_file
9565 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9566 > tfind
9567 > end
9568 @end smallexample
9569
9570 @node Overlays
9571 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9572 @cindex overlays
9573
9574 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9575 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9576 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9577 use overlays.
9578
9579 @menu
9580 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9581 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9582 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9583 mapped by asking the inferior.
9584 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9585 @end menu
9586
9587 @node How Overlays Work
9588 @section How Overlays Work
9589 @cindex mapped overlays
9590 @cindex unmapped overlays
9591 @cindex load address, overlay's
9592 @cindex mapped address
9593 @cindex overlay area
9594
9595 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9596 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9597 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9598 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9599 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9600
9601 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9602 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9603 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9604 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9605 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9606 largest overlay as well.
9607
9608 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9609 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9610 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9611 there.
9612
9613 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9614 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9615 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 @group
9619 Data Instruction Larger
9620 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9621 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9622 | | | | | |
9623 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9624 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9625 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9626 | and heap | | | | | |
9627 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9628 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9629 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9630 | | | | | |
9631 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9632 address | | | | | |
9633 | overlay | <-' | | |
9634 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9635 | | <---. | | load address
9636 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9637 | | | |
9638 +-----------+ | |
9639 +-----------+
9640 | |
9641 +-----------+
9642
9643 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9644 @end group
9645 @end smallexample
9646
9647 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9648 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9649 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9650 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9651 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9652 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9653 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9654 program and the overlay area.
9655
9656 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9657 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9658 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9659 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9660 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9661 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9662 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9663
9664 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9665 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9666 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9667
9668 @itemize @bullet
9669
9670 @item
9671 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9672 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9673 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9674 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9675
9676 @item
9677 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9678 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9679 your program's performance.
9680
9681 @item
9682 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9683 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9684 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9685 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9686 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9687 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9688 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9689
9690 @item
9691 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9692 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9693 instruction and data spaces.
9694
9695 @end itemize
9696
9697 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9698 improved in many ways:
9699
9700 @itemize @bullet
9701
9702 @item
9703 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9704 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9705 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9706 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9707 area in the usual way.
9708
9709 @item
9710 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9711 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9712
9713 @item
9714 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9715 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9716 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9717 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9718 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9719 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9720 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9721
9722 @end itemize
9723
9724
9725 @node Overlay Commands
9726 @section Overlay Commands
9727
9728 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9729 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9730 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9731 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9732 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9733 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9734
9735 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9736 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9737
9738 @table @code
9739 @item overlay off
9740 @kindex overlay
9741 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9742 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9743 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9744 overlay support is disabled.
9745
9746 @item overlay manual
9747 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9748 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9749 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9750 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9751 commands described below.
9752
9753 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9754 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9755 @cindex map an overlay
9756 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9757 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9758 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9759 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9760 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9761 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9762
9763 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9764 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9765 @cindex unmap an overlay
9766 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9767 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9768 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9769 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9770
9771 @item overlay auto
9772 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9773 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9774 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9775 Overlay Debugging}.
9776
9777 @item overlay load-target
9778 @itemx overlay load
9779 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9780 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9781 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9782 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9783 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9784 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9785
9786 @item overlay list-overlays
9787 @itemx overlay list
9788 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9789 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9790 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9791
9792 @end table
9793
9794 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9795 of the function the address falls in:
9796
9797 @smallexample
9798 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9799 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9800 @end smallexample
9801 @noindent
9802 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9803 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9804 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9805 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9806
9807 @smallexample
9808 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9809 No sections are mapped.
9810 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9811 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9812 @end smallexample
9813 @noindent
9814 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9815 name normally:
9816
9817 @smallexample
9818 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9819 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9820 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9821 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9822 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9823 @end smallexample
9824
9825 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9826 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9827 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9828 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9829 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9830
9831 @itemize @bullet
9832 @item
9833 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9834 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9835 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9836 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9837 @item
9838 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9839 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9840 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9841 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9842 breakpoints properly.
9843 @end itemize
9844
9845
9846 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9847 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9848 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9849
9850 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9851 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9852 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9853 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9854 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9855 current state of the overlays.
9856
9857 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9858 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9859
9860 @table @asis
9861
9862 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9863 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9864
9865 @smallexample
9866 struct
9867 @{
9868 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9869 unsigned long vma;
9870
9871 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9872 unsigned long size;
9873
9874 /* The overlay's load address. */
9875 unsigned long lma;
9876
9877 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9878 zero otherwise. */
9879 unsigned long mapped;
9880 @}
9881 @end smallexample
9882
9883 @item @code{_novlys}:
9884 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9885 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9886
9887 @end table
9888
9889 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9890 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9891 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9892 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9893 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9894 currently mapped.
9895
9896 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9897 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9898 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9899 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9900 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9901 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9902 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9903 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9904 are not being executed.
9905
9906 @node Overlay Sample Program
9907 @section Overlay Sample Program
9908 @cindex overlay example program
9909
9910 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9911 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9912 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9913 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9914 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9915 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9916 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9917
9918 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9919 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9920 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9921 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9922
9923 @table @file
9924 @item overlays.c
9925 The main program file.
9926 @item ovlymgr.c
9927 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9928 @item foo.c
9929 @itemx bar.c
9930 @itemx baz.c
9931 @itemx grbx.c
9932 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9933 @item d10v.ld
9934 @itemx m32r.ld
9935 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9936 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9937 @end table
9938
9939 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9940 cross-compiler like this:
9941
9942 @smallexample
9943 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9944 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9945 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9946 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9947 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9948 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9949 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9950 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9951 @end smallexample
9952
9953 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9954 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9955 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9956
9957
9958 @node Languages
9959 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9960 @cindex languages
9961
9962 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9963 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9964 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9965 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9966 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9967 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9968
9969 @cindex working language
9970 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9971 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9972 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9973 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9974 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9975 language}.
9976
9977 @menu
9978 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9979 * Show:: Displaying the language
9980 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9981 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9982 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9983 @end menu
9984
9985 @node Setting
9986 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9987
9988 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9989 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9990 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9991 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9992 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9993 are printed, etc.
9994
9995 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9996 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9997 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9998 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9999 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
10000 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
10001 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
10002 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
10003 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
10004 Displaying the Language}.
10005
10006 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
10007 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
10008 another language. In that case, make the
10009 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
10010 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
10011 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
10012
10013 @menu
10014 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
10015 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
10016 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
10017 @end menu
10018
10019 @node Filenames
10020 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
10021
10022 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
10023 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
10024
10025 @table @file
10026 @item .ada
10027 @itemx .ads
10028 @itemx .adb
10029 @itemx .a
10030 Ada source file.
10031
10032 @item .c
10033 C source file
10034
10035 @item .C
10036 @itemx .cc
10037 @itemx .cp
10038 @itemx .cpp
10039 @itemx .cxx
10040 @itemx .c++
10041 C@t{++} source file
10042
10043 @item .m
10044 Objective-C source file
10045
10046 @item .f
10047 @itemx .F
10048 Fortran source file
10049
10050 @item .mod
10051 Modula-2 source file
10052
10053 @item .s
10054 @itemx .S
10055 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
10056 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
10057 @end table
10058
10059 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
10060 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
10061
10062 @node Manually
10063 @subsection Setting the Working Language
10064
10065 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
10066 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
10067 your program.
10068
10069 @kindex set language
10070 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
10071 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
10072 a language, such as
10073 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
10074 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
10075
10076 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
10077 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
10078 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
10079 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
10080 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
10081 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
10082 command such as:
10083
10084 @smallexample
10085 print a = b + c
10086 @end smallexample
10087
10088 @noindent
10089 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
10090 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
10091 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
10092 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
10093
10094 @node Automatically
10095 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
10096
10097 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
10098 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
10099 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
10100 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
10101 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
10102 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
10103 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
10104 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
10105 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
10106
10107 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
10108 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
10109 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
10110 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
10111 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
10112
10113 @node Show
10114 @section Displaying the Language
10115
10116 The following commands help you find out which language is the
10117 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
10118
10119 @table @code
10120 @item show language
10121 @kindex show language
10122 Display the current working language. This is the
10123 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
10124 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
10125
10126 @item info frame
10127 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
10128 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
10129 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
10130 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
10131 information listed here.
10132
10133 @item info source
10134 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
10135 Display the source language of this source file.
10136 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
10137 information listed here.
10138 @end table
10139
10140 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
10141 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
10142 with a language explicitly:
10143
10144 @table @code
10145 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
10146 @kindex set extension-language
10147 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
10148 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
10149
10150 @item info extensions
10151 @kindex info extensions
10152 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
10153 @end table
10154
10155 @node Checks
10156 @section Type and Range Checking
10157
10158 @quotation
10159 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
10160 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
10161 section documents the intended facilities.
10162 @end quotation
10163 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
10164
10165 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
10166 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
10167 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
10168 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
10169 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
10170 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
10171 errors when your program is running.
10172
10173 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
10174 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
10175 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
10176 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
10177 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
10178 automatically based on your program's source language.
10179 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
10180 settings of supported languages.
10181
10182 @menu
10183 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
10184 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
10185 @end menu
10186
10187 @cindex type checking
10188 @cindex checks, type
10189 @node Type Checking
10190 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
10191
10192 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10193 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10194 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10195 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10196
10197 @smallexample
10198 1 + 2 @result{} 3
10199 @exdent but
10200 @error{} 1 + 2.3
10201 @end smallexample
10202
10203 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10204 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10205
10206 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
10207 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
10208 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
10209 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
10210 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
10211 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
10212 also issues a warning.
10213
10214 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
10215 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
10216 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
10217 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
10218 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
10219 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
10220
10221 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
10222 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
10223 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
10224 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
10225 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
10226 details on specific languages.
10227
10228 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
10229
10230 @kindex set check type
10231 @kindex show check type
10232 @table @code
10233 @item set check type auto
10234 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
10235 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10236 each language.
10237
10238 @item set check type on
10239 @itemx set check type off
10240 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10241 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
10242 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
10243 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
10244 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
10245
10246 @item set check type warn
10247 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
10248 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
10249 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
10250 numbers and structures.
10251
10252 @item show type
10253 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
10254 is setting it automatically.
10255 @end table
10256
10257 @cindex range checking
10258 @cindex checks, range
10259 @node Range Checking
10260 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
10261
10262 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
10263 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
10264 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
10265 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
10266 not exceed the bounds of the array.
10267
10268 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
10269 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
10270 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
10271 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
10272
10273 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
10274 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
10275 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
10276 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
10277 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
10278 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
10279
10280 @smallexample
10281 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
10282 @end smallexample
10283
10284 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
10285 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
10286 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
10287
10288 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
10289
10290 @kindex set check range
10291 @kindex show check range
10292 @table @code
10293 @item set check range auto
10294 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
10295 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10296 each language.
10297
10298 @item set check range on
10299 @itemx set check range off
10300 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10301 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
10302 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
10303 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
10304
10305 @item set check range warn
10306 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
10307 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
10308 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
10309 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
10310 systems).
10311
10312 @item show range
10313 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
10314 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
10315 @end table
10316
10317 @node Supported Languages
10318 @section Supported Languages
10319
10320 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
10321 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
10322 @c This is false ...
10323 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
10324 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
10325 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
10326 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
10327 language.
10328
10329 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
10330 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
10331 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
10332 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
10333 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
10334 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
10335 language reference or tutorial.
10336
10337 @menu
10338 * C:: C and C@t{++}
10339 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
10340 * Fortran:: Fortran
10341 * Pascal:: Pascal
10342 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
10343 * Ada:: Ada
10344 @end menu
10345
10346 @node C
10347 @subsection C and C@t{++}
10348
10349 @cindex C and C@t{++}
10350 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
10351
10352 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
10353 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
10354 together.
10355
10356 @cindex C@t{++}
10357 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
10358 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
10359 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
10360 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
10361 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
10362 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
10363 compiler (@code{aCC}).
10364
10365 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
10366 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
10367 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
10368 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
10369 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
10370 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10371
10372 @menu
10373 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
10374 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
10375 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
10376 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
10377 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
10378 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
10379 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
10380 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
10381 @end menu
10382
10383 @node C Operators
10384 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
10385
10386 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
10387
10388 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10389 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10390 often defined on groups of types.
10391
10392 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10393
10394 @itemize @bullet
10395
10396 @item
10397 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10398 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10399
10400 @item
10401 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10402 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10403
10404 @item
10405 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10406
10407 @item
10408 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10409
10410 @end itemize
10411
10412 @noindent
10413 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10414 in order of increasing precedence:
10415
10416 @table @code
10417 @item ,
10418 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10419 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10420 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10421
10422 @item =
10423 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10424 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10425
10426 @item @var{op}=
10427 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10428 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10429 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10430 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10431 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10432
10433 @item ?:
10434 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10435 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10436 integral type.
10437
10438 @item ||
10439 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10440
10441 @item &&
10442 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10443
10444 @item |
10445 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10446
10447 @item ^
10448 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10449
10450 @item &
10451 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10452
10453 @item ==@r{, }!=
10454 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10455 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10456
10457 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10458 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10459 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10460 and non-zero for true.
10461
10462 @item <<@r{, }>>
10463 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10464
10465 @item @@
10466 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10467
10468 @item +@r{, }-
10469 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10470 pointer types.
10471
10472 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10473 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10474 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10475 integral types.
10476
10477 @item ++@r{, }--
10478 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10479 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10480 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10481 operation takes place.
10482
10483 @item *
10484 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10485 @code{++}.
10486
10487 @item &
10488 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10489
10490 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10491 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10492 to examine the address
10493 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10494 stored.
10495
10496 @item -
10497 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10498 precedence as @code{++}.
10499
10500 @item !
10501 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10502 @code{++}.
10503
10504 @item ~
10505 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10506 @code{++}.
10507
10508
10509 @item .@r{, }->
10510 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10511 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10512 pointer based on the stored type information.
10513 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10514
10515 @item .*@r{, }->*
10516 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10517
10518 @item []
10519 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10520 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10521
10522 @item ()
10523 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10524
10525 @item ::
10526 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10527 and @code{class} types.
10528
10529 @item ::
10530 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10531 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10532 above.
10533 @end table
10534
10535 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10536 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10537 predefined meaning.
10538
10539 @node C Constants
10540 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10541
10542 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10543
10544 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10545 following ways:
10546
10547 @itemize @bullet
10548 @item
10549 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10550 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10551 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10552 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10553 @code{long} value.
10554
10555 @item
10556 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10557 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10558 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10559 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10560 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10561 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10562 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10563 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10564 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10565 constant.
10566
10567 @item
10568 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10569 integral equivalents.
10570
10571 @item
10572 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10573 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10574 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10575 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10576 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10577 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10578 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10579 @samp{\n} for newline.
10580
10581 @item
10582 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10583 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10584 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10585 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10586 characters.
10587
10588 @item
10589 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10590 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10591
10592 @item
10593 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10594 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10595 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10596 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10597 @end itemize
10598
10599 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10600 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10601
10602 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10603 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10604
10605 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10606 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10607 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10608 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10609 @quotation
10610 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10611 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10612 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10613 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10614 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10615 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10616 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10617 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10618 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10619 C@t{++} code.
10620 @end quotation
10621
10622 @enumerate
10623
10624 @cindex member functions
10625 @item
10626 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10627
10628 @smallexample
10629 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10630 @end smallexample
10631
10632 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10633 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10634 @item
10635 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10636 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10637 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10638 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10639
10640 @cindex call overloaded functions
10641 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10642 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10643 @item
10644 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10645 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10646 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10647 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10648 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10649 default arguments.
10650
10651 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10652 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10653 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10654 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10655 number of function arguments.
10656
10657 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10658 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10659 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10660
10661 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10662 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10663 @smallexample
10664 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10665 @end smallexample
10666
10667 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10668 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10669
10670 @cindex reference declarations
10671 @item
10672 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10673 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10674 dereferenced.
10675
10676 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10677 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10678 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10679 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10680 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10681
10682 @item
10683 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10684 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10685 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10686 necessary, for example in an expression like
10687 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10688 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10689 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10690 @end enumerate
10691
10692 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10693 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10694 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10695 invoking user-defined operators.
10696
10697 @node C Defaults
10698 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10699
10700 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10701
10702 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10703 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10704 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10705 selects the working language.
10706
10707 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10708 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10709 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10710 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10711 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10712 for further details.
10713
10714 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10715 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10716 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10717
10718 @node C Checks
10719 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10720
10721 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10722
10723 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10724 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10725 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10726
10727 @itemize @bullet
10728 @item
10729 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10730 enumerated tag.
10731
10732 @item
10733 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10734 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10735
10736 @ignore
10737 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10738 @c FIXME--beers?
10739 @item
10740 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10741 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10742 compilers.)
10743 @end ignore
10744 @end itemize
10745
10746 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10747 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10748 that is not itself an array.
10749
10750 @node Debugging C
10751 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10752
10753 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10754 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10755 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10756 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10757
10758 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10759 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10760 ,Expressions}.
10761
10762 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10763 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10764
10765 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10766
10767 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10768 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10769
10770 @table @code
10771 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10772 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10773 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10774 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10775 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10776 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10777
10778 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10779 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10780 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10781 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10782 classes.
10783 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10784
10785 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10786 @item catch throw
10787 @itemx catch catch
10788 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10789 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10790
10791 @cindex inheritance
10792 @item ptype @var{typename}
10793 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10794 @var{typename}.
10795 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10796
10797 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10798 @item set print demangle
10799 @itemx show print demangle
10800 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10801 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10802 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10803 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10804 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10805
10806 @item set print object
10807 @itemx show print object
10808 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10809 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10810
10811 @item set print vtbl
10812 @itemx show print vtbl
10813 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10814 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10815 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10816 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10817
10818 @kindex set overload-resolution
10819 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10820 @item set overload-resolution on
10821 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10822 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10823 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10824 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10825 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10826 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10827
10828 @item set overload-resolution off
10829 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10830 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10831 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10832 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10833 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10834 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10835 argument types.
10836
10837 @kindex show overload-resolution
10838 @item show overload-resolution
10839 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10840
10841 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10842 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10843 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10844 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10845 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10846 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10847 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10848 @end table
10849
10850 @node Decimal Floating Point
10851 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10852 @cindex decimal floating point format
10853
10854 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10855 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10856 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10857 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10858
10859 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10860 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10861 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10862 target.
10863
10864 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10865 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10866 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10867
10868 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10869 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10870 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10871
10872 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10873 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
10874 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10875
10876 @node Objective-C
10877 @subsection Objective-C
10878
10879 @cindex Objective-C
10880 This section provides information about some commands and command
10881 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10882 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10883 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10884
10885 @menu
10886 * Method Names in Commands::
10887 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10888 @end menu
10889
10890 @node Method Names in Commands
10891 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10892
10893 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10894 names as line specifications:
10895
10896 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10897 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10898 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10899 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10900 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10901 @itemize
10902 @item @code{clear}
10903 @item @code{break}
10904 @item @code{info line}
10905 @item @code{jump}
10906 @item @code{list}
10907 @end itemize
10908
10909 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10910
10911 @smallexample
10912 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10913 @end smallexample
10914
10915 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10916 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10917 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10918 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10919 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10920 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10921 debugged, enter:
10922
10923 @smallexample
10924 break -[Fruit create]
10925 @end smallexample
10926
10927 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10928 enter:
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 list +[NSText initialize]
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10935 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10936 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10937 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10938
10939 @smallexample
10940 break create
10941 @end smallexample
10942
10943 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10944 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10945 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10946 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10947 none apply.
10948
10949 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10950 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10951
10952 @smallexample
10953 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10954 @end smallexample
10955
10956 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10957 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10958 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10959 @kindex print-object
10960 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10961
10962 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10963
10964 @smallexample
10965 print -[@var{object} hash]
10966 @end smallexample
10967
10968 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10969 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10970 @noindent
10971 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10972 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10973 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10974 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10975 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10976 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10977
10978 @node Fortran
10979 @subsection Fortran
10980 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10981
10982 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10983 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10984
10985 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10986 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10987 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10988 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10989 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10990 underscore.
10991
10992 @menu
10993 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10994 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10995 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10996 @end menu
10997
10998 @node Fortran Operators
10999 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
11000
11001 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
11002
11003 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11004 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
11005 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
11006
11007 @table @code
11008 @item **
11009 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
11010 of the second one.
11011
11012 @item :
11013 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
11014 represent a section of array.
11015
11016 @item %
11017 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
11018 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
11019 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
11020 union type.
11021 @end table
11022
11023 @node Fortran Defaults
11024 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
11025
11026 @cindex Fortran Defaults
11027
11028 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
11029 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
11030 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
11031 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
11032
11033 @node Special Fortran Commands
11034 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
11035
11036 @cindex Special Fortran commands
11037
11038 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
11039 such as displaying common blocks.
11040
11041 @table @code
11042 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
11043 @kindex info common
11044 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
11045 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
11046 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
11047 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
11048 printed.
11049 @end table
11050
11051 @node Pascal
11052 @subsection Pascal
11053
11054 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
11055 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
11056 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
11057 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
11058 syntax.
11059
11060 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
11061 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
11062 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
11063
11064 @node Modula-2
11065 @subsection Modula-2
11066
11067 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
11068
11069 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
11070 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
11071 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
11072 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11073 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
11074 table.
11075
11076 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
11077 @menu
11078 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
11079 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
11080 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
11081 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
11082 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
11083 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
11084 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
11085 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11086 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11087 @end menu
11088
11089 @node M2 Operators
11090 @subsubsection Operators
11091 @cindex Modula-2 operators
11092
11093 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11094 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11095 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
11096 following definitions hold:
11097
11098 @itemize @bullet
11099
11100 @item
11101 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
11102 their subranges.
11103
11104 @item
11105 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
11106
11107 @item
11108 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
11109
11110 @item
11111 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
11112 @var{type}}.
11113
11114 @item
11115 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
11116
11117 @item
11118 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
11119
11120 @item
11121 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
11122 @end itemize
11123
11124 @noindent
11125 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
11126 increasing precedence:
11127
11128 @table @code
11129 @item ,
11130 Function argument or array index separator.
11131
11132 @item :=
11133 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
11134 @var{value}.
11135
11136 @item <@r{, }>
11137 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
11138 types.
11139
11140 @item <=@r{, }>=
11141 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
11142 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
11143 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
11144
11145 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
11146 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
11147 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
11148 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
11149 comment character.
11150
11151 @item IN
11152 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
11153 Same precedence as @code{<}.
11154
11155 @item OR
11156 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11157
11158 @item AND@r{, }&
11159 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11160
11161 @item @@
11162 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11163
11164 @item +@r{, }-
11165 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
11166 and difference on set types.
11167
11168 @item *
11169 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
11170 on set types.
11171
11172 @item /
11173 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
11174 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
11175
11176 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
11177 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
11178 precedence as @code{*}.
11179
11180 @item -
11181 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
11182
11183 @item ^
11184 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
11185
11186 @item NOT
11187 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
11188 @code{^}.
11189
11190 @item .
11191 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
11192 precedence as @code{^}.
11193
11194 @item []
11195 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11196
11197 @item ()
11198 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
11199 as @code{^}.
11200
11201 @item ::@r{, }.
11202 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
11203 @end table
11204
11205 @quotation
11206 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
11207 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
11208 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
11209 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
11210 @end quotation
11211
11212
11213 @node Built-In Func/Proc
11214 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
11215 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
11216
11217 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
11218 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
11219
11220 @table @var
11221
11222 @item a
11223 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
11224
11225 @item c
11226 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
11227
11228 @item i
11229 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
11230
11231 @item m
11232 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
11233 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
11234 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
11235
11236 @item n
11237 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
11238
11239 @item r
11240 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
11241
11242 @item t
11243 represents a type.
11244
11245 @item v
11246 represents a variable.
11247
11248 @item x
11249 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
11250 explanation of the function for details.
11251 @end table
11252
11253 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
11254
11255 @table @code
11256 @item ABS(@var{n})
11257 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
11258
11259 @item CAP(@var{c})
11260 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
11261 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
11262
11263 @item CHR(@var{i})
11264 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11265
11266 @item DEC(@var{v})
11267 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11268
11269 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
11270 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11271 new value.
11272
11273 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11274 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
11275 set.
11276
11277 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
11278 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
11279
11280 @item HIGH(@var{a})
11281 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
11282
11283 @item INC(@var{v})
11284 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11285
11286 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
11287 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11288 new value.
11289
11290 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11291 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
11292 there. Returns the new set.
11293
11294 @item MAX(@var{t})
11295 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
11296
11297 @item MIN(@var{t})
11298 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
11299
11300 @item ODD(@var{i})
11301 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
11302
11303 @item ORD(@var{x})
11304 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
11305 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
11306 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
11307 integral, character and enumerated types.
11308
11309 @item SIZE(@var{x})
11310 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11311
11312 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
11313 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
11314
11315 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
11316 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11317
11318 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
11319 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11320 @end table
11321
11322 @quotation
11323 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
11324 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
11325 an error.
11326 @end quotation
11327
11328 @cindex Modula-2 constants
11329 @node M2 Constants
11330 @subsubsection Constants
11331
11332 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
11333 ways:
11334
11335 @itemize @bullet
11336
11337 @item
11338 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
11339 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
11340 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
11341 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
11342
11343 @item
11344 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
11345 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
11346 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
11347 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
11348 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
11349 digits.
11350
11351 @item
11352 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
11353 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
11354 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
11355 followed by a @samp{C}.
11356
11357 @item
11358 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
11359 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
11360 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
11361 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
11362 sequences.
11363
11364 @item
11365 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
11366
11367 @item
11368 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
11369 @code{FALSE}.
11370
11371 @item
11372 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
11373
11374 @item
11375 Set constants are not yet supported.
11376 @end itemize
11377
11378 @node M2 Types
11379 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
11380 @cindex Modula-2 types
11381
11382 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
11383 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
11384 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
11385 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
11386 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
11387 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
11388
11389 The first example contains the following section of code:
11390
11391 @smallexample
11392 VAR
11393 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11394 r: [20..40] ;
11395 @end smallexample
11396
11397 @noindent
11398 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11399 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11403 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11404 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11405 SET OF CHAR
11406 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11407 21
11408 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11409 [20..40]
11410 @end smallexample
11411
11412 @noindent
11413 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11414
11415 @smallexample
11416 VAR
11417 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11418 @end smallexample
11419
11420 @noindent
11421 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11422
11423 @smallexample
11424 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11425 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11426 @end smallexample
11427
11428 @noindent
11429 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11430 expressions using the debugger.
11431
11432 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11433 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11434
11435 @smallexample
11436 VAR
11437 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11438 @end smallexample
11439
11440 @smallexample
11441 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11442 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11443 @end smallexample
11444
11445 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11446 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11447 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11448 above.
11449
11450 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11451
11452 @smallexample
11453 TYPE
11454 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11455 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11456 VAR
11457 s: t ;
11458 BEGIN
11459 s := blue ;
11460 @end smallexample
11461
11462 @noindent
11463 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11464 and value of a variable.
11465
11466 @smallexample
11467 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11468 $1 = blue
11469 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11470 type = [blue..yellow]
11471 @end smallexample
11472
11473 @noindent
11474 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11475 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11476 their @code{C} counterparts.
11477
11478 @smallexample
11479 VAR
11480 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11481 BEGIN
11482 s[1] := 1 ;
11483 @end smallexample
11484
11485 @smallexample
11486 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11487 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11488 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11489 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11490 @end smallexample
11491
11492 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11493 pointer types as shown in this example:
11494
11495 @smallexample
11496 VAR
11497 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11498 BEGIN
11499 NEW(s) ;
11500 s^[1] := 1 ;
11501 @end smallexample
11502
11503 @noindent
11504 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11505
11506 @smallexample
11507 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11508 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11509 @end smallexample
11510
11511 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11512 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11513 types:
11514
11515 @smallexample
11516 TYPE
11517 foo = RECORD
11518 f1: CARDINAL ;
11519 f2: CHAR ;
11520 f3: myarray ;
11521 END ;
11522
11523 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11524 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11525 VAR
11526 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11527 @end smallexample
11528
11529 @noindent
11530 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11531 below.
11532
11533 @smallexample
11534 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11535 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11536 f1 : CARDINAL;
11537 f2 : CHAR;
11538 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11539 END
11540 @end smallexample
11541
11542 @node M2 Defaults
11543 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11544 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11545
11546 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11547 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11548 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11549 selected the working language.
11550
11551 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11552 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11553 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11554 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11555
11556 @node Deviations
11557 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11558 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11559
11560 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11561 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11562
11563 @itemize @bullet
11564 @item
11565 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11566 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11567 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11568 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11569 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11570 returned a pointer.)
11571
11572 @item
11573 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11574 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11575 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11576 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11577
11578 @item
11579 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11580 argument.
11581
11582 @item
11583 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11584 @end itemize
11585
11586 @node M2 Checks
11587 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11588 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11589
11590 @quotation
11591 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11592 range checking.
11593 @end quotation
11594 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11595
11596 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11597
11598 @itemize @bullet
11599 @item
11600 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11601 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11602
11603 @item
11604 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11605 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11606 @end itemize
11607
11608 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11609 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11610
11611 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11612 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11613
11614 @node M2 Scope
11615 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11616 @cindex scope
11617 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11618 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11619 @ifinfo
11620 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11621 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11622 @end ifinfo
11623 @ifnotinfo
11624 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11625 @end ifnotinfo
11626
11627 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11628 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11629 similar syntax:
11630
11631 @smallexample
11632
11633 @var{module} . @var{id}
11634 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11635 @end smallexample
11636
11637 @noindent
11638 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11639 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11640 identifier within your program, except another module.
11641
11642 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11643 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11644 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11645 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11646
11647 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11648 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11649 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11650 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11651 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11652 @var{module}.
11653
11654 @node GDB/M2
11655 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11656
11657 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11658 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11659 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11660 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11661 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11662 analogue in Modula-2.
11663
11664 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11665 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11666 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11667 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11668 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11669 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11670
11671 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11672 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11673 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11674
11675 @node Ada
11676 @subsection Ada
11677 @cindex Ada
11678
11679 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11680 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11681 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11682 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11683 to be difficult.
11684
11685
11686 @cindex expressions in Ada
11687 @menu
11688 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11689 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11690 in @value{GDBN}.
11691 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11692 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11693 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11694 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11695 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11696 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11697 @end menu
11698
11699 @node Ada Mode Intro
11700 @subsubsection Introduction
11701 @cindex Ada mode, general
11702
11703 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11704 syntax, with some extensions.
11705 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11706
11707 @itemize @bullet
11708 @item
11709 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11710 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11711 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11712 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11713
11714 @item
11715 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11716 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11717
11718 @item
11719 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11720 @end itemize
11721
11722 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11723 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11724 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11725 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11726 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11727
11728 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11729 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11730 was translated from an Ada source file.
11731
11732 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11733 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11734 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11735 middle (to allow based literals).
11736
11737 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11738 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11739 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11740 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11741 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11742 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11743
11744 @node Omissions from Ada
11745 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11746 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11747
11748 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11749
11750 @itemize @bullet
11751 @item
11752 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11753
11754 @itemize @minus
11755 @item
11756 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11757 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11758
11759 @item
11760 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11761
11762 @item
11763 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11764
11765 @item
11766 @t{'Tag}.
11767
11768 @item
11769 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11770 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11771
11772 @item
11773 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11774 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11775
11776 @item
11777 @t{'Address}.
11778 @end itemize
11779
11780 @item
11781 The names in
11782 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11783 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11784 not currently available.
11785
11786 @item
11787 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11788 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11789 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11790 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11791 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11792 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11793 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11794 indeterminate values.
11795
11796 @item
11797 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11798 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11799 are not implemented.
11800
11801 @item
11802 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11803 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11804 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11805 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11806 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11807
11808 @smallexample
11809 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11810 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11811 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11812 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11813 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11814 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11815 @end smallexample
11816
11817 Changing a
11818 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11819 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11820 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11821 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11822 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11823 declared to have a type such as:
11824
11825 @smallexample
11826 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11827 Id : Integer;
11828 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11829 end record;
11830 @end smallexample
11831
11832 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11833 assignments:
11834
11835 @smallexample
11836 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11837 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11838 @end smallexample
11839
11840 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11841 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11842 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11843 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11844 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11845 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11846 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11847 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11848
11849 @item
11850 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11851
11852 @item
11853 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11854 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11855 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11856 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11857 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11858 the proper resolution.
11859
11860 @item
11861 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11862
11863 @item
11864 Entry calls are not implemented.
11865
11866 @item
11867 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11868 formats are not supported.
11869
11870 @item
11871 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11872
11873 @item
11874 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11875 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11876 context.
11877 Should your program
11878 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11879 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11880 @end itemize
11881
11882 @node Additions to Ada
11883 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11884 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11885
11886 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11887 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11888
11889 @itemize @bullet
11890 @item
11891 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11892 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11893 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11894 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11895 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11896 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11897 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11898 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11899
11900 @item
11901 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11902 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11903 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11904
11905 @item
11906 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11907 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11908
11909 @item
11910 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11911 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11912 @end itemize
11913
11914 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11915 additions specific to Ada:
11916
11917 @itemize @bullet
11918 @item
11919 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11920 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11921
11922 @smallexample
11923 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11924 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11925 @end smallexample
11926
11927 @item
11928 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11929 the value of its right-hand operand.
11930 This allows, for example,
11931 complex conditional breaks:
11932
11933 @smallexample
11934 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11935 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11936 @end smallexample
11937
11938 @item
11939 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11940 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11941 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11942 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11943 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11944 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11945 in strings. For example,
11946 @smallexample
11947 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11948 @end smallexample
11949 @noindent
11950 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11951 after each period.
11952
11953 @item
11954 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11955 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11956 to write
11957
11958 @smallexample
11959 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11960 @end smallexample
11961
11962 @item
11963 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11964 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11965 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11966 of 3 might print as
11967
11968 @smallexample
11969 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11970 @end smallexample
11971
11972 @noindent
11973 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11974 clause.
11975
11976 @item
11977 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11978 multi-character subsequence of
11979 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11980 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11981 in place of @t{a'length}.
11982
11983 @item
11984 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11985 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11986 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11987 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11988 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11989 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11990 For example,
11991 @smallexample
11992 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11993 @end smallexample
11994
11995 @item
11996 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11997 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11998 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11999 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
12000 object.
12001
12002 @end itemize
12003
12004 @node Stopping Before Main Program
12005 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
12006
12007 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
12008 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
12009 before reaching the main procedure.
12010 As defined in the Ada Reference
12011 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
12012 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
12013 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
12014 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
12015
12016 @node Ada Tasks
12017 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
12018 @cindex Ada, tasking
12019
12020 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
12021 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
12022
12023 @table @code
12024 @kindex info tasks
12025 @item info tasks
12026 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
12027
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 @iftex
12031 @leftskip=0.5cm
12032 @end iftex
12033 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12034 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12035 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12036 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
12037 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
12038 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
12039
12040 @end smallexample
12041
12042 @noindent
12043 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
12044 task currently being inspected.
12045
12046 @table @asis
12047 @item ID
12048 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
12049
12050 @item TID
12051 The Ada task ID.
12052
12053 @item P-ID
12054 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
12055
12056 @item Pri
12057 The base priority of the task.
12058
12059 @item State
12060 Current state of the task.
12061
12062 @table @code
12063 @item Unactivated
12064 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
12065 executing.
12066
12067 @item Runnable
12068 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
12069 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
12070
12071 @item Terminated
12072 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
12073 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
12074 terminated themselves.
12075
12076 @item Child Activation Wait
12077 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
12078
12079 @item Accept Statement
12080 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
12081
12082 @item Waiting on entry call
12083 The task is waiting on an entry call.
12084
12085 @item Async Select Wait
12086 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
12087 select statement.
12088
12089 @item Delay Sleep
12090 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
12091 alternative open.
12092
12093 @item Child Termination Wait
12094 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
12095 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
12096 waiting on a terminate Phase.
12097
12098 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
12099 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
12100 finish terminating.
12101
12102 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
12103 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
12104 @end table
12105
12106 @item Name
12107 Name of the task in the program.
12108
12109 @end table
12110
12111 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
12112 @item info task @var{taskno}
12113 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
12114 the following example:
12115 @smallexample
12116 @iftex
12117 @leftskip=0.5cm
12118 @end iftex
12119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12121 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12122 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
12123 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
12124 Ada Task: 0x807c468
12125 Name: task_1
12126 Thread: 0x807f378
12127 Parent: 1 (main_task)
12128 Base Priority: 15
12129 State: Runnable
12130 @end smallexample
12131
12132 @item task
12133 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
12134 @cindex current Ada task ID
12135 This command prints the ID of the current task.
12136
12137 @smallexample
12138 @iftex
12139 @leftskip=0.5cm
12140 @end iftex
12141 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12142 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12143 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12144 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12145 (@value{GDBP}) task
12146 [Current task is 2]
12147 @end smallexample
12148
12149 @item task @var{taskno}
12150 @cindex Ada task switching
12151 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
12152 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
12153 from the current task to the given task.
12154
12155 @smallexample
12156 @iftex
12157 @leftskip=0.5cm
12158 @end iftex
12159 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12160 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12161 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12162 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12163 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
12164 [Switching to task 1]
12165 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12166 (@value{GDBP}) bt
12167 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12168 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
12169 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
12170 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
12171 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
12172 @end smallexample
12173
12174 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
12175 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
12176 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
12177 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
12178 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
12179 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
12180 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
12181 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
12182 in @ref{Specify Location}.
12183
12184 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
12185 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
12186 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
12187 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
12188 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
12189
12190 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
12191 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
12192 program.
12193
12194 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12195 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12196 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12197
12198 For example,
12199
12200 @smallexample
12201 @iftex
12202 @leftskip=0.5cm
12203 @end iftex
12204 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12205 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12206 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12207 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
12208 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12209 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
12210 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
12211 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
12212 (@value{GDBP}) cont
12213 Continuing.
12214 task # 1 running
12215 task # 2 running
12216
12217 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
12218 15 flush;
12219 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12220 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12221 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12222 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
12223 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
12224 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
12225 @end smallexample
12226 @end table
12227
12228 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
12229 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12230 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
12231
12232 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
12233 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
12234 the platform being used.
12235 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
12236 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
12237 as usual.
12238
12239 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
12240 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
12241 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
12242 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
12243 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
12244 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
12245
12246 @node Ada Glitches
12247 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
12248 @cindex Ada, problems
12249
12250 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
12251 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
12252 @value{GDBN},
12253 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
12254 and the GNU Ada compiler.
12255
12256 @itemize @bullet
12257 @item
12258 Currently, the debugger
12259 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
12260 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
12261 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
12262 to get it printed properly.
12263
12264 @item
12265 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
12266 storage are invisible to the debugger.
12267
12268 @item
12269 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
12270 argument lists are treated as positional).
12271
12272 @item
12273 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
12274
12275 @item
12276 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
12277 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
12278 the host machine.
12279
12280 @item
12281 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
12282 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
12283 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
12284 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
12285 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
12286 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
12287 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
12288 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
12289 you can usually resolve the confusion
12290 by qualifying the problematic names with package
12291 @code{Standard} explicitly.
12292 @end itemize
12293
12294 @node Unsupported Languages
12295 @section Unsupported Languages
12296
12297 @cindex unsupported languages
12298 @cindex minimal language
12299 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
12300 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
12301 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
12302 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
12303 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
12304 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
12305
12306 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
12307 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
12308 language.
12309
12310 @node Symbols
12311 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
12312
12313 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
12314 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
12315 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
12316 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
12317 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
12318 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
12319 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12320
12321 @cindex symbol names
12322 @cindex names of symbols
12323 @cindex quoting names
12324 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
12325 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
12326 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
12327 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
12328 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
12329 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
12330 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
12331 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
12332
12333 @smallexample
12334 p 'foo.c'::x
12335 @end smallexample
12336
12337 @noindent
12338 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
12339
12340 @table @code
12341 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
12342 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
12343 @kindex set case-sensitive
12344 @item set case-sensitive on
12345 @itemx set case-sensitive off
12346 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
12347 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
12348 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
12349 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
12350 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
12351 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
12352 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
12353 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
12354 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
12355 case-insensitive matches.
12356
12357 @kindex show case-sensitive
12358 @item show case-sensitive
12359 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
12360 lookups.
12361
12362 @kindex info address
12363 @cindex address of a symbol
12364 @item info address @var{symbol}
12365 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
12366 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
12367 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
12368 is always stored.
12369
12370 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
12371 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
12372 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
12373
12374 @kindex info symbol
12375 @cindex symbol from address
12376 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
12377 @item info symbol @var{addr}
12378 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
12379 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
12380 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
12381
12382 @smallexample
12383 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
12384 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
12385 @end smallexample
12386
12387 @noindent
12388 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
12389 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
12390
12391 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12392 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12393
12394 @smallexample
12395 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12396 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12397 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12398 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12399 @end smallexample
12400
12401 @kindex whatis
12402 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12403 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12404 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12405 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12406 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12407 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12408 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12409 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12410 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12411 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12412 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12413
12414 @kindex ptype
12415 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12416 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12417 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12418 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12419
12420 For example, for this variable declaration:
12421
12422 @smallexample
12423 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12424 @end smallexample
12425
12426 @noindent
12427 the two commands give this output:
12428
12429 @smallexample
12430 @group
12431 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12432 type = struct complex
12433 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12434 type = struct complex @{
12435 double real;
12436 double imag;
12437 @}
12438 @end group
12439 @end smallexample
12440
12441 @noindent
12442 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12443 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12444
12445 @cindex incomplete type
12446 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12447 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12448 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12449 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12450 given these declarations:
12451
12452 @smallexample
12453 struct foo;
12454 struct foo *fooptr;
12455 @end smallexample
12456
12457 @noindent
12458 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12459
12460 @smallexample
12461 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12462 $1 = <incomplete type>
12463 @end smallexample
12464
12465 @noindent
12466 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12467 completely specified.
12468
12469 @kindex info types
12470 @item info types @var{regexp}
12471 @itemx info types
12472 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12473 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12474 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12475 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12476 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12477 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12478 name is @code{value}.
12479
12480 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12481 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12482 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12483
12484 @kindex info scope
12485 @cindex local variables
12486 @item info scope @var{location}
12487 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12488 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12489 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12490 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12491 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12492
12493 @smallexample
12494 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12495 Scope for command_line_handler:
12496 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12497 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12498 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12499 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12500 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12501 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12502 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12503 @end smallexample
12504
12505 @noindent
12506 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12507 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12508 collect}.
12509
12510 @kindex info source
12511 @item info source
12512 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12513 the function containing the current point of execution:
12514 @itemize @bullet
12515 @item
12516 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12517 @item
12518 the directory it was compiled in,
12519 @item
12520 its length, in lines,
12521 @item
12522 which programming language it is written in,
12523 @item
12524 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12525 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12526 @item
12527 whether the debugging information includes information about
12528 preprocessor macros.
12529 @end itemize
12530
12531
12532 @kindex info sources
12533 @item info sources
12534 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12535 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12536 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12537
12538 @kindex info functions
12539 @item info functions
12540 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12541
12542 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12543 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12544 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12545 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12546 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12547 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12548 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12549 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12550
12551 @kindex info variables
12552 @item info variables
12553 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12554 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12555
12556 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12557 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12558 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12559 @var{regexp}.
12560
12561 @kindex info classes
12562 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12563 @item info classes
12564 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12565 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12566 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12567 expression.
12568
12569 @kindex info selectors
12570 @item info selectors
12571 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12572 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12573 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12574 expression.
12575
12576 @ignore
12577 This was never implemented.
12578 @kindex info methods
12579 @item info methods
12580 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12581 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12582 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12583 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12584 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12585 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12586 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12587 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12588 @end ignore
12589
12590 @cindex reloading symbols
12591 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12592 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12593 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12594 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12595 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12596
12597 @table @code
12598 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12599 @item set symbol-reloading on
12600 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12601 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12602
12603 @item set symbol-reloading off
12604 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12605 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12606 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12607 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12608 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12609 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12610 name.
12611
12612 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12613 @item show symbol-reloading
12614 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12615 @end table
12616
12617 @cindex opaque data types
12618 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12619 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12620 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12621 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12622 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12623 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12624 another source file. The default is on.
12625
12626 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12627 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12628
12629 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12630 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12631 is printed as follows:
12632 @smallexample
12633 @{<no data fields>@}
12634 @end smallexample
12635
12636 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12637 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12638 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12639
12640 @kindex maint print symbols
12641 @cindex symbol dump
12642 @kindex maint print psymbols
12643 @cindex partial symbol dump
12644 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12645 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12646 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12647 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12648 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12649 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12650 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12651 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12652 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12653 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12654 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12655 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12656 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12657 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12658 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12659 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12660 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12661
12662 @kindex maint info symtabs
12663 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12664 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12665 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12666 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12667 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12668 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12669 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12670
12671 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12672 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12673 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12674 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12675 structure in more detail. For example:
12676
12677 @smallexample
12678 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12679 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12680 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12681 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12682 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12683 readin no
12684 fullname (null)
12685 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12686 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12687 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12688 dependencies (none)
12689 @}
12690 @}
12691 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12692 (@value{GDBP})
12693 @end smallexample
12694 @noindent
12695 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12696 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12697 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12698 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12699 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12700
12701 @smallexample
12702 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12703 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12704 line 1574.
12705 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12706 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12707 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12708 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12709 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12710 dirname (null)
12711 fullname (null)
12712 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12713 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12714 debugformat DWARF 2
12715 @}
12716 @}
12717 (@value{GDBP})
12718 @end smallexample
12719 @end table
12720
12721
12722 @node Altering
12723 @chapter Altering Execution
12724
12725 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12726 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12727 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12728 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12729 program.
12730
12731 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12732 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12733 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12734
12735 @menu
12736 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12737 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12738 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12739 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12740 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12741 * Patching:: Patching your program
12742 @end menu
12743
12744 @node Assignment
12745 @section Assignment to Variables
12746
12747 @cindex assignment
12748 @cindex setting variables
12749 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12750 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12751
12752 @smallexample
12753 print x=4
12754 @end smallexample
12755
12756 @noindent
12757 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12758 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12759 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12760 information on operators in supported languages.
12761
12762 @kindex set variable
12763 @cindex variables, setting
12764 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12765 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12766 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12767 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12768 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12769
12770 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12771 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12772 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12773 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12774 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12775 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12776 command @code{set width}:
12777
12778 @smallexample
12779 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12780 type = double
12781 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12782 $4 = 13
12783 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12784 Invalid syntax in expression.
12785 @end smallexample
12786
12787 @noindent
12788 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12789 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12790
12791 @smallexample
12792 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12793 @end smallexample
12794
12795 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12796 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12797 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12798 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12799 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12800 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 @group
12804 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12805 type = double
12806 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12807 $1 = 1
12808 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12809 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12810 $2 = 1
12811 (@value{GDBP}) r
12812 The program being debugged has been started already.
12813 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12814 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12815 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12816 Invalid bfd target.
12817 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12818 The current BFD target is "=4".
12819 @end group
12820 @end smallexample
12821
12822 @noindent
12823 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12824 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12825 @code{g}, use
12826
12827 @smallexample
12828 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12829 @end smallexample
12830
12831 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12832 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12833 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12834 same length or shorter.
12835 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12836 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12837
12838 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12839 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12840 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12841 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12842 and representation in memory), and
12843
12844 @smallexample
12845 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12846 @end smallexample
12847
12848 @noindent
12849 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12850
12851 @node Jumping
12852 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12853
12854 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12855 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12856 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12857
12858 @table @code
12859 @kindex jump
12860 @item jump @var{linespec}
12861 @itemx jump @var{location}
12862 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12863 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12864 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12865 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12866 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12867 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12868
12869 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12870 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12871 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12872 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12873 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12874 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12875 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12876 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12877 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12878 @end table
12879
12880 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12881 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12882 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12883 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12884 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12885 example,
12886
12887 @smallexample
12888 set $pc = 0x485
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 @noindent
12892 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12893 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12894 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12895
12896 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12897 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12898 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12899 detail.
12900
12901 @c @group
12902 @node Signaling
12903 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12904 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12905
12906 @table @code
12907 @kindex signal
12908 @item signal @var{signal}
12909 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12910 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12911 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12912 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12913
12914 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12915 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12916 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12917 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12918 signal.
12919
12920 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12921 after executing the command.
12922 @end table
12923 @c @end group
12924
12925 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12926 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12927 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12928 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12929 passes the signal directly to your program.
12930
12931
12932 @node Returning
12933 @section Returning from a Function
12934
12935 @table @code
12936 @cindex returning from a function
12937 @kindex return
12938 @item return
12939 @itemx return @var{expression}
12940 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12941 command. If you give an
12942 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12943 value.
12944 @end table
12945
12946 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12947 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12948 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12949 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12950
12951 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12952 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12953 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12954 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12955 of functions.
12956
12957 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12958 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12959 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12960 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12961 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12962
12963 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
12964 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
12965 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
12966 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
12967 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
12968 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
12969 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
12970 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
12971 assignment into the right register(s).
12972
12973 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
12974 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
12975 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
12976 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
12977 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
12978 into a @code{long long int}:
12979
12980 @smallexample
12981 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
12982 29 return 31;
12983 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12984 Make func return now? (y or n) y
12985 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
12986 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
12987 (@value{GDBP})
12988 @end smallexample
12989
12990 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
12991 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
12992 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
12993 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
12994 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
12995 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
12996 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
12997 an appropriate cast explicitly:
12998
12999 @smallexample
13000 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
13001 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13002 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
13003 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
13004 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
13005 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
13006 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
13007 (@value{GDBP})
13008 @end smallexample
13009
13010 @node Calling
13011 @section Calling Program Functions
13012
13013 @table @code
13014 @cindex calling functions
13015 @cindex inferior functions, calling
13016 @item print @var{expr}
13017 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
13018 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
13019 debugged.
13020
13021 @kindex call
13022 @item call @var{expr}
13023 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
13024 returned values.
13025
13026 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
13027 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
13028 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
13029 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
13030 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
13031 value history.
13032 @end table
13033
13034 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
13035 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
13036 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
13037 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
13038
13039 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
13040 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
13041 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
13042 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
13043 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
13044 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
13045 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
13046 in that case is controlled by the
13047 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
13048
13049 @table @code
13050 @item set unwindonsignal
13051 @kindex set unwindonsignal
13052 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
13053 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
13054 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
13055 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
13056 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
13057 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
13058 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
13059 received.
13060
13061 @item show unwindonsignal
13062 @kindex show unwindonsignal
13063 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13064 @value{GDBN}.
13065
13066 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13067 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13068 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
13069 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
13070 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
13071 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
13072 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
13073 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
13074 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
13075 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
13076
13077 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13078 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13079 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13080 @value{GDBN}.
13081
13082 @end table
13083
13084 @cindex weak alias functions
13085 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
13086 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
13087 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
13088 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
13089 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
13090 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
13091 function instead.
13092
13093 @node Patching
13094 @section Patching Programs
13095
13096 @cindex patching binaries
13097 @cindex writing into executables
13098 @cindex writing into corefiles
13099
13100 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
13101 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
13102 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
13103 patching your program's binary.
13104
13105 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
13106 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
13107 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
13108 repairs.
13109
13110 @table @code
13111 @kindex set write
13112 @item set write on
13113 @itemx set write off
13114 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
13115 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
13116 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
13117
13118 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
13119 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
13120 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
13121
13122 @item show write
13123 @kindex show write
13124 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
13125 as well as reading.
13126 @end table
13127
13128 @node GDB Files
13129 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
13130
13131 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
13132 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
13133 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
13134 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
13135
13136 @menu
13137 * Files:: Commands to specify files
13138 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
13139 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
13140 * Data Files:: GDB data files
13141 @end menu
13142
13143 @node Files
13144 @section Commands to Specify Files
13145
13146 @cindex symbol table
13147 @cindex core dump file
13148
13149 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
13150 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
13151 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
13152 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
13153
13154 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
13155 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
13156 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
13157 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
13158 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
13159 new files are useful.
13160
13161 @table @code
13162 @cindex executable file
13163 @kindex file
13164 @item file @var{filename}
13165 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
13166 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
13167 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
13168 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
13169 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
13170 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
13171 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
13172 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
13173
13174 @cindex unlinked object files
13175 @cindex patching object files
13176 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
13177 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
13178 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
13179 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
13180 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
13181 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
13182 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
13183 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
13184
13185 @item file
13186 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
13187 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
13188
13189 @kindex exec-file
13190 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13191 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
13192 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
13193 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
13194 discard information on the executable file.
13195
13196 @kindex symbol-file
13197 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
13198 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
13199 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
13200 table and program to run from the same file.
13201
13202 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
13203 program's symbol table.
13204
13205 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
13206 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
13207 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
13208 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
13209 @value{GDBN}.
13210
13211 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
13212 executing it once.
13213
13214 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
13215 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
13216 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
13217 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
13218 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
13219 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
13220 optimized code.
13221
13222 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
13223 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
13224 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
13225 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
13226 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
13227
13228 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
13229 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
13230 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
13231 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
13232 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
13233 Warnings and Messages}.)
13234
13235 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
13236 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
13237 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
13238 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
13239 in stabs format.
13240
13241 @kindex readnow
13242 @cindex reading symbols immediately
13243 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
13244 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13245 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13246 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
13247 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
13248 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
13249 entire symbol table available.
13250
13251 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
13252 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
13253 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
13254 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
13255 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
13256 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
13257 @c files.
13258
13259 @kindex core-file
13260 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
13261 @itemx core
13262 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
13263 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
13264 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
13265 executable file itself for other parts.
13266
13267 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
13268 to be used.
13269
13270 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
13271 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
13272 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
13273 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
13274 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
13275
13276 @kindex add-symbol-file
13277 @cindex dynamic linking
13278 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
13279 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13280 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
13281 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
13282 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
13283 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
13284 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
13285 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
13286 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
13287 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
13288 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
13289 @var{address} as an expression.
13290
13291 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
13292 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
13293 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
13294 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
13295 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
13296
13297 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
13298 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
13299 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
13300 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
13301 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
13302 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
13303 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
13304 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
13305 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
13306
13307 @itemize @bullet
13308 @item
13309 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
13310 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
13311 @item
13312 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
13313 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
13314 @item
13315 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
13316 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13317 @end itemize
13318
13319 @noindent
13320 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
13321 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
13322 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
13323 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
13324 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
13325 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
13326 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
13327 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
13328 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
13329 way.
13330
13331 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
13332
13333 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
13334 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
13335 @cindex load symbols from memory
13336 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
13337 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
13338 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
13339 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
13340 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
13341 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
13342 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
13343 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
13344 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
13345
13346 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
13347 @kindex assf
13348 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
13349 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
13350 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
13351 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
13352 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
13353 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
13354 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
13355 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
13356 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
13357 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
13358
13359 @kindex section
13360 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
13361 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
13362 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
13363 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
13364 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
13365 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
13366 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
13367 their addresses.
13368
13369 @kindex info files
13370 @kindex info target
13371 @item info files
13372 @itemx info target
13373 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
13374 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
13375 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
13376 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
13377 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
13378 current ones.
13379
13380 @kindex maint info sections
13381 @item maint info sections
13382 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
13383 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
13384 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
13385 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
13386 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
13387 may be arbitrarily combined):
13388
13389 @table @code
13390 @item ALLOBJ
13391 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
13392 @item @var{sections}
13393 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
13394 @item @var{section-flags}
13395 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
13396 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
13397 @table @code
13398 @item ALLOC
13399 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
13400 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
13401 @item LOAD
13402 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13403 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13404 @item RELOC
13405 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13406 @item READONLY
13407 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13408 @item CODE
13409 Section contains executable code only.
13410 @item DATA
13411 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13412 @item ROM
13413 Section will reside in ROM.
13414 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13415 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13416 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13417 Section is not empty.
13418 @item NEVER_LOAD
13419 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13420 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13421 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13422 COFF shared library information.
13423 @item IS_COMMON
13424 Section contains common symbols.
13425 @end table
13426 @end table
13427 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13428 @cindex read-only sections
13429 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13430 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13431 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13432 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13433 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13434 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13435 enhancement to debugging performance.
13436
13437 The default is off.
13438
13439 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13440 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13441 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13442 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13443
13444 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13445 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13446 @end table
13447
13448 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13449 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13450 name and remembers it that way.
13451
13452 @cindex shared libraries
13453 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13454 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13455 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13456
13457 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13458 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13459
13460 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13461 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13462 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13463 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13464 debugging a core file).
13465
13466 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13467 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13468
13469 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13470 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13471 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13472
13473 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13474 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13475 particularly large or there are many of them.
13476
13477 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13478 commands:
13479
13480 @table @code
13481 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13482 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13483 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13484 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13485 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13486 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13487 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13488 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13489
13490 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13491 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13492 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13493 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13494 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13495 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13496 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13497 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13498 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13499
13500 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13501 @item show auto-solib-add
13502 Display the current autoloading mode.
13503 @end table
13504
13505 @cindex load shared library
13506 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13507 command:
13508
13509 @table @code
13510 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13511 @kindex info share
13512 @item info share @var{regex}
13513 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13514 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
13515 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
13516 all shared libraries that are loaded.
13517
13518 @kindex sharedlibrary
13519 @kindex share
13520 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13521 @itemx share @var{regex}
13522 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13523 Unix regular expression.
13524 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13525 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13526 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13527 loaded.
13528
13529 @item nosharedlibrary
13530 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13531 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13532 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13533 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13534 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13535 discarded.
13536 @end table
13537
13538 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13539 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13540 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13541
13542 @table @code
13543 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13544 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13545 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13546 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13547 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13548 shared library.
13549
13550 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13551 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13552 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13553 library events happen.
13554 @end table
13555
13556 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13557 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13558 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13559 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13560 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13561 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13562 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13563 not.
13564
13565 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13566 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13567 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13568 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13569 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13570
13571 @table @code
13572 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13573 @cindex system root, alternate
13574 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13575 @kindex set sysroot
13576 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13577 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13578 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13579 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13580 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13581 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13582 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13583 under @var{path}.
13584
13585 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13586 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13587 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13588 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13589 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13590 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13591 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13592 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13593 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13594
13595 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13596 sysroot}.
13597
13598 @cindex default system root
13599 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13600 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13601 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13602 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13603 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13604 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13605 location.
13606
13607 @kindex show sysroot
13608 @item show sysroot
13609 Display the current shared library prefix.
13610
13611 @kindex set solib-search-path
13612 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13613 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13614 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13615 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13616 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13617 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13618 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13619 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13620 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13621 of shared library symbols.
13622
13623 @kindex show solib-search-path
13624 @item show solib-search-path
13625 Display the current shared library search path.
13626 @end table
13627
13628
13629 @node Separate Debug Files
13630 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13631 @cindex separate debugging information files
13632 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13633 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13634 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13635 @cindex global debugging information directory
13636 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13637 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13638
13639 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13640 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13641 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13642 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13643 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13644 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13645 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13646
13647 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13648 file:
13649
13650 @itemize @bullet
13651 @item
13652 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13653 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13654 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13655 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13656 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13657 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
13658 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
13659 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
13660
13661 @item
13662 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13663 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13664 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13665 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13666 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13667 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13668 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13669 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13670 below.
13671 @end itemize
13672
13673 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13674 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13675
13676 @itemize @bullet
13677 @item
13678 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13679 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13680 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13681 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13682 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13683
13684 @item
13685 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13686 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13687 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13688 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13689 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13690 hex characters, not 10.)
13691 @end itemize
13692
13693 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13694 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13695 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13696 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13697 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13698 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13699
13700 @itemize @minus
13701 @item
13702 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13703 @item
13704 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13705 @item
13706 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13707 @item
13708 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13709 @end itemize
13710
13711 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13712 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13713
13714 @table @code
13715
13716 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13717 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13718 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13719 information files to @var{directory}.
13720
13721 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13722 @item show debug-file-directory
13723 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13724 information files.
13725
13726 @end table
13727
13728 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13729 @cindex debug link sections
13730 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13731 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13732
13733 @itemize
13734 @item
13735 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13736 a zero byte,
13737 @item
13738 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13739 boundary within the section, and
13740 @item
13741 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13742 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13743 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13744 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13745 @end itemize
13746
13747 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13748 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13749 described above.
13750
13751 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13752 @cindex build ID sections
13753 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13754 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13755 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13756 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13757 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13758 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13759 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13760 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13761 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13762
13763 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13764 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13765 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13766 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13767 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13768 in an ordinary executable.
13769
13770 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13771 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13772 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13773 following commands:
13774
13775 @smallexample
13776 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13777 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13778 @end smallexample
13779
13780 @noindent
13781 These commands remove the debugging
13782 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13783 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13784 two files:
13785
13786 @itemize @bullet
13787 @item
13788 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13789 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13790
13791 @smallexample
13792 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13793 @end smallexample
13794
13795 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13796 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13797 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13798 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13799
13800 @item
13801 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13802 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13803 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13804 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13805 @end itemize
13806
13807 @noindent
13808
13809 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
13810 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
13811 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
13812
13813 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
13814 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
13815 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
13816 @c different ways!
13817 @ifhtml
13818 @display
13819 @html
13820 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
13821 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
13822 @end html
13823 @end display
13824 @end ifhtml
13825 @ifnothtml
13826 @display
13827 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
13828 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
13829 @end display
13830 @end ifnothtml
13831
13832 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
13833 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
13834 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
13835 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
13836 CRC.
13837
13838 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
13839 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
13840 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
13841 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
13842 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
13843 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
13844
13845 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
13846 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
13847 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
13848 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
13849 @code{0xffffffff}.
13850
13851 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13852 @smallexample
13853 unsigned long
13854 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13855 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13856 @{
13857 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13858 @{
13859 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13860 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13861 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13862 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13863 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13864 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13865 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13866 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13867 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13868 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13869 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13870 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13871 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13872 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13873 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13874 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13875 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13876 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13877 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13878 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13879 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13880 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13881 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13882 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13883 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13884 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13885 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13886 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13887 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13888 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13889 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13890 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13891 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13892 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13893 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13894 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13895 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13896 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13897 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13898 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13899 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13900 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13901 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13902 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13903 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13904 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13905 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13906 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13907 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13908 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13909 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13910 0x2d02ef8d
13911 @};
13912 unsigned char *end;
13913
13914 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13915 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13916 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13917 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13918 @}
13919 @end smallexample
13920
13921 @noindent
13922 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13923
13924
13925 @node Symbol Errors
13926 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13927
13928 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13929 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13930 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13931 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13932 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13933 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13934 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13935 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13936 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13937 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13938 Messages}).
13939
13940 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13941
13942 @table @code
13943 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13944
13945 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13946 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13947 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13948 in its outer scope blocks.
13949
13950 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13951 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13952 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13953 function.
13954
13955 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13956
13957 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13958 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13959 do so.
13960
13961 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13962 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13963 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13964 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13965 Messages}.)
13966
13967 @item bad block start address patched
13968
13969 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13970 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13971 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13972
13973 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13974 starting on the previous source line.
13975
13976 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13977
13978 @cindex foo
13979 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13980 larger than the size of the string table.
13981
13982 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13983 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13984 with this name.
13985
13986 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13987
13988 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13989 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13990 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13991
13992 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13993 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13994 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13995 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13996 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13997 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13998
13999 @item stub type has NULL name
14000
14001 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
14002
14003 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
14004 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
14005 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
14006 it.
14007
14008 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
14009
14010 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
14011
14012 @end table
14013
14014 @node Data Files
14015 @section GDB Data Files
14016
14017 @cindex prefix for data files
14018 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
14019 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
14020
14021 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
14022 is currently using.
14023
14024 @table @code
14025 @kindex set data-directory
14026 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
14027 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
14028 to @var{directory}.
14029
14030 @kindex show data-directory
14031 @item show data-directory
14032 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
14033 @end table
14034
14035 @cindex default data directory
14036 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
14037 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
14038 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
14039 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14040 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
14041 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14042 location.
14043
14044 @node Targets
14045 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
14046
14047 @cindex debugging target
14048 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
14049
14050 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
14051 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
14052 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
14053 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
14054 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
14055 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
14056 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
14057 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
14058
14059 @cindex target architecture
14060 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
14061 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
14062 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
14063 command.
14064
14065 @table @code
14066 @kindex set architecture
14067 @kindex show architecture
14068 @item set architecture @var{arch}
14069 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
14070 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
14071 supported architectures.
14072
14073 @item show architecture
14074 Show the current target architecture.
14075
14076 @item set processor
14077 @itemx processor
14078 @kindex set processor
14079 @kindex show processor
14080 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
14081 and @code{show architecture}.
14082 @end table
14083
14084 @menu
14085 * Active Targets:: Active targets
14086 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
14087 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
14088 @end menu
14089
14090 @node Active Targets
14091 @section Active Targets
14092
14093 @cindex stacking targets
14094 @cindex active targets
14095 @cindex multiple targets
14096
14097 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
14098 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
14099 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
14100 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
14101 a core file.
14102
14103 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
14104 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
14105 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
14106 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
14107 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
14108 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
14109 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
14110 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
14111 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
14112
14113 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
14114 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
14115 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
14116 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
14117 process target is active.
14118
14119 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
14120 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
14121 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
14122 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
14123 Process}).
14124
14125 @node Target Commands
14126 @section Commands for Managing Targets
14127
14128 @table @code
14129 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
14130 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
14131 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
14132 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
14133 protocol of the target machine.
14134
14135 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
14136 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
14137 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
14138
14139 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
14140 after executing the command.
14141
14142 @kindex help target
14143 @item help target
14144 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
14145 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
14146 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14147
14148 @item help target @var{name}
14149 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
14150 select it.
14151
14152 @kindex set gnutarget
14153 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
14154 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
14155 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
14156 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
14157 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
14158 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
14159
14160 @quotation
14161 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
14162 you must know the actual BFD name.
14163 @end quotation
14164
14165 @noindent
14166 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
14167
14168 @kindex show gnutarget
14169 @item show gnutarget
14170 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
14171 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
14172 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
14173 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
14174 @end table
14175
14176 @cindex common targets
14177 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
14178 configuration):
14179
14180 @table @code
14181 @kindex target
14182 @item target exec @var{program}
14183 @cindex executable file target
14184 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
14185 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
14186
14187 @item target core @var{filename}
14188 @cindex core dump file target
14189 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
14190 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
14191
14192 @item target remote @var{medium}
14193 @cindex remote target
14194 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
14195 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
14196 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
14197
14198 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
14199 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
14200
14201 @smallexample
14202 target remote /dev/ttya
14203 @end smallexample
14204
14205 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
14206 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
14207 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
14208 clobbered by the download.
14209
14210 @item target sim
14211 @cindex built-in simulator target
14212 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
14213 In general,
14214 @smallexample
14215 target sim
14216 load
14217 run
14218 @end smallexample
14219 @noindent
14220 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
14221 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
14222 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
14223 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
14224 Processors}.
14225
14226 @end table
14227
14228 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
14229
14230 @table @code
14231
14232 @item target nrom @var{dev}
14233 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
14234 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
14235
14236 @end table
14237
14238 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
14239 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
14240
14241 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
14242 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
14243 various aspects of this process.
14244
14245 @table @code
14246
14247 @item set hash
14248 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14249 @cindex hash mark while downloading
14250 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
14251 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
14252 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
14253 monitor.
14254
14255 @item show hash
14256 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
14257 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
14258
14259 @item set debug monitor
14260 @kindex set debug monitor
14261 @cindex display remote monitor communications
14262 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
14263 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14264
14265 @item show debug monitor
14266 @kindex show debug monitor
14267 Show the current status of displaying communications between
14268 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
14269 @end table
14270
14271 @table @code
14272
14273 @kindex load @var{filename}
14274 @item load @var{filename}
14275 @anchor{load}
14276 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
14277 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
14278 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
14279 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
14280 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
14281 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14282
14283 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
14284 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
14285 target is @dots{}}''
14286
14287 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
14288 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
14289 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
14290 specifies a fixed address.
14291 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
14292
14293 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
14294 load programs into flash memory.
14295
14296 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
14297 @end table
14298
14299 @node Byte Order
14300 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
14301
14302 @cindex choosing target byte order
14303 @cindex target byte order
14304
14305 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
14306 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
14307 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
14308 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
14309 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
14310 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
14311
14312 @table @code
14313 @kindex set endian
14314 @item set endian big
14315 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
14316
14317 @item set endian little
14318 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
14319
14320 @item set endian auto
14321 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
14322 executable.
14323
14324 @item show endian
14325 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
14326
14327 @end table
14328
14329 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
14330 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
14331 target system.
14332
14333
14334 @node Remote Debugging
14335 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
14336 @cindex remote debugging
14337
14338 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
14339 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
14340 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
14341 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
14342 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
14343
14344 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
14345 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
14346 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
14347 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
14348 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
14349 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
14350
14351 Other remote targets may be available in your
14352 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
14353
14354 @menu
14355 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
14356 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
14357 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
14358 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
14359 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
14360 @end menu
14361
14362 @node Connecting
14363 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
14364
14365 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
14366 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
14367 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
14368 program as the first argument.
14369
14370 @cindex @code{target remote}
14371 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
14372 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
14373 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
14374 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
14375 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
14376 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
14377
14378 @table @code
14379
14380 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
14381 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
14382 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
14383 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
14384
14385 @smallexample
14386 target remote /dev/ttyb
14387 @end smallexample
14388
14389 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
14390 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
14391 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
14392 @code{target} command.
14393
14394 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
14395 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14396 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
14397 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
14398 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
14399 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
14400 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
14401 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
14402 target.
14403
14404 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
14405 @code{manyfarms}:
14406
14407 @smallexample
14408 target remote manyfarms:2828
14409 @end smallexample
14410
14411 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
14412 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
14413 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
14414 port 1234 on your local machine:
14415
14416 @smallexample
14417 target remote :1234
14418 @end smallexample
14419 @noindent
14420
14421 Note that the colon is still required here.
14422
14423 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14424 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
14425 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
14426 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
14427
14428 @smallexample
14429 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
14430 @end smallexample
14431
14432 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
14433 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
14434 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
14435 cause havoc with your debugging session.
14436
14437 @item target remote | @var{command}
14438 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
14439 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
14440 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
14441 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
14442 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
14443 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
14444 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
14445 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
14446
14447 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
14448 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
14449 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
14450
14451 @end table
14452
14453 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
14454 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
14455 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
14456 need to use @kbd{run}.
14457
14458 @cindex interrupting remote programs
14459 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
14460 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
14461 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
14462 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
14463 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
14464 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
14465
14466 @smallexample
14467 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
14468 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
14469 @end smallexample
14470
14471 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14472 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14473 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14474 goes back to waiting.
14475
14476 @table @code
14477 @kindex detach (remote)
14478 @item detach
14479 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14480 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14481 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14482 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14483 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14484
14485 @kindex disconnect
14486 @item disconnect
14487 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
14488 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
14489 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
14490 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
14491 another target.
14492
14493 @cindex send command to remote monitor
14494 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
14495 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
14496 @kindex monitor
14497 @item monitor @var{cmd}
14498 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
14499 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
14500 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
14501 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
14502 and implement.
14503 @end table
14504
14505 @node File Transfer
14506 @section Sending files to a remote system
14507 @cindex remote target, file transfer
14508 @cindex file transfer
14509 @cindex sending files to remote systems
14510
14511 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
14512 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
14513 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
14514 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
14515 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
14516 the only way to upload or download files.
14517
14518 Not all remote targets support these commands.
14519
14520 @table @code
14521 @kindex remote put
14522 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
14523 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
14524 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
14525
14526 @kindex remote get
14527 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
14528 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
14529 on the host system.
14530
14531 @kindex remote delete
14532 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
14533 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
14534
14535 @end table
14536
14537 @node Server
14538 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
14539
14540 @kindex gdbserver
14541 @cindex remote connection without stubs
14542 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
14543 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
14544 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
14545
14546 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
14547 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14548 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14549 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14550 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14551 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14552 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14553 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14554 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14555 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14556 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14557 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14558 choice for debugging.
14559
14560 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14561 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14562 protocol.
14563
14564 @quotation
14565 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14566 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14567 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14568 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14569 @code{gdbserver}.
14570 @end quotation
14571
14572 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14573 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14574
14575 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14576 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14577 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14578 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14579 system does all the symbol handling.
14580
14581 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14582 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14583 syntax is:
14584
14585 @smallexample
14586 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14587 @end smallexample
14588
14589 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14590 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14591 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14592 @file{/dev/com1}:
14593
14594 @smallexample
14595 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14596 @end smallexample
14597
14598 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14599 with it.
14600
14601 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14602
14603 @smallexample
14604 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14605 @end smallexample
14606
14607 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14608 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14609 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14610 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14611 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14612 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14613 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14614 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14615 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14616 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14617 @code{target remote} command.
14618
14619 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14620
14621 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14622 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14623
14624 @smallexample
14625 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14626 @end smallexample
14627
14628 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14629 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
14630
14631 @pindex pidof
14632 @cindex attach to a program by name
14633 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
14634 @code{pidof} utility:
14635
14636 @smallexample
14637 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
14638 @end smallexample
14639
14640 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
14641 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
14642 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
14643
14644 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
14645 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
14646 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
14647
14648 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
14649 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
14650 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
14651 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
14652
14653 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
14654 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
14655 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
14656 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
14657 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
14658 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
14659 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
14660 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
14661 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
14662
14663 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
14664 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
14665 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
14666 the program you want to debug.
14667
14668 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
14669 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
14670 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
14671
14672 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
14673
14674 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
14675 status information about the debugging process. The
14676 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14677 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14678 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14679
14680 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14681 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14682 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14683 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14684
14685 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14686 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14687 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14688 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14689
14690 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14691 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14692 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14693 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14694
14695 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14696 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14697 environment:
14698
14699 @smallexample
14700 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14701 @end smallexample
14702
14703 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14704
14705 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14706
14707 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14708 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14709 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14710 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14711
14712 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14713 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14714 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14715 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14716 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14717 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14718 programs.
14719
14720 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14721 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14722 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14723 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14724 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14725 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14726 already on the target.
14727
14728 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14729 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14730 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14731
14732 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14733 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14734 Here are the available commands.
14735
14736 @table @code
14737 @item monitor help
14738 List the available monitor commands.
14739
14740 @item monitor set debug 0
14741 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14742 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14743
14744 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14745 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14746 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14747 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14748
14749 @item monitor exit
14750 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14751 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14752 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14753 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14754 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14755
14756 @end table
14757
14758 @node Remote Configuration
14759 @section Remote Configuration
14760
14761 @kindex set remote
14762 @kindex show remote
14763 This section documents the configuration options available when
14764 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14765 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14766 system-call-allowed}.
14767
14768 @table @code
14769 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14770 @cindex address size for remote targets
14771 @cindex bits in remote address
14772 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14773 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14774 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14775 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14776
14777 @item show remoteaddresssize
14778 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14779
14780 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14781 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14782 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14783 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14784 remote targets.
14785
14786 @item show remotebaud
14787 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14788
14789 @item set remotebreak
14790 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14791 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14792 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14793 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14794 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14795 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14796 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14797 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14798
14799 @item show remotebreak
14800 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14801 interrupt the remote program.
14802
14803 @item set remoteflow on
14804 @itemx set remoteflow off
14805 @kindex set remoteflow
14806 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14807 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14808
14809 @item show remoteflow
14810 @kindex show remoteflow
14811 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14812
14813 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14814 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14815 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14816 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14817 @code{ascii}.
14818
14819 @item show remotelogbase
14820 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14821 protocol.
14822
14823 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14824 @cindex record serial communications on file
14825 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14826 default is not to record at all.
14827
14828 @item show remotelogfile.
14829 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14830 serial communications.
14831
14832 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14833 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14834 @cindex remote timeout
14835 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14836 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14837
14838 @item show remotetimeout
14839 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14840 responses.
14841
14842 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14843 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14844 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14845 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14846 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14847 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14848 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14849 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14850
14851 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14852 @itemx show remote exec-file
14853 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14854 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14855 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14856 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14857 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14858 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14859
14860 @kindex set tcp
14861 @kindex show tcp
14862 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14863 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14864 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14865 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14866 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14867 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14868 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14869 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14870 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14871
14872 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14873 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14874
14875 @item show tcp auto-retry
14876 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14877
14878 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14879 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14880 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14881 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14882 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14883 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14884 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14885 value.
14886
14887 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14888 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14889 @end table
14890
14891 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14892 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14893 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14894 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14895 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14896 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14897 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14898 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14899 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14900
14901 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14902 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14903 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14904 @value{GDBN} developers.
14905
14906 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14907 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14908 are:
14909
14910 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14911 @item Command Name
14912 @tab Remote Packet
14913 @tab Related Features
14914
14915 @item @code{fetch-register}
14916 @tab @code{p}
14917 @tab @code{info registers}
14918
14919 @item @code{set-register}
14920 @tab @code{P}
14921 @tab @code{set}
14922
14923 @item @code{binary-download}
14924 @tab @code{X}
14925 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14926
14927 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14928 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14929 @tab @code{info auxv}
14930
14931 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14932 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14933 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14934
14935 @item @code{attach}
14936 @tab @code{vAttach}
14937 @tab @code{attach}
14938
14939 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14940 @tab @code{vCont}
14941 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14942
14943 @item @code{run}
14944 @tab @code{vRun}
14945 @tab @code{run}
14946
14947 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14948 @tab @code{Z0}
14949 @tab @code{break}
14950
14951 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14952 @tab @code{Z1}
14953 @tab @code{hbreak}
14954
14955 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14956 @tab @code{Z2}
14957 @tab @code{watch}
14958
14959 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14960 @tab @code{Z3}
14961 @tab @code{rwatch}
14962
14963 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14964 @tab @code{Z4}
14965 @tab @code{awatch}
14966
14967 @item @code{target-features}
14968 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14969 @tab @code{set architecture}
14970
14971 @item @code{library-info}
14972 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14973 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14974
14975 @item @code{memory-map}
14976 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14977 @tab @code{info mem}
14978
14979 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14980 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14981 @tab @code{info spu}
14982
14983 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14984 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14985 @tab @code{info spu}
14986
14987 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
14988 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
14989 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
14990
14991 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
14992 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
14993 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
14994
14995 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14996 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14997 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14998
14999 @item @code{search-memory}
15000 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
15001 @tab @code{find}
15002
15003 @item @code{supported-packets}
15004 @tab @code{qSupported}
15005 @tab Remote communications parameters
15006
15007 @item @code{pass-signals}
15008 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
15009 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
15010
15011 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
15012 @tab @code{vFile:close}
15013 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15014
15015 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
15016 @tab @code{vFile:open}
15017 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15018
15019 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
15020 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
15021 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15022
15023 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
15024 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
15025 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15026
15027 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
15028 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
15029 @tab @code{remote delete}
15030
15031 @item @code{noack-packet}
15032 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
15033 @tab Packet acknowledgment
15034
15035 @item @code{osdata}
15036 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
15037 @tab @code{info os}
15038
15039 @item @code{query-attached}
15040 @tab @code{qAttached}
15041 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
15042 @end multitable
15043
15044 @node Remote Stub
15045 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
15046
15047 @cindex debugging stub, example
15048 @cindex remote stub, example
15049 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
15050 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
15051 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
15052 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
15053 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
15054 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
15055 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
15056 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
15057
15058 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
15059 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
15060 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
15061 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
15062 program, you need:
15063
15064 @enumerate
15065 @item
15066 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
15067 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
15068 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
15069
15070 @item
15071 A C subroutine library to support your program's
15072 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
15073
15074 @item
15075 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
15076 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
15077 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
15078 documentation.
15079 @end enumerate
15080
15081 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
15082 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
15083 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
15084
15085 @table @emph
15086 @item On the host,
15087 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
15088 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
15089 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
15090
15091 @item On the target,
15092 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
15093 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
15094 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
15095
15096 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
15097 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
15098 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
15099 @end table
15100
15101 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
15102 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
15103 @sc{sparc} boards.
15104
15105 @cindex remote serial stub list
15106 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
15107
15108 @table @code
15109
15110 @item i386-stub.c
15111 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
15112 @cindex Intel
15113 @cindex i386
15114 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
15115
15116 @item m68k-stub.c
15117 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
15118 @cindex Motorola 680x0
15119 @cindex m680x0
15120 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
15121
15122 @item sh-stub.c
15123 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
15124 @cindex Renesas
15125 @cindex SH
15126 For Renesas SH architectures.
15127
15128 @item sparc-stub.c
15129 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
15130 @cindex Sparc
15131 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
15132
15133 @item sparcl-stub.c
15134 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
15135 @cindex Fujitsu
15136 @cindex SparcLite
15137 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
15138
15139 @end table
15140
15141 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
15142 recently added stubs.
15143
15144 @menu
15145 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
15146 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
15147 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
15148 @end menu
15149
15150 @node Stub Contents
15151 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
15152
15153 @cindex remote serial stub
15154 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
15155 subroutines:
15156
15157 @table @code
15158 @item set_debug_traps
15159 @findex set_debug_traps
15160 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
15161 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
15162 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
15163 beginning of your program.
15164
15165 @item handle_exception
15166 @findex handle_exception
15167 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
15168 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
15169 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
15170 run when a trap is triggered.
15171
15172 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
15173 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
15174 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
15175 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
15176 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
15177 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
15178 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
15179 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
15180 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
15181 machine.
15182
15183 @item breakpoint
15184 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
15185 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
15186 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
15187 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
15188 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
15189 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
15190 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
15191 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
15192 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
15193 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
15194 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
15195
15196 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
15197 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
15198 start of your debugging session.
15199 @end table
15200
15201 @node Bootstrapping
15202 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
15203
15204 @cindex remote stub, support routines
15205 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
15206 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
15207 debugging target machine.
15208
15209 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
15210 serial port.
15211
15212 @table @code
15213 @item int getDebugChar()
15214 @findex getDebugChar
15215 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
15216 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
15217 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15218
15219 @item void putDebugChar(int)
15220 @findex putDebugChar
15221 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
15222 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
15223 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
15224 @end table
15225
15226 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
15227 @cindex interrupting remote targets
15228 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
15229 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
15230 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
15231 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
15232 remote system to stop.
15233
15234 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
15235 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
15236 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
15237 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
15238
15239 Other routines you need to supply are:
15240
15241 @table @code
15242 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
15243 @findex exceptionHandler
15244 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
15245 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
15246 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
15247 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
15248 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
15249 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
15250 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
15251 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
15252 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
15253 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
15254 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
15255 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
15256 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
15257
15258 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
15259 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
15260 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
15261 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
15262 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
15263
15264 @item void flush_i_cache()
15265 @findex flush_i_cache
15266 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
15267 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
15268 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
15269
15270 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
15271 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
15272 @end table
15273
15274 @noindent
15275 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
15276
15277 @table @code
15278 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
15279 @findex memset
15280 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
15281 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
15282 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
15283 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
15284 @end table
15285
15286 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
15287 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
15288 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
15289 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
15290
15291
15292 @node Debug Session
15293 @subsection Putting it All Together
15294
15295 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
15296 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
15297 steps.
15298
15299 @enumerate
15300 @item
15301 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
15302 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
15303 @display
15304 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
15305 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
15306 @end display
15307
15308 @item
15309 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
15310
15311 @smallexample
15312 set_debug_traps();
15313 breakpoint();
15314 @end smallexample
15315
15316 @item
15317 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
15318 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
15319
15320 @smallexample
15321 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
15322 @end smallexample
15323
15324 @noindent
15325 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
15326 function in your program, that function is called when
15327 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
15328 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
15329 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
15330
15331 @item
15332 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
15333 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
15334
15335 @item
15336 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
15337 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
15338
15339 @item
15340 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
15341 @c document that. FIXME.
15342 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
15343 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
15344
15345 @item
15346 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
15347 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15348
15349 @end enumerate
15350
15351 @node Configurations
15352 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
15353
15354 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
15355 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
15356 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
15357
15358 There are three major categories of configurations: native
15359 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
15360 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
15361 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
15362 are quite different from each other.
15363
15364 @menu
15365 * Native::
15366 * Embedded OS::
15367 * Embedded Processors::
15368 * Architectures::
15369 @end menu
15370
15371 @node Native
15372 @section Native
15373
15374 This section describes details specific to particular native
15375 configurations.
15376
15377 @menu
15378 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
15379 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
15380 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
15381 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
15382 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
15383 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
15384 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
15385 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
15386 @end menu
15387
15388 @node HP-UX
15389 @subsection HP-UX
15390
15391 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
15392 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
15393 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
15394
15395
15396 @node BSD libkvm Interface
15397 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
15398
15399 @cindex libkvm
15400 @cindex kernel memory image
15401 @cindex kernel crash dump
15402
15403 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
15404 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
15405 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
15406 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
15407 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
15408 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
15409 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
15410 @code{kvm} target:
15411
15412 @smallexample
15413 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
15414 @end smallexample
15415
15416 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
15417 argument:
15418
15419 @smallexample
15420 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
15421 @end smallexample
15422
15423 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
15424 available:
15425
15426 @table @code
15427 @kindex kvm
15428 @item kvm pcb
15429 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
15430
15431 @item kvm proc
15432 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
15433 modern FreeBSD systems.
15434 @end table
15435
15436 @node SVR4 Process Information
15437 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
15438 @cindex /proc
15439 @cindex examine process image
15440 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
15441
15442 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
15443 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
15444 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
15445 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
15446 proc} is available to report information about the process running
15447 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
15448 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
15449 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
15450 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
15451
15452 @table @code
15453 @kindex info proc
15454 @cindex process ID
15455 @item info proc
15456 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
15457 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
15458 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
15459 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
15460 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
15461 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
15462 executable file's absolute file name.
15463
15464 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
15465 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
15466 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
15467 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
15468 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
15469 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
15470
15471 @item info proc mappings
15472 @cindex memory address space mappings
15473 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
15474 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
15475 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
15476 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
15477 memory access rights to that range.
15478
15479 @item info proc stat
15480 @itemx info proc status
15481 @cindex process detailed status information
15482 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
15483 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
15484 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
15485 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
15486 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
15487 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
15488 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
15489
15490 @item info proc all
15491 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
15492 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
15493
15494 @ignore
15495 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
15496 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
15497 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
15498 @kindex info proc times
15499 @item info proc times
15500 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
15501 its children.
15502
15503 @kindex info proc id
15504 @item info proc id
15505 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
15506 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
15507 @end ignore
15508
15509 @item set procfs-trace
15510 @kindex set procfs-trace
15511 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
15512 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
15513
15514 @item show procfs-trace
15515 @kindex show procfs-trace
15516 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
15517
15518 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
15519 @kindex set procfs-file
15520 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
15521 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
15522 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
15523 standard output.
15524
15525 @item show procfs-file
15526 @kindex show procfs-file
15527 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
15528
15529 @item proc-trace-entry
15530 @itemx proc-trace-exit
15531 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
15532 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
15533 @kindex proc-trace-entry
15534 @kindex proc-trace-exit
15535 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
15536 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
15537 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
15538 from the @code{syscall} interface.
15539
15540 @item info pidlist
15541 @kindex info pidlist
15542 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
15543 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
15544 processes and all the threads within each process.
15545
15546 @item info meminfo
15547 @kindex info meminfo
15548 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15549 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15550 @end table
15551
15552 @node DJGPP Native
15553 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15554 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15555 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15556 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15557
15558 @cindex DPMI
15559 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15560 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15561 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15562 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15563
15564 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15565 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15566 subsection describes those commands.
15567
15568 @table @code
15569 @kindex info dos
15570 @item info dos
15571 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15572 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15573
15574 @kindex sysinfo
15575 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15576 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15577 @item info dos sysinfo
15578 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15579 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15580 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15581
15582 @cindex GDT
15583 @cindex LDT
15584 @cindex IDT
15585 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15586 @cindex descriptor tables display
15587 @item info dos gdt
15588 @itemx info dos ldt
15589 @itemx info dos idt
15590 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15591 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15592 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15593 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15594 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
15595 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
15596 rights.
15597
15598 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
15599 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
15600 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
15601 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
15602 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
15603
15604 @cindex garbled pointers
15605 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
15606 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
15607 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
15608 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
15609 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
15610 debugged program's data segment:
15611
15612 @smallexample
15613 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
15614 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
15615 @end smallexample
15616
15617 @noindent
15618 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
15619 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
15620
15621 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
15622 @item info dos pde
15623 @itemx info dos pte
15624 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
15625 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
15626 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
15627 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
15628 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
15629 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
15630 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
15631 that is currently in use.
15632
15633 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
15634 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
15635 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
15636 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
15637 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
15638 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
15639 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
15640
15641 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
15642 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
15643 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
15644 controller.
15645
15646 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
15647
15648 @cindex physical address from linear address
15649 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
15650 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
15651 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
15652 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
15653 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
15654 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
15655 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
15656
15657 @smallexample
15658 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
15659 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
15660 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
15661 @end smallexample
15662
15663 @noindent
15664 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
15665 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
15666 attributes of that page.
15667
15668 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
15669 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
15670 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
15671 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
15672 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
15673 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
15674
15675 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
15676 transfer buffer:
15677
15678 @smallexample
15679 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
15680 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
15681 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
15682 @end smallexample
15683
15684 @noindent
15685 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
15686 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
15687 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
15688 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15689 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15690
15691 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15692 @end table
15693
15694 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15695 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15696 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15697 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15698
15699 @table @code
15700 @kindex set com1base
15701 @kindex set com1irq
15702 @kindex set com2base
15703 @kindex set com2irq
15704 @kindex set com3base
15705 @kindex set com3irq
15706 @kindex set com4base
15707 @kindex set com4irq
15708 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15709 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15710 port.
15711
15712 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15713 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15714 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15715
15716 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15717 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15718 other 3 COM ports.
15719
15720 @kindex show com1base
15721 @kindex show com1irq
15722 @kindex show com2base
15723 @kindex show com2irq
15724 @kindex show com3base
15725 @kindex show com3irq
15726 @kindex show com4base
15727 @kindex show com4irq
15728 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15729 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15730 lines used by the COM ports.
15731
15732 @item info serial
15733 @kindex info serial
15734 @cindex DOS serial port status
15735 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15736 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15737 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15738 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15739 @end table
15740
15741
15742 @node Cygwin Native
15743 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15744 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15745 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15746 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15747
15748 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15749 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15750 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15751 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15752 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15753
15754 @table @code
15755 @kindex info w32
15756 @item info w32
15757 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15758 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15759
15760 @item info w32 selector
15761 This command displays information returned by
15762 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15763 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15764 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15765 Without argument, this command displays information
15766 about the six segment registers.
15767
15768 @kindex info dll
15769 @item info dll
15770 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15771
15772 @kindex dll-symbols
15773 @item dll-symbols
15774 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15775 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15776
15777 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15778 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15779 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15780 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15781 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15782 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15783 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15784 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15785 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15786 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15787 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15788
15789 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15790 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15791 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15792 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15793
15794 @kindex set new-console
15795 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15796 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15797 be started in a new console on next start.
15798 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15799 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15800
15801 @kindex show new-console
15802 @item show new-console
15803 Displays whether a new console is used
15804 when the debuggee is started.
15805
15806 @kindex set new-group
15807 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15808 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15809 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15810 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15811 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15812
15813 @kindex show new-group
15814 @item show new-group
15815 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15816
15817 @kindex set debugevents
15818 @item set debugevents
15819 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15820 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15821 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15822 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15823 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15824
15825 @kindex set debugexec
15826 @item set debugexec
15827 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15828 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15829
15830 @kindex set debugexceptions
15831 @item set debugexceptions
15832 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15833 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15834
15835 @kindex set debugmemory
15836 @item set debugmemory
15837 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15838 and writes by the debugger.
15839
15840 @kindex set shell
15841 @item set shell
15842 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15843 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15844
15845 @kindex show shell
15846 @item show shell
15847 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15848
15849 @end table
15850
15851 @menu
15852 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15853 @end menu
15854
15855 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15856 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15857 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15858 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15859
15860 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15861 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15862 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15863 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15864 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15865 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15866 ``minimal symbols''.
15867
15868 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15869 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15870 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15871 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15872 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15873 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15874 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15875 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15876 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15877 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15878
15879 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15880
15881 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15882 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15883 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15884 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15885 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15886 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15887 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15888 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15889 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15890
15891 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15892 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15893 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15894 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15895 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15896 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15897
15898 @smallexample
15899 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15900 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15901
15902 Non-debugging symbols:
15903 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15904 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15905 @end smallexample
15906
15907 @smallexample
15908 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15909 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15910
15911 Non-debugging symbols:
15912 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15913 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15914 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15915 [etc...]
15916 @end smallexample
15917
15918 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15919
15920 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15921 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15922 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15923 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15924 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15925 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15926 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15927
15928 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15929 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15930 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15931 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15932 problem:
15933
15934 @smallexample
15935 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15936 $1 = 268572168
15937 @end smallexample
15938
15939 @smallexample
15940 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15941 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15942 @end smallexample
15943
15944 And two possible solutions:
15945
15946 @smallexample
15947 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15948 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15949 @end smallexample
15950
15951 @smallexample
15952 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15953 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15954 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15955 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15956 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15957 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15958 @end smallexample
15959
15960 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15961 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15962 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15963 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15964 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15968 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15969 @end smallexample
15970
15971 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15972 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15973 safe.
15974
15975 @node Hurd Native
15976 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15977 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15978
15979 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15980 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15981
15982 @table @code
15983 @item set signals
15984 @itemx set sigs
15985 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15986 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15987 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15988 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15989 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15990 @code{signals}.
15991
15992 @item show signals
15993 @itemx show sigs
15994 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15995 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15996 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15997
15998 @item set signal-thread
15999 @itemx set sigthread
16000 @kindex set signal-thread
16001 @kindex set sigthread
16002 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
16003 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
16004 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
16005 signal-thread}.
16006
16007 @item show signal-thread
16008 @itemx show sigthread
16009 @kindex show signal-thread
16010 @kindex show sigthread
16011 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
16012 delivered a signal.
16013
16014 @item set stopped
16015 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16016 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
16017 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
16018 continued by delivering a signal to it.
16019
16020 @item show stopped
16021 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
16022 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
16023 stopped.
16024
16025 @item set exceptions
16026 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16027 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
16028 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
16029 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
16030 trapping on.
16031
16032 @item show exceptions
16033 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
16034 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
16035
16036 @item set task pause
16037 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
16038 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16039 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16040 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
16041 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
16042 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
16043 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
16044 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
16045 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
16046
16047 @item show task pause
16048 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
16049 Show the current state of task suspension.
16050
16051 @item set task detach-suspend-count
16052 @cindex task suspend count
16053 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16054 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
16055 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
16056
16057 @item show task detach-suspend-count
16058 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
16059
16060 @item set task exception-port
16061 @itemx set task excp
16062 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16063 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
16064 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
16065 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
16066
16067 @item set noninvasive
16068 @cindex noninvasive task options
16069 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
16070 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
16071 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
16072 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
16073
16074 @item info send-rights
16075 @itemx info receive-rights
16076 @itemx info port-rights
16077 @itemx info port-sets
16078 @itemx info dead-names
16079 @itemx info ports
16080 @itemx info psets
16081 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16082 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16083 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16084 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16085 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16086 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
16087 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
16088 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
16089 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
16090
16091 @item set thread pause
16092 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
16093 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16094 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
16095 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
16096 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
16097 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
16098 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
16099 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
16100 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
16101 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
16102 only the current thread.
16103
16104 @item show thread pause
16105 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
16106 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
16107
16108 @item set thread run
16109 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16110
16111 @item show thread run
16112 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
16113
16114 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
16115 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16116 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16117 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
16118 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
16119 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
16120 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
16121
16122 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
16123 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
16124 detaching.
16125
16126 @item set thread exception-port
16127 @itemx set thread excp
16128 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
16129 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
16130 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
16131
16132 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
16133 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
16134 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
16135 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
16136
16137 @item set thread default
16138 @itemx show thread default
16139 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
16140 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
16141 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
16142 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
16143 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
16144 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
16145 the non-default commands.
16146 @end table
16147
16148
16149 @node Neutrino
16150 @subsection QNX Neutrino
16151 @cindex QNX Neutrino
16152
16153 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
16154 Neutrino target:
16155
16156 @table @code
16157 @item set debug nto-debug
16158 @kindex set debug nto-debug
16159 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
16160 Neutrino support.
16161
16162 @item show debug nto-debug
16163 @kindex show debug nto-debug
16164 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
16165 @end table
16166
16167 @node Darwin
16168 @subsection Darwin
16169 @cindex Darwin
16170
16171 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
16172
16173 @table @code
16174 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
16175 @kindex set debug darwin
16176 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
16177 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
16178
16179 @item show debug darwin
16180 @kindex show debug darwin
16181 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
16182
16183 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
16184 @kindex set debug mach-o
16185 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
16186 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
16187 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
16188 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
16189 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
16190 usage.
16191
16192 @item show debug mach-o
16193 @kindex show debug mach-o
16194 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
16195
16196 @item set mach-exceptions on
16197 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
16198 @kindex set mach-exceptions
16199 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
16200 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
16201 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
16202 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
16203
16204 @item show mach-exceptions
16205 @kindex show mach-exceptions
16206 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
16207 @end table
16208
16209
16210 @node Embedded OS
16211 @section Embedded Operating Systems
16212
16213 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
16214 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
16215 architectures.
16216
16217 @menu
16218 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16219 @end menu
16220
16221 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
16222 various real-time operating systems.
16223
16224 @node VxWorks
16225 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
16226
16227 @cindex VxWorks
16228
16229 @table @code
16230
16231 @kindex target vxworks
16232 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
16233 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
16234 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
16235
16236 @end table
16237
16238 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
16239 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
16240
16241 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
16242 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
16243 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16244 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
16245 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
16246 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
16247 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
16248
16249 @table @code
16250 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
16251 @kindex vxworks-timeout
16252 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
16253 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16254 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
16255 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
16256 of a thin network line.
16257 @end table
16258
16259 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
16260 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
16261 procedures.
16262
16263 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
16264 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
16265 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
16266 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
16267 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
16268 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
16269 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
16270 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
16271 manual.
16272 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
16273
16274 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
16275 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16276 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
16277 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
16278
16279 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16280
16281 @smallexample
16282 (vxgdb)
16283 @end smallexample
16284
16285 @menu
16286 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
16287 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
16288 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
16289 @end menu
16290
16291 @node VxWorks Connection
16292 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
16293
16294 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
16295 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
16299 @end smallexample
16300
16301 @need 750
16302 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16303
16304 @smallexample
16305 Attaching remote machine across net...
16306 Connected to tt.
16307 @end smallexample
16308
16309 @need 1000
16310 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
16311 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
16312 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
16313 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
16314 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
16315
16316 @smallexample
16317 prog.o: No such file or directory.
16318 @end smallexample
16319
16320 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
16321 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
16322 command again.
16323
16324 @node VxWorks Download
16325 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
16326
16327 @cindex download to VxWorks
16328 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
16329 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
16330 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
16331 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
16332 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
16333 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
16334 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
16335 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
16336 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
16337 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
16338 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
16339 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
16340 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
16341 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
16342 program, type this on VxWorks:
16343
16344 @smallexample
16345 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
16346 @end smallexample
16347
16348 @noindent
16349 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16350
16351 @smallexample
16352 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
16353 (vxgdb) load prog.o
16354 @end smallexample
16355
16356 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
16357
16358 @smallexample
16359 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
16363 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
16364 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
16365 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
16366 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
16367 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
16368 table.)
16369
16370 @node VxWorks Attach
16371 @subsubsection Running Tasks
16372
16373 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
16374 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
16375 follows:
16376
16377 @smallexample
16378 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
16379 @end smallexample
16380
16381 @noindent
16382 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
16383 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
16384 the time of attachment.
16385
16386 @node Embedded Processors
16387 @section Embedded Processors
16388
16389 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
16390 configurations.
16391
16392 @cindex send command to simulator
16393 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
16394 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
16395
16396 @table @code
16397 @item sim @var{command}
16398 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
16399 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
16400 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
16401 acceptable commands.
16402 @end table
16403
16404
16405 @menu
16406 * ARM:: ARM RDI
16407 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
16408 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
16409 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
16410 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
16411 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
16412 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
16413 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
16414 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
16415 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
16416 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
16417 * CRIS:: CRIS
16418 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
16419 @end menu
16420
16421 @node ARM
16422 @subsection ARM
16423 @cindex ARM RDI
16424
16425 @table @code
16426 @kindex target rdi
16427 @item target rdi @var{dev}
16428 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
16429 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
16430 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
16431
16432 @kindex target rdp
16433 @item target rdp @var{dev}
16434 ARM Demon monitor.
16435
16436 @end table
16437
16438 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
16439
16440 @table @code
16441 @item set arm disassembler
16442 @kindex set arm
16443 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
16444 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
16445
16446 @item show arm disassembler
16447 @kindex show arm
16448 Show the current disassembly style.
16449
16450 @item set arm apcs32
16451 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
16452 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
16453
16454 @item show arm apcs32
16455 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
16456
16457 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
16458 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
16459 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
16460
16461 @table @code
16462 @item auto
16463 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
16464 @item softfpa
16465 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
16466 processors.
16467 @item fpa
16468 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
16469 @item softvfp
16470 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
16471 @item vfp
16472 VFP co-processor.
16473 @end table
16474
16475 @item show arm fpu
16476 Show the current type of the FPU.
16477
16478 @item set arm abi
16479 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
16480
16481 @item show arm abi
16482 Show the currently used ABI.
16483
16484 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16485 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
16486 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
16487 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
16488 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
16489 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
16490 register).
16491
16492 @item show arm fallback-mode
16493 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
16494
16495 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16496 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
16497 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
16498 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
16499 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
16500
16501 @item show arm force-mode
16502 Show the current forced instruction mode.
16503
16504 @item set debug arm
16505 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
16506 target support subsystem.
16507
16508 @item show debug arm
16509 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
16510 @end table
16511
16512 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
16513 using the RDI interface:
16514
16515 @table @code
16516 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16517 @kindex rdilogfile
16518 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
16519 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
16520 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
16521 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
16522 @file{rdi.log}.
16523
16524 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
16525 @kindex rdilogenable
16526 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
16527 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
16528 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
16529 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
16530 are logged to a file.
16531
16532 @item set rdiromatzero
16533 @kindex set rdiromatzero
16534 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
16535 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
16536 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
16537 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
16538 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
16539
16540 @item show rdiromatzero
16541 @kindex show rdiromatzero
16542 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
16543
16544 @item set rdiheartbeat
16545 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
16546 @cindex RDI heartbeat
16547 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16548 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16549 well as the Angel monitor.
16550
16551 @item show rdiheartbeat
16552 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16553 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16554 @end table
16555
16556
16557 @node M32R/D
16558 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16559
16560 @table @code
16561 @kindex target m32r
16562 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16563 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16564
16565 @kindex target m32rsdi
16566 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16567 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16568 @end table
16569
16570 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16571
16572 @table @code
16573 @item set download-path @var{path}
16574 @kindex set download-path
16575 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16576 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16577
16578 @item show download-path
16579 @kindex show download-path
16580 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16581
16582 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16583 @kindex set board-address
16584 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
16585 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
16586
16587 @item show board-address
16588 @kindex show board-address
16589 Show the current IP address of the target board.
16590
16591 @item set server-address @var{addr}
16592 @kindex set server-address
16593 @cindex download server address (M32R)
16594 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
16595 host machine.
16596
16597 @item show server-address
16598 @kindex show server-address
16599 Display the IP address of the download server.
16600
16601 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16602 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
16603 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
16604 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
16605 executable file is uploaded.
16606
16607 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16608 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
16609 Test the @code{upload} command.
16610 @end table
16611
16612 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
16613
16614 @table @code
16615 @item sdireset
16616 @kindex sdireset
16617 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
16618 This command resets the SDI connection.
16619
16620 @item sdistatus
16621 @kindex sdistatus
16622 This command shows the SDI connection status.
16623
16624 @item debug_chaos
16625 @kindex debug_chaos
16626 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
16627 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
16628
16629 @item use_debug_dma
16630 @kindex use_debug_dma
16631 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
16632
16633 @item use_mon_code
16634 @kindex use_mon_code
16635 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
16636
16637 @item use_ib_break
16638 @kindex use_ib_break
16639 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
16640
16641 @item use_dbt_break
16642 @kindex use_dbt_break
16643 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
16644 @end table
16645
16646 @node M68K
16647 @subsection M68k
16648
16649 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
16650 target command for the following ROM monitor.
16651
16652 @table @code
16653
16654 @kindex target dbug
16655 @item target dbug @var{dev}
16656 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
16657
16658 @end table
16659
16660 @node MIPS Embedded
16661 @subsection MIPS Embedded
16662
16663 @cindex MIPS boards
16664 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
16665 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
16666 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
16667
16668 @need 1000
16669 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
16670
16671 @table @code
16672 @item target mips @var{port}
16673 @kindex target mips @var{port}
16674 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
16675 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
16676 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
16677 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
16678 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
16679 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
16680
16681 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
16682 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
16683 debugger:
16684
16685 @smallexample
16686 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
16687 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
16688 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16689 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16690 (@value{GDBP}) run
16691 @end smallexample
16692
16693 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16694 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16695 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16696 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16697 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16698
16699 @item target pmon @var{port}
16700 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16701 PMON ROM monitor.
16702
16703 @item target ddb @var{port}
16704 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16705 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16706
16707 @item target lsi @var{port}
16708 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16709 LSI variant of PMON.
16710
16711 @kindex target r3900
16712 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16713 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16714
16715 @kindex target array
16716 @item target array @var{dev}
16717 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16718
16719 @end table
16720
16721
16722 @noindent
16723 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16724
16725 @table @code
16726 @item set mipsfpu double
16727 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16728 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16729 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16730 @itemx show mipsfpu
16731 @kindex set mipsfpu
16732 @kindex show mipsfpu
16733 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16734 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16735 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16736 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16737 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16738 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16739 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16740 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16741 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16742 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16743 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16744 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16745 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16746
16747 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16748 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16749 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16750
16751 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16752 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16753
16754 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16755 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16756 @itemx show timeout
16757 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16758 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16759 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16760 @kindex set timeout
16761 @kindex show timeout
16762 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16763 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16764 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16765 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16766 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16767 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16768 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16769 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16770 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16771 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16772
16773 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16774 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16775 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16776 to run before stopping.
16777
16778 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16779 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16780 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16781 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16782 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16783 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16784
16785 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16786 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16787 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16788 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16789
16790 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16791 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16792 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16793 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16794 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16795 @table @asis
16796 @item pmon target
16797 @samp{PMON}
16798 @item ddb target
16799 @samp{NEC010}
16800 @item lsi target
16801 @samp{PMON>}
16802 @end table
16803
16804 @item show monitor-prompt
16805 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16806 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16807 remote monitor.
16808
16809 @item set monitor-warnings
16810 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16811 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16812 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16813 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16814 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16815
16816 @item show monitor-warnings
16817 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16818 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16819
16820 @item pmon @var{command}
16821 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16822 @cindex send PMON command
16823 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16824 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16825 @end table
16826
16827 @node OpenRISC 1000
16828 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16829 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16830
16831 @cindex or1k boards
16832 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16833 about platform and commands.
16834
16835 @table @code
16836
16837 @kindex target jtag
16838 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16839
16840 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16841 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16842 connected via parallel port to the board.
16843
16844 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16845
16846 @kindex or1ksim
16847 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16848 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16849 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16850
16851 @kindex info or1k spr
16852 @item info or1k spr
16853 Displays spr groups.
16854
16855 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16856 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16857 Displays register names in selected group.
16858
16859 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16860 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16861 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16862 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16863 Shows information about specified spr register.
16864
16865 @kindex spr
16866 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16867 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16868 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16869 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16870 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16871 @end table
16872
16873 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16874 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16875 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16876 triggers can be set using:
16877 @table @code
16878 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16879 Load effective address/data
16880 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16881 Store effective address/data
16882 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16883 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16884 @item $FETCH
16885 Fetch data
16886 @end table
16887
16888 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16889 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16890
16891 @code{htrace} commands:
16892 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16893 @table @code
16894 @kindex hwatch
16895 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16896 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16897 or Data. For example:
16898
16899 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16900
16901 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16902
16903 @kindex htrace
16904 @item htrace info
16905 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16906
16907 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16908 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16909
16910 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16911 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16912
16913 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16914 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16915
16916 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16917 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16918 triggered.
16919
16920 @item htrace enable
16921 @itemx htrace disable
16922 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16923
16924 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16925 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16926
16927 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16928 will be written there.
16929
16930 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16931 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16932
16933 @item htrace mode continuous
16934 Set continuous trace mode.
16935
16936 @item htrace mode suspend
16937 Set suspend trace mode.
16938
16939 @end table
16940
16941 @node PowerPC Embedded
16942 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16943
16944 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16945
16946 @table @code
16947 @kindex set powerpc
16948 @item set powerpc soft-float
16949 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16950 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16951 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16952 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16953
16954 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16955 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16956 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16957 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16958 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16959 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16960 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16961 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16962
16963 @kindex target dink32
16964 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16965 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16966
16967 @kindex target ppcbug
16968 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16969 @kindex target ppcbug1
16970 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16971 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16972
16973 @kindex target sds
16974 @item target sds @var{dev}
16975 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16976 @end table
16977
16978 @cindex SDS protocol
16979 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16980 by @value{GDBN}:
16981
16982 @table @code
16983 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16984 @kindex set sdstimeout
16985 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16986 default is 2 seconds.
16987
16988 @item show sdstimeout
16989 @kindex show sdstimeout
16990 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16991
16992 @item sds @var{command}
16993 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16994 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16995 @end table
16996
16997
16998 @node PA
16999 @subsection HP PA Embedded
17000
17001 @table @code
17002
17003 @kindex target op50n
17004 @item target op50n @var{dev}
17005 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
17006
17007 @kindex target w89k
17008 @item target w89k @var{dev}
17009 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
17010
17011 @end table
17012
17013 @node Sparclet
17014 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
17015
17016 @cindex Sparclet
17017
17018 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
17019 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
17020 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17021 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
17022 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
17023
17024 @table @code
17025 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
17026 @kindex remotetimeout
17027 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
17028 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17029 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
17030 @end table
17031
17032 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
17033 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
17034 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
17035 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
17036 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
17037
17038 @smallexample
17039 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
17040 @end smallexample
17041
17042 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
17043
17044 @smallexample
17045 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
17046 @end smallexample
17047
17048 @cindex running, on Sparclet
17049 Once you have set
17050 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17051 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
17052 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
17053
17054 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17055
17056 @smallexample
17057 (gdbslet)
17058 @end smallexample
17059
17060 @menu
17061 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
17062 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
17063 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
17064 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
17065 @end menu
17066
17067 @node Sparclet File
17068 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
17069
17070 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
17071
17072 @smallexample
17073 (gdbslet) file prog
17074 @end smallexample
17075
17076 @need 1000
17077 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
17078 @value{GDBN} locates
17079 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
17080 path.
17081 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
17082 files will be searched as well.
17083 @value{GDBN} locates
17084 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
17085 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
17086 If it fails
17087 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
17088
17089 @smallexample
17090 prog: No such file or directory.
17091 @end smallexample
17092
17093 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
17094 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
17095 @code{target} command again.
17096
17097 @node Sparclet Connection
17098 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
17099
17100 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
17101 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
17102
17103 @smallexample
17104 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
17105 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
17106 main () at ../prog.c:3
17107 @end smallexample
17108
17109 @need 750
17110 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17111
17112 @smallexample
17113 Connected to ttya.
17114 @end smallexample
17115
17116 @node Sparclet Download
17117 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
17118
17119 @cindex download to Sparclet
17120 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
17121 you can use the @value{GDBN}
17122 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
17123 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
17124 command.
17125 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
17126 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
17127 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
17128 of each of the file's sections.
17129 For instance, if the program
17130 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
17131 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
17135 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
17136 @end smallexample
17137
17138 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
17139 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
17140 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
17141
17142 @node Sparclet Execution
17143 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
17144
17145 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
17146 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
17147 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
17148 manual for the list of commands.
17149
17150 @smallexample
17151 (gdbslet) b main
17152 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
17153 (gdbslet) run
17154 Starting program: prog
17155 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
17156 3 char *symarg = 0;
17157 (gdbslet) step
17158 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
17159 (gdbslet)
17160 @end smallexample
17161
17162 @node Sparclite
17163 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
17164
17165 @table @code
17166
17167 @kindex target sparclite
17168 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
17169 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
17170 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
17171 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
17172 remote protocol.
17173
17174 @end table
17175
17176 @node Z8000
17177 @subsection Zilog Z8000
17178
17179 @cindex Z8000
17180 @cindex simulator, Z8000
17181 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
17182
17183 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
17184 a Z8000 simulator.
17185
17186 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
17187 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
17188 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
17189 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
17190
17191 @table @code
17192 @item target sim @var{args}
17193 @kindex sim
17194 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
17195 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
17196 options, specify them via @var{args}.
17197 @end table
17198
17199 @noindent
17200 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
17201 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
17202 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
17203 to run your program, and so on.
17204
17205 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
17206 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
17207 additional items of information as specially named registers:
17208
17209 @table @code
17210
17211 @item cycles
17212 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
17213
17214 @item insts
17215 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
17216
17217 @item time
17218 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
17219
17220 @end table
17221
17222 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
17223 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
17224 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
17225 simulated clock ticks.
17226
17227 @node AVR
17228 @subsection Atmel AVR
17229 @cindex AVR
17230
17231 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
17232 following AVR-specific commands:
17233
17234 @table @code
17235 @item info io_registers
17236 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
17237 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
17238 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
17239 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
17240 @end table
17241
17242 @node CRIS
17243 @subsection CRIS
17244 @cindex CRIS
17245
17246 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
17247 following CRIS-specific commands:
17248
17249 @table @code
17250 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
17251 @cindex CRIS version
17252 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
17253 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
17254 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
17255
17256 @item show cris-version
17257 Show the current CRIS version.
17258
17259 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
17260 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
17261 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
17262 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
17263 @code{R59}.
17264
17265 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
17266 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
17267
17268 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
17269 @cindex CRIS mode
17270 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
17271 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
17272 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
17273
17274 @item show cris-mode
17275 Show the current CRIS mode.
17276 @end table
17277
17278 @node Super-H
17279 @subsection Renesas Super-H
17280 @cindex Super-H
17281
17282 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
17283 commands:
17284
17285 @table @code
17286 @item regs
17287 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
17288 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
17289
17290 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
17291 @kindex set sh calling-convention
17292 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
17293 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
17294 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
17295 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
17296 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
17297 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
17298 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
17299 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
17300 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
17301 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
17302
17303 @item show sh calling-convention
17304 @kindex show sh calling-convention
17305 Show the current calling convention setting.
17306
17307 @end table
17308
17309
17310 @node Architectures
17311 @section Architectures
17312
17313 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
17314 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
17315
17316 @menu
17317 * i386::
17318 * A29K::
17319 * Alpha::
17320 * MIPS::
17321 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
17322 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17323 * PowerPC::
17324 @end menu
17325
17326 @node i386
17327 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
17331 @kindex set struct-convention
17332 @cindex struct return convention
17333 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
17334 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
17335 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
17336 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
17337 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
17338 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
17339 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
17340 be returned in a register.
17341
17342 @item show struct-convention
17343 @kindex show struct-convention
17344 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
17345 from functions.
17346 @end table
17347
17348 @node A29K
17349 @subsection A29K
17350
17351 @table @code
17352
17353 @kindex set rstack_high_address
17354 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
17355 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
17356 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
17357 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
17358 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
17359 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
17360 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
17361 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
17362 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
17363 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
17364 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
17365 hexadecimal.
17366
17367 @kindex show rstack_high_address
17368 @item show rstack_high_address
17369 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
17370 processors.
17371
17372 @end table
17373
17374 @node Alpha
17375 @subsection Alpha
17376
17377 See the following section.
17378
17379 @node MIPS
17380 @subsection MIPS
17381
17382 @cindex stack on Alpha
17383 @cindex stack on MIPS
17384 @cindex Alpha stack
17385 @cindex MIPS stack
17386 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
17387 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
17388 find the beginning of a function.
17389
17390 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
17391 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
17392 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
17393 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
17394 commands:
17395
17396 @table @code
17397 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
17398 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
17399 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
17400 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
17401 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
17402 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
17403 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
17404 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
17405
17406 @item show heuristic-fence-post
17407 Display the current limit.
17408 @end table
17409
17410 @noindent
17411 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
17412 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
17413
17414 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
17415 programs:
17416
17417 @table @code
17418 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
17419 @kindex set mips abi
17420 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
17421 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
17422 values of @var{arg} are:
17423
17424 @table @samp
17425 @item auto
17426 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
17427 default).
17428 @item o32
17429 @item o64
17430 @item n32
17431 @item n64
17432 @item eabi32
17433 @item eabi64
17434 @item auto
17435 @end table
17436
17437 @item show mips abi
17438 @kindex show mips abi
17439 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
17440
17441 @item set mipsfpu
17442 @itemx show mipsfpu
17443 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
17444
17445 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
17446 @kindex set mips mask-address
17447 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
17448 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
17449 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
17450 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
17451 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
17452
17453 @item show mips mask-address
17454 @kindex show mips mask-address
17455 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
17456 not.
17457
17458 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17459 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17460 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
17461 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
17462 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
17463 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
17464
17465 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17466 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17467 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
17468
17469 @item set debug mips
17470 @kindex set debug mips
17471 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
17472 target code in @value{GDBN}.
17473
17474 @item show debug mips
17475 @kindex show debug mips
17476 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
17477 @end table
17478
17479
17480 @node HPPA
17481 @subsection HPPA
17482 @cindex HPPA support
17483
17484 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
17485 following special commands:
17486
17487 @table @code
17488 @item set debug hppa
17489 @kindex set debug hppa
17490 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
17491 messages are to be displayed.
17492
17493 @item show debug hppa
17494 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
17495
17496 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
17497 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
17498 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
17499 given @var{address}.
17500
17501 @end table
17502
17503
17504 @node SPU
17505 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17506 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
17507 @cindex SPU
17508
17509 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
17510 it provides the following special commands:
17511
17512 @table @code
17513 @item info spu event
17514 @kindex info spu
17515 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
17516 and pending event status.
17517
17518 @item info spu signal
17519 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
17520 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
17521 notification channels.
17522
17523 @item info spu mailbox
17524 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
17525 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
17526 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
17527
17528 @item info spu dma
17529 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17530 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17531 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17532
17533 @item info spu proxydma
17534 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17535 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17536 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17537
17538 @end table
17539
17540 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
17541 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
17542 special commands:
17543
17544 @table @code
17545 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
17546 @kindex set spu
17547 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
17548 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
17549 function. The default is @code{off}.
17550
17551 @item show spu stop-on-load
17552 @kindex show spu
17553 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
17554
17555 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
17556 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
17557 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
17558 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
17559 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
17560 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
17561
17562 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
17563 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
17564
17565 @end table
17566
17567 @node PowerPC
17568 @subsection PowerPC
17569 @cindex PowerPC architecture
17570
17571 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
17572 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
17573 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
17574 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
17575 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
17576
17577 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
17578 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
17579 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
17580
17581 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
17582 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
17583
17584
17585 @node Controlling GDB
17586 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
17587
17588 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
17589 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
17590 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
17591 described here.
17592
17593 @menu
17594 * Prompt:: Prompt
17595 * Editing:: Command editing
17596 * Command History:: Command history
17597 * Screen Size:: Screen size
17598 * Numbers:: Numbers
17599 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
17600 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
17601 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
17602 @end menu
17603
17604 @node Prompt
17605 @section Prompt
17606
17607 @cindex prompt
17608
17609 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
17610 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
17611 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
17612 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
17613 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
17614 which one you are talking to.
17615
17616 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
17617 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
17618 or a prompt that does not.
17619
17620 @table @code
17621 @kindex set prompt
17622 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
17623 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
17624
17625 @kindex show prompt
17626 @item show prompt
17627 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
17628 @end table
17629
17630 @node Editing
17631 @section Command Editing
17632 @cindex readline
17633 @cindex command line editing
17634
17635 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
17636 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
17637 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
17638 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
17639 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
17640 debugging sessions.
17641
17642 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
17643 command @code{set}.
17644
17645 @table @code
17646 @kindex set editing
17647 @cindex editing
17648 @item set editing
17649 @itemx set editing on
17650 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
17651
17652 @item set editing off
17653 Disable command line editing.
17654
17655 @kindex show editing
17656 @item show editing
17657 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
17658 @end table
17659
17660 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
17661 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
17662 encouraged to read that chapter.
17663
17664 @node Command History
17665 @section Command History
17666 @cindex command history
17667
17668 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
17669 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
17670 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
17671 history facility.
17672
17673 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
17674 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
17675 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
17676
17677 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17678 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
17679 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
17680 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17681 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17682 pressed on a line by itself.
17683
17684 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
17685 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17686 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17687 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17688
17689 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
17690 history.
17691
17692 @table @code
17693 @cindex history substitution
17694 @cindex history file
17695 @kindex set history filename
17696 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
17697 @item set history filename @var{fname}
17698 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
17699 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
17700 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
17701 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
17702 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
17703 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
17704 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
17705 is not set.
17706
17707 @cindex save command history
17708 @kindex set history save
17709 @item set history save
17710 @itemx set history save on
17711 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
17712 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
17713
17714 @item set history save off
17715 Stop recording command history in a file.
17716
17717 @cindex history size
17718 @kindex set history size
17719 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17720 @item set history size @var{size}
17721 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17722 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17723 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17724 @end table
17725
17726 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17727 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17728
17729 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17730 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17731 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17732 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17733 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17734 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17735 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17736 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17737
17738 The commands to control history expansion are:
17739
17740 @table @code
17741 @item set history expansion on
17742 @itemx set history expansion
17743 @kindex set history expansion
17744 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17745
17746 @item set history expansion off
17747 Disable history expansion.
17748
17749 @c @group
17750 @kindex show history
17751 @item show history
17752 @itemx show history filename
17753 @itemx show history save
17754 @itemx show history size
17755 @itemx show history expansion
17756 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17757 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17758 @c @end group
17759 @end table
17760
17761 @table @code
17762 @kindex show commands
17763 @cindex show last commands
17764 @cindex display command history
17765 @item show commands
17766 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17767
17768 @item show commands @var{n}
17769 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17770
17771 @item show commands +
17772 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17773 @end table
17774
17775 @node Screen Size
17776 @section Screen Size
17777 @cindex size of screen
17778 @cindex pauses in output
17779
17780 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17781 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17782 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17783 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17784 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17785 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17786 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17787 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17788
17789 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17790 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17791 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17792 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17793 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17794 width} commands:
17795
17796 @table @code
17797 @kindex set height
17798 @kindex set width
17799 @kindex show width
17800 @kindex show height
17801 @item set height @var{lpp}
17802 @itemx show height
17803 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17804 @itemx show width
17805 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17806 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17807 commands display the current settings.
17808
17809 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17810 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17811 file or to an editor buffer.
17812
17813 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17814 from wrapping its output.
17815
17816 @item set pagination on
17817 @itemx set pagination off
17818 @kindex set pagination
17819 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17820 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17821
17822 @item show pagination
17823 @kindex show pagination
17824 Show the current pagination mode.
17825 @end table
17826
17827 @node Numbers
17828 @section Numbers
17829 @cindex number representation
17830 @cindex entering numbers
17831
17832 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17833 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17834 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17835 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17836 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17837 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17838 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17839 both input and output with the commands described below.
17840
17841 @table @code
17842 @kindex set input-radix
17843 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17844 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17845 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17846 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17847 example, any of
17848
17849 @smallexample
17850 set input-radix 012
17851 set input-radix 10.
17852 set input-radix 0xa
17853 @end smallexample
17854
17855 @noindent
17856 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17857 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17858 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17859 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17860 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17861 change the radix.
17862
17863 @kindex set output-radix
17864 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17865 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17866 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17867 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17868
17869 @kindex show input-radix
17870 @item show input-radix
17871 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17872
17873 @kindex show output-radix
17874 @item show output-radix
17875 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17876
17877 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17878 @itemx show radix
17879 @kindex set radix
17880 @kindex show radix
17881 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17882 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17883 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17884 default value of 10.
17885
17886 @end table
17887
17888 @node ABI
17889 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17890
17891 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17892 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17893 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17894 current ABI.
17895
17896 @cindex OS ABI
17897 @kindex set osabi
17898 @kindex show osabi
17899
17900 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17901 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17902 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17903 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17904 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17905 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17906 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17907 platform provides.
17908
17909 @table @code
17910 @item show osabi
17911 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17912
17913 @item set osabi
17914 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17915
17916 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17917 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17918 @end table
17919
17920 @cindex float promotion
17921
17922 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17923 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17924 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17925 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17926 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17927 @code{double} and then passed.
17928
17929 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17930 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17931 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17932
17933 @table @code
17934 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17935 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17936 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17937 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17938 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17939
17940 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17941 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17942 functions.
17943
17944 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17945 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17946 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17947 @end table
17948
17949 @kindex set cp-abi
17950 @kindex show cp-abi
17951 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17952 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17953 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17954 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17955 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17956 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17957 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17958 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17959 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17960 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17961 ``auto''.
17962
17963 @table @code
17964 @item show cp-abi
17965 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17966
17967 @item set cp-abi
17968 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17969
17970 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17971 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17972 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17973 @end table
17974
17975 @node Messages/Warnings
17976 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17977
17978 @cindex verbose operation
17979 @cindex optional warnings
17980 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17981 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17982 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17983 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17984
17985 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17986 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17987 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17988
17989 @table @code
17990 @kindex set verbose
17991 @item set verbose on
17992 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17993
17994 @item set verbose off
17995 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17996
17997 @kindex show verbose
17998 @item show verbose
17999 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
18000 @end table
18001
18002 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
18003 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
18004 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
18005 Symbol Files}).
18006
18007 @table @code
18008
18009 @kindex set complaints
18010 @item set complaints @var{limit}
18011 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
18012 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
18013 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
18014 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
18015
18016 @kindex show complaints
18017 @item show complaints
18018 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
18019
18020 @end table
18021
18022 @anchor{confirmation requests}
18023 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
18024 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
18025 you try to run a program which is already running:
18026
18027 @smallexample
18028 (@value{GDBP}) run
18029 The program being debugged has been started already.
18030 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
18031 @end smallexample
18032
18033 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
18034 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
18035
18036 @table @code
18037
18038 @kindex set confirm
18039 @cindex flinching
18040 @cindex confirmation
18041 @cindex stupid questions
18042 @item set confirm off
18043 Disables confirmation requests.
18044
18045 @item set confirm on
18046 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
18047
18048 @kindex show confirm
18049 @item show confirm
18050 Displays state of confirmation requests.
18051
18052 @end table
18053
18054 @cindex command tracing
18055 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
18056 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
18057 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
18058 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
18059
18060 @table @code
18061 @kindex set trace-commands
18062 @cindex command scripts, debugging
18063 @item set trace-commands on
18064 Enable command tracing.
18065 @item set trace-commands off
18066 Disable command tracing.
18067 @item show trace-commands
18068 Display the current state of command tracing.
18069 @end table
18070
18071 @node Debugging Output
18072 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
18073 @cindex optional debugging messages
18074
18075 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
18076 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
18077 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
18078 section documents those commands.
18079
18080 @table @code
18081 @kindex set exec-done-display
18082 @item set exec-done-display
18083 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
18084 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
18085 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
18086 @kindex show exec-done-display
18087 @item show exec-done-display
18088 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
18089 notification.
18090 @kindex set debug
18091 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
18092 @cindex architecture debugging info
18093 @item set debug arch
18094 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
18095 @kindex show debug
18096 @item show debug arch
18097 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
18098 @item set debug aix-thread
18099 @cindex AIX threads
18100 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
18101 module.
18102 @item show debug aix-thread
18103 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
18104 @item set debug dwarf2-die
18105 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
18106 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
18107 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
18108 A value of zero turns off the display.
18109 @item show debug dwarf2-die
18110 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
18111 @item set debug displaced
18112 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
18113 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
18114 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
18115 @item show debug displaced
18116 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
18117 related to displaced stepping.
18118 @item set debug event
18119 @cindex event debugging info
18120 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
18121 default is off.
18122 @item show debug event
18123 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
18124 info.
18125 @item set debug expression
18126 @cindex expression debugging info
18127 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
18128 expression parsing. The default is off.
18129 @item show debug expression
18130 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
18131 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
18132 @item set debug frame
18133 @cindex frame debugging info
18134 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
18135 default is off.
18136 @item show debug frame
18137 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
18138 info.
18139 @item set debug gnu-nat
18140 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
18141 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
18142 @item show debug gnu-nat
18143 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
18144 @item set debug infrun
18145 @cindex inferior debugging info
18146 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
18147 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
18148 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
18149 @item show debug infrun
18150 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
18151 @item set debug lin-lwp
18152 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
18153 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18154 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
18155 @item show debug lin-lwp
18156 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
18157 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
18158 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
18159 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
18160 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
18161 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
18162 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
18163 @item set debug observer
18164 @cindex observer debugging info
18165 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
18166 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
18167 @item show debug observer
18168 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
18169 @item set debug overload
18170 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
18171 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
18172 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
18173 is off.
18174 @item show debug overload
18175 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
18176 debugging info.
18177 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
18178 @cindex serial connections, debugging
18179 @cindex debug remote protocol
18180 @cindex remote protocol debugging
18181 @cindex display remote packets
18182 @item set debug remote
18183 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
18184 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
18185 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
18186 @item show debug remote
18187 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
18188 @item set debug serial
18189 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
18190 default is off.
18191 @item show debug serial
18192 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
18193 info.
18194 @item set debug solib-frv
18195 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
18196 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
18197 @item show debug solib-frv
18198 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
18199 messages.
18200 @item set debug target
18201 @cindex target debugging info
18202 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
18203 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
18204 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
18205 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
18206 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
18207 @item show debug target
18208 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
18209 info.
18210 @item set debug timestamp
18211 @cindex timestampping debugging info
18212 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
18213 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
18214 message.
18215 @item show debug timestamp
18216 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
18217 debugging info.
18218 @item set debugvarobj
18219 @cindex variable object debugging info
18220 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
18221 info. The default is off.
18222 @item show debugvarobj
18223 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
18224 debugging info.
18225 @item set debug xml
18226 @cindex XML parser debugging
18227 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
18228 @item show debug xml
18229 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
18230 @end table
18231
18232 @node Extending GDB
18233 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
18234 @cindex extending GDB
18235
18236 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
18237 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
18238 Python scripting language.
18239
18240 @menu
18241 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
18242 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18243 @end menu
18244
18245 @node Sequences
18246 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
18247
18248 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
18249 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
18250 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
18251 files.
18252
18253 @menu
18254 * Define:: How to define your own commands
18255 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
18256 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
18257 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
18258 @end menu
18259
18260 @node Define
18261 @subsection User-defined Commands
18262
18263 @cindex user-defined command
18264 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
18265 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
18266 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
18267 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
18268 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
18269 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
18270
18271 @smallexample
18272 define adder
18273 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18274 end
18275 @end smallexample
18276
18277 @noindent
18278 To execute the command use:
18279
18280 @smallexample
18281 adder 1 2 3
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 @noindent
18285 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
18286 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
18287 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
18288 functions calls.
18289
18290 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
18291 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
18292 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
18293 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
18294
18295 @smallexample
18296 define adder
18297 if $argc == 2
18298 print $arg0 + $arg1
18299 end
18300 if $argc == 3
18301 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
18302 end
18303 end
18304 @end smallexample
18305
18306 @table @code
18307
18308 @kindex define
18309 @item define @var{commandname}
18310 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
18311 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
18312 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
18313 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
18314 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
18315 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
18316
18317 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
18318 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
18319 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18320
18321 @kindex document
18322 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
18323 @item document @var{commandname}
18324 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
18325 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
18326 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
18327 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
18328 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
18329 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
18330
18331 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
18332 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
18333 does not change the documentation.
18334
18335 @kindex dont-repeat
18336 @cindex don't repeat command
18337 @item dont-repeat
18338 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
18339 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
18340 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
18341
18342 @kindex help user-defined
18343 @item help user-defined
18344 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
18345 (if any) for each.
18346
18347 @kindex show user
18348 @item show user
18349 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
18350 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
18351 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
18352 definitions for all user-defined commands.
18353
18354 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
18355 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
18356 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
18357 @item show max-user-call-depth
18358 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
18359 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
18360 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
18361 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
18362 @end table
18363
18364 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
18365 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
18366
18367 When user-defined commands are executed, the
18368 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
18369 stops execution of the user-defined command.
18370
18371 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
18372 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
18373 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
18374 messages when used in a user-defined command.
18375
18376 @node Hooks
18377 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
18378 @cindex command hooks
18379 @cindex hooks, for commands
18380 @cindex hooks, pre-command
18381
18382 @kindex hook
18383 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
18384 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
18385 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
18386 before that command.
18387
18388 @cindex hooks, post-command
18389 @kindex hookpost
18390 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
18391 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
18392 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
18393 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
18394 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
18395
18396 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
18397 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
18398
18399 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
18400 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
18401
18402 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
18403 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
18404 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
18405 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
18406 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
18407
18408 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
18409 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
18410 you could define:
18411
18412 @smallexample
18413 define hook-stop
18414 handle SIGALRM nopass
18415 end
18416
18417 define hook-run
18418 handle SIGALRM pass
18419 end
18420
18421 define hook-continue
18422 handle SIGALRM pass
18423 end
18424 @end smallexample
18425
18426 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
18427 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
18428 you could define:
18429
18430 @smallexample
18431 define hook-echo
18432 echo <<<---
18433 end
18434
18435 define hookpost-echo
18436 echo --->>>\n
18437 end
18438
18439 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
18440 <<<---Hello World--->>>
18441 (@value{GDBP})
18442
18443 @end smallexample
18444
18445 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
18446 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
18447 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
18448 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
18449 @c or not?
18450 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
18451 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
18452 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
18453
18454 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
18455 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
18456 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
18457
18458 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
18459 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
18460
18461 @node Command Files
18462 @subsection Command Files
18463
18464 @cindex command files
18465 @cindex scripting commands
18466 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
18467 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
18468 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
18469 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
18470 terminal.
18471
18472 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
18473 command:
18474
18475 @table @code
18476 @kindex source
18477 @cindex execute commands from a file
18478 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
18479 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
18480 @end table
18481
18482 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
18483 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
18484 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
18485 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
18486 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
18487
18488 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
18489 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
18490
18491 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
18492 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
18493 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
18494
18495 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
18496 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
18497 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
18498 when called from command files.
18499
18500 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
18501 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
18502 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
18503 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
18504 the next command.
18505
18506 @smallexample
18507 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
18508 @end smallexample
18509
18510 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
18511 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
18512 would be directed to @file{log}.
18513
18514 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
18515 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
18516 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
18517 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
18518 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
18519 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
18520 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
18521 conditionally, etc.
18522
18523 @table @code
18524 @kindex if
18525 @kindex else
18526 @item if
18527 @itemx else
18528 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
18529 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
18530 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
18531 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
18532 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
18533 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
18534 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18535
18536 @kindex while
18537 @item while
18538 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
18539 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
18540 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
18541 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
18542 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
18543 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
18544
18545 @kindex loop_break
18546 @item loop_break
18547 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
18548 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
18549 line.
18550
18551 @kindex loop_continue
18552 @item loop_continue
18553 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
18554 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
18555 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
18556 the controlling expression.
18557
18558 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
18559 @item end
18560 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
18561 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
18562 @end table
18563
18564
18565 @node Output
18566 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
18567
18568 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
18569 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
18570 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
18571 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
18572 want.
18573
18574 @table @code
18575 @kindex echo
18576 @item echo @var{text}
18577 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
18578 @c because it is not in ANSI.
18579 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
18580 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
18581 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
18582 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
18583 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
18584 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
18585 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
18586 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
18587 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
18588
18589 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
18590 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
18591
18592 @smallexample
18593 echo This is some text\n\
18594 which is continued\n\
18595 onto several lines.\n
18596 @end smallexample
18597
18598 produces the same output as
18599
18600 @smallexample
18601 echo This is some text\n
18602 echo which is continued\n
18603 echo onto several lines.\n
18604 @end smallexample
18605
18606 @kindex output
18607 @item output @var{expression}
18608 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
18609 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
18610 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
18611 on expressions.
18612
18613 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
18614 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
18615 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
18616 Formats}, for more information.
18617
18618 @kindex printf
18619 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
18620 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
18621 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
18622 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
18623 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
18624 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
18625 executing the code below:
18626
18627 @smallexample
18628 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
18629 @end smallexample
18630
18631 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
18632 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
18633 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
18634 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
18635 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
18636 printed.
18637
18638 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
18639
18640 @smallexample
18641 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
18642 @end smallexample
18643
18644 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
18645 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
18646 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
18647
18648 @itemize @bullet
18649 @item
18650 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
18651
18652 @item
18653 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
18654 width.
18655
18656 @item
18657 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
18658 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
18659
18660 @item
18661 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
18662 supported.
18663
18664 @item
18665 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
18666
18667 @item
18668 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
18669 @end itemize
18670
18671 @noindent
18672 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
18673 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
18674 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
18675 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
18676
18677 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
18678 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
18679 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
18680 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
18681 supported.
18682
18683 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
18684 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
18685 together with a floating point specifier.
18686 letters:
18687
18688 @itemize @bullet
18689 @item
18690 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
18691
18692 @item
18693 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
18694
18695 @item
18696 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
18697 @end itemize
18698
18699 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
18700 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
18701 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
18702
18703 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
18704 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
18705
18706 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
18707 @smallexample
18708 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
18709 @end smallexample
18710
18711 @end table
18712
18713 @node Python
18714 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18715 @cindex python scripting
18716 @cindex scripting with python
18717
18718 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
18719 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
18720 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
18721
18722 @menu
18723 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18724 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18725 @end menu
18726
18727 @node Python Commands
18728 @subsection Python Commands
18729 @cindex python commands
18730 @cindex commands to access python
18731
18732 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18733 and one related setting:
18734
18735 @table @code
18736 @kindex python
18737 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18738 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18739
18740 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18741 argument as a Python command. For example:
18742
18743 @smallexample
18744 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18745 23
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18749 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18750 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18751 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18752 containing @code{end}. For example:
18753
18754 @smallexample
18755 (@value{GDBP}) python
18756 Type python script
18757 End with a line saying just "end".
18758 >print 23
18759 >end
18760 23
18761 @end smallexample
18762
18763 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18764 @item maint set python print-stack
18765 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18766 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18767 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18768 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18769 disabled.
18770 @end table
18771
18772 @node Python API
18773 @subsection Python API
18774 @cindex python api
18775 @cindex programming in python
18776
18777 @cindex python stdout
18778 @cindex python pagination
18779 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18780 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18781 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18782 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18783 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18784
18785 @menu
18786 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18787 * Exception Handling::
18788 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
18789 * Values From Inferior::
18790 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
18791 * Pretty Printing:: Pretty-printing values.
18792 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
18793 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
18794 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
18795 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
18796 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18797 @end menu
18798
18799 @node Basic Python
18800 @subsubsection Basic Python
18801
18802 @cindex python functions
18803 @cindex python module
18804 @cindex gdb module
18805 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18806 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18807 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18808 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18809
18810 @findex gdb.execute
18811 @defun execute command [from_tty]
18812 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18813 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18814 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18815 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18816
18817 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
18818 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
18819 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
18820 @end defun
18821
18822 @findex gdb.parameter
18823 @defun parameter parameter
18824 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18825 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18826 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18827 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18828
18829 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18830 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18831 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18832 @end defun
18833
18834 @findex gdb.history
18835 @defun history number
18836 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
18837 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
18838 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
18839 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
18840 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
18841 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
18842 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
18843 raised.
18844
18845 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
18846 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
18847 @end defun
18848
18849 @findex gdb.write
18850 @defun write string
18851 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18852 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18853 call this function.
18854 @end defun
18855
18856 @findex gdb.flush
18857 @defun flush
18858 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18859 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18860 function.
18861 @end defun
18862
18863 @node Exception Handling
18864 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18865 @cindex python exceptions
18866 @cindex exceptions, python
18867
18868 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18869 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18870 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18871 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18872 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18873 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18874 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18875
18876 @smallexample
18877 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18878 Traceback (most recent call last):
18879 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18880 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18881 @end smallexample
18882
18883 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18884 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18885 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18886 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18887 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18888 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18889 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18890 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18891 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18892 traceback.
18893
18894 @node Auto-loading
18895 @subsubsection Auto-loading
18896 @cindex auto-loading, Python
18897
18898 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
18899 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
18900 @value{GDBN} will look for a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
18901 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
18902 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
18903 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
18904 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
18905
18906 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
18907 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
18908 then @value{GDBN} will use the file named
18909 @file{@var{debug-file-directory}/@var{real-name}}, where
18910 @var{real-name} is the object file's real name, as described above.
18911
18912 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
18913 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
18914 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
18915 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
18916 is the object file's real name, as described above.
18917
18918 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the ``current
18919 objfile''. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
18920 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
18921 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
18922
18923 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
18924 debugging commands and scripts. You can enable or disable this
18925 feature, and view its current state.
18926
18927 @table @code
18928 @kindex maint set python auto-load
18929 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
18930 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
18931
18932 @kindex show python auto-load
18933 @item show python auto-load
18934 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
18935 @end table
18936
18937 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded.
18938 So, your @samp{-gdb.py} file should take care to ensure that it may be
18939 evaluated multiple times without error.
18940
18941 @node Values From Inferior
18942 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18943 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18944 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18945
18946 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18947 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18948 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18949 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18950 fetching values when necessary.
18951
18952 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18953 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18954 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18955
18956 @smallexample
18957 bar = some_val + 2
18958 @end smallexample
18959
18960 @noindent
18961 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18962 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18963
18964 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18965 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18966 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18967 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18968
18969 @smallexample
18970 bar = some_val['foo']
18971 @end smallexample
18972
18973 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18974
18975 The following attributes are provided:
18976
18977 @table @code
18978 @defivar Value address
18979 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
18980 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
18981 this attribute holds @code{None}.
18982 @end defivar
18983
18984 @cindex optimized out value in Python
18985 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
18986 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
18987 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
18988 @end defivar
18989
18990 @defivar Value type
18991 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
18992 @code{gdb.Type} object.
18993 @end defivar
18994 @end table
18995
18996 The following methods are provided:
18997
18998 @table @code
18999 @defmethod Value dereference
19000 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
19001 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
19002 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 int *foo;
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 @noindent
19009 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
19010 @code{foo} points to like this:
19011
19012 @smallexample
19013 bar = foo.dereference ()
19014 @end smallexample
19015
19016 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
19017 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
19018 @end defmethod
19019
19020 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
19021 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
19022 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
19023 throw an exception.
19024
19025 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
19026 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
19027 language.
19028
19029 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
19030 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
19031 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
19032 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
19033 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
19034
19035 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
19036 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
19037 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
19038 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
19039 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
19040 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
19041 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
19042 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
19043 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
19044
19045 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
19046 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
19047
19048 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
19049 fetched and converted to the given length.
19050 @end defmethod
19051 @end table
19052
19053 @node Types In Python
19054 @subsubsection Types In Python
19055 @cindex types in Python
19056 @cindex Python, working with types
19057
19058 @tindex gdb.Type
19059 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
19060 @code{gdb.Type}.
19061
19062 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
19063 module:
19064
19065 @findex gdb.lookup_type
19066 @defun lookup_type name [block]
19067 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
19068 type to look up. It must be a string.
19069
19070 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
19071 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
19072 @end defun
19073
19074 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
19075
19076 @table @code
19077 @defivar Type code
19078 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
19079 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
19080 @end defivar
19081
19082 @defivar Type sizeof
19083 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
19084 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
19085 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
19086 @end defivar
19087
19088 @defivar Type tag
19089 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
19090 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
19091 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
19092 @code{None} is returned.
19093 @end defivar
19094 @end table
19095
19096 The following methods are provided:
19097
19098 @table @code
19099 @defmethod Type fields
19100 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
19101 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
19102 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
19103 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
19104 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
19105 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
19106
19107 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
19108 @table @code
19109 @item bitpos
19110 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
19111 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
19112 position of the field.
19113
19114 @item name
19115 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
19116
19117 @item artificial
19118 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
19119 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
19120 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
19121
19122 @item bitsize
19123 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
19124 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
19125 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
19126
19127 @item type
19128 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
19129 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
19130 @end table
19131 @end defmethod
19132
19133 @defmethod Type const
19134 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19135 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
19136 @end defmethod
19137
19138 @defmethod Type volatile
19139 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
19140 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
19141 @end defmethod
19142
19143 @defmethod Type unqualified
19144 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
19145 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
19146 @code{volatile}.
19147 @end defmethod
19148
19149 @defmethod Type reference
19150 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
19151 type.
19152 @end defmethod
19153
19154 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
19155 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
19156 after removing all layers of typedefs.
19157 @end defmethod
19158
19159 @defmethod Type target
19160 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
19161 of this type.
19162
19163 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
19164 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
19165 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
19166 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
19167 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
19168 target type is the aliased type.
19169
19170 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
19171 exception.
19172 @end defmethod
19173
19174 @defmethod Type template_argument n
19175 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
19176 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
19177 @var{n}th template argument.
19178
19179 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
19180 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
19181
19182 @var{name} is searched for globally.
19183 @end defmethod
19184 @end table
19185
19186
19187 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
19188 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
19189 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
19190
19191 @table @code
19192 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
19193 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
19194 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
19195 The type is a pointer.
19196
19197 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19198 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19199 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
19200 The type is an array.
19201
19202 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19203 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19204 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
19205 The type is a structure.
19206
19207 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
19208 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
19209 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
19210 The type is a union.
19211
19212 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19213 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19214 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
19215 The type is an enum.
19216
19217 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19218 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19219 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
19220 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
19221
19222 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19223 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19224 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
19225 The type is a function.
19226
19227 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
19228 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
19229 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
19230 The type is an integer type.
19231
19232 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
19233 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
19234 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
19235 A floating point type.
19236
19237 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
19238 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
19239 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
19240 The special type @code{void}.
19241
19242 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
19243 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
19244 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
19245 A Pascal set type.
19246
19247 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19248 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19249 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
19250 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
19251
19252 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
19253 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
19254 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
19255 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
19256 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
19257
19258 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19259 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19260 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
19261 A string of bits.
19262
19263 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19264 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19265 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
19266 An unknown or erroneous type.
19267
19268 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19269 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19270 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
19271 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
19272
19273 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19274 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19275 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
19276 A pointer-to-member-function.
19277
19278 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19279 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19280 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
19281 A pointer-to-member.
19282
19283 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
19284 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
19285 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
19286 A reference type.
19287
19288 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19289 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19290 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
19291 A character type.
19292
19293 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19294 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19295 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
19296 A boolean type.
19297
19298 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19299 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19300 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
19301 A complex float type.
19302
19303 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19304 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19305 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
19306 A typedef to some other type.
19307
19308 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19309 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19310 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
19311 A C@t{++} namespace.
19312
19313 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19314 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19315 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
19316 A decimal floating point type.
19317
19318 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19319 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19320 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
19321 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
19322 convenience functions.
19323 @end table
19324
19325 @node Pretty Printing
19326 @subsubsection Pretty Printing
19327
19328 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values
19329 using Python code. The pretty-printer API allows application-specific
19330 code to greatly simplify the display of complex objects. This
19331 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
19332
19333 For example, here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a
19334 pretty-printer:
19335
19336 @smallexample
19337 (@value{GDBP}) print s
19338 $1 = @{
19339 static npos = 4294967295,
19340 _M_dataplus = @{
19341 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
19342 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{<No data fields>@}, <No data fields>@},
19343 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
19344 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
19345 @}
19346 @}
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 After a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} has been installed, only
19350 the contents are printed:
19351
19352 @smallexample
19353 (@value{GDBP}) print s
19354 $2 = "abcd"
19355 @end smallexample
19356
19357 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
19358 specific interface, defined here.
19359
19360 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
19361 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
19362 children of the pretty-printer's value.
19363
19364 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
19365 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
19366 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
19367 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
19368 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
19369
19370 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
19371 as though the value has no children.
19372 @end defop
19373
19374 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
19375 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
19376 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
19377 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
19378 printed.
19379
19380 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
19381 string.
19382
19383 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
19384
19385 @table @samp
19386 @item array
19387 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
19388 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
19389 @code{set print array}.
19390
19391 @item map
19392 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
19393 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
19394 values.
19395
19396 @item string
19397 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
19398 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
19399 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
19400 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
19401 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
19402 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
19403 @end table
19404 @end defop
19405
19406 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
19407 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
19408 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
19409
19410 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
19411 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
19412 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
19413 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
19414 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
19415 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
19416 the result of @code{children}.
19417
19418 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
19419
19420 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
19421 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
19422 another pretty-printer.
19423
19424 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
19425 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
19426 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
19427 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
19428 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
19429
19430 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
19431 @end defop
19432
19433 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
19434 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
19435
19436 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
19437 functions that have been registered via addition as a pretty-printer.
19438 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
19439 attribute.
19440
19441 A function on one of these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
19442 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
19443 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). If a function
19444 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
19445 @code{None}.
19446
19447 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
19448 @code{gdb.Objfile} and iteratively calls each function in the list for
19449 that @code{gdb.Objfile} until it receives a pretty-printer object.
19450 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
19451 @code{gdb.pretty-printers} list, again calling each function until an
19452 object is returned.
19453
19454 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
19455 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
19456 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
19457 object is returned.
19458
19459 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
19460 written:
19461
19462 @smallexample
19463 class StdStringPrinter:
19464 "Print a std::string"
19465
19466 def __init__ (self, val):
19467 self.val = val
19468
19469 def to_string (self):
19470 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
19471
19472 def display_hint (self):
19473 return 'string'
19474 @end smallexample
19475
19476 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
19477 example above might be written.
19478
19479 @smallexample
19480 def str_lookup_function (val):
19481
19482 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
19483 regex = re.compile ("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
19484 if lookup_tag == None:
19485 return None
19486 if regex.match (lookup_tag):
19487 return StdStringPrinter (val)
19488
19489 return None
19490 @end smallexample
19491
19492 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
19493 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
19494 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
19495 returns @code{None}.
19496
19497 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
19498 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
19499 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
19500 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
19501 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
19502 different names.
19503
19504 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
19505 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
19506 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
19507 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
19508 the current objfile.
19509
19510 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
19511 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
19512 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
19513 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
19514 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
19515 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
19516 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
19517 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
19518 inferior.
19519
19520 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
19521 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
19522
19523 @smallexample
19524 def register_printers (objfile):
19525 objfile.pretty_printers.add (str_lookup_function)
19526 @end smallexample
19527
19528 @noindent
19529 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
19530
19531 @smallexample
19532 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
19533 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers (gdb.current_objfile ())
19534 @end smallexample
19535
19536 @node Commands In Python
19537 @subsubsection Commands In Python
19538
19539 @cindex commands in python
19540 @cindex python commands
19541 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
19542 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
19543 class, most commonly using a subclass.
19544
19545 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
19546 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
19547 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
19548 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
19549
19550 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
19551 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
19552 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
19553 an exception is raised.
19554
19555 There is no support for multi-line commands.
19556
19557 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
19558 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
19559 new command in the help system.
19560
19561 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
19562 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
19563 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
19564 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
19565 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
19566 error will occur when completion is attempted.
19567
19568 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
19569 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
19570 registered.
19571
19572 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
19573 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
19574 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
19575 not documented.'' is used.
19576 @end defmethod
19577
19578 @cindex don't repeat Python command
19579 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
19580 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
19581 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
19582 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
19583 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
19584 @end defmethod
19585
19586 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
19587 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
19588
19589 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
19590 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
19591
19592 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
19593 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
19594 that the command came from elsewhere.
19595
19596 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
19597 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
19598 @end defmethod
19599
19600 @cindex completion of Python commands
19601 @defmethod Command complete text word
19602 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
19603 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
19604 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
19605 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
19606 complete}).
19607
19608 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
19609 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
19610 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
19611 using a word-breaking heuristic.
19612
19613 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
19614 @itemize @bullet
19615 @item
19616 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
19617 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
19618 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
19619 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
19620 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
19621 sequence are ignored.
19622
19623 @item
19624 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
19625 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
19626 function is invoked, and its result is used.
19627
19628 @item
19629 All other results are treated as though there were no available
19630 completions.
19631 @end itemize
19632 @end defmethod
19633
19634 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
19635 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
19636 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
19637 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
19638 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
19639 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
19640
19641 @table @code
19642 @findex COMMAND_NONE
19643 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
19644 @item COMMAND_NONE
19645 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
19646 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
19647
19648 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
19649 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
19650 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
19651 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
19652 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
19653 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
19654 commands in this category.
19655
19656 @findex COMMAND_DATA
19657 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
19658 @item COMMAND_DATA
19659 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
19660 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
19661 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
19662 in this category.
19663
19664 @findex COMMAND_STACK
19665 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
19666 @item COMMAND_STACK
19667 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
19668 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
19669 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
19670 list of commands in this category.
19671
19672 @findex COMMAND_FILES
19673 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
19674 @item COMMAND_FILES
19675 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
19676 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
19677 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
19678 commands in this category.
19679
19680 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
19681 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
19682 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
19683 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
19684 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
19685 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
19686 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
19687 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
19688 commands in this category.
19689
19690 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
19691 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
19692 @item COMMAND_STATUS
19693 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
19694 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
19695 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
19696 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
19697
19698 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
19699 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
19700 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
19701 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
19702 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
19703 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
19704 this category.
19705
19706 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
19707 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
19708 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
19709 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
19710 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
19711 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
19712 commands in this category.
19713
19714 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
19715 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
19716 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
19717 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
19718 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
19719 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
19720 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
19721 category.
19722
19723 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
19724 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
19725 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
19726 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
19727 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
19728 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
19729 commands in this category.
19730 @end table
19731
19732 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
19733 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
19734 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
19735 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
19736
19737 @table @code
19738 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
19739 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
19740 @item COMPLETE_NONE
19741 This constant means that no completion should be done.
19742
19743 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
19744 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
19745 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
19746 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
19747
19748 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
19749 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
19750 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
19751 This constant means that location completion should be done.
19752 @xref{Specify Location}.
19753
19754 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
19755 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
19756 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
19757 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
19758 command names.
19759
19760 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
19761 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
19762 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
19763 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
19764 as the source.
19765 @end table
19766
19767 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
19768 implemented in Python:
19769
19770 @smallexample
19771 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
19772 """Greet the whole world."""
19773
19774 def __init__ (self):
19775 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
19776
19777 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
19778 print "Hello, World!"
19779
19780 HelloWorld ()
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
19784 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
19785 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
19786 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
19787
19788 @node Functions In Python
19789 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
19790
19791 @cindex writing convenience functions
19792 @cindex convenience functions in python
19793 @cindex python convenience functions
19794 @tindex gdb.Function
19795 @tindex Function
19796 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
19797 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
19798 class @code{gdb.Function}.
19799
19800 @defmethod Function __init__ name
19801 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
19802 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
19803 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
19804 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
19805 the given @var{name}.
19806
19807 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
19808 string for the new class.
19809 @end defmethod
19810
19811 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
19812 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
19813 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
19814 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
19815 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
19816 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
19817 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
19818 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
19819
19820 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
19821 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
19822 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
19823 @end defmethod
19824
19825 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
19826 be implemented in Python:
19827
19828 @smallexample
19829 class Greet (gdb.Function):
19830 """Return string to greet someone.
19831 Takes a name as argument."""
19832
19833 def __init__ (self):
19834 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
19835
19836 def invoke (self, name):
19837 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
19838
19839 Greet ()
19840 @end smallexample
19841
19842 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
19843 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
19844 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
19845 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
19846
19847 @node Objfiles In Python
19848 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
19849
19850 @cindex objfiles in python
19851 @tindex gdb.Objfile
19852 @tindex Objfile
19853 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
19854 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
19855 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
19856 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
19857 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
19858
19859 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
19860 @code{gdb} module:
19861
19862 @findex gdb.current_objfile
19863 @defun current_objfile
19864 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
19865 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
19866 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
19867 this function returns @code{None}.
19868 @end defun
19869
19870 @findex gdb.objfiles
19871 @defun objfiles
19872 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
19873 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
19874 @end defun
19875
19876 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
19877 class.
19878
19879 @defivar Objfile filename
19880 The file name of the objfile as a string.
19881 @end defivar
19882
19883 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
19884 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
19885 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
19886 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
19887 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
19888 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing}, for more
19889 information.
19890 @end defivar
19891
19892 @node Frames In Python
19893 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
19894
19895 @cindex frames in python
19896 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
19897 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
19898 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
19899 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
19900 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
19901 exception.
19902
19903 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
19904 operator, like:
19905
19906 @smallexample
19907 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
19908 True
19909 @end smallexample
19910
19911 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
19912
19913 @findex gdb.selected_frame
19914 @defun selected_frame
19915 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
19916 @end defun
19917
19918 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
19919 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
19920 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
19921 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
19922 @end defun
19923
19924 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
19925
19926 @table @code
19927 @defmethod Frame is_valid
19928 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
19929 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
19930 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
19931 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
19932 @end defmethod
19933
19934 @defmethod Frame name
19935 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
19936 obtained.
19937 @end defmethod
19938
19939 @defmethod Frame type
19940 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
19941 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
19942 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
19943 @end defmethod
19944
19945 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
19946 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
19947 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
19948 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
19949 function to a string.
19950 @end defmethod
19951
19952 @defmethod Frame pc
19953 Returns the frame's resume address.
19954 @end defmethod
19955
19956 @defmethod Frame older
19957 Return the frame that called this frame.
19958 @end defmethod
19959
19960 @defmethod Frame newer
19961 Return the frame called by this frame.
19962 @end defmethod
19963
19964 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
19965 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
19966 be a string.
19967 @end defmethod
19968 @end table
19969
19970 @node Interpreters
19971 @chapter Command Interpreters
19972 @cindex command interpreters
19973
19974 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
19975 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
19976 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
19977
19978 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
19979 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
19980 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
19981 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
19982
19983 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
19984 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
19985 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
19986 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
19987
19988 @table @code
19989 @item console
19990 @cindex console interpreter
19991 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
19992 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
19993 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
19994
19995 @item mi
19996 @cindex mi interpreter
19997 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
19998 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
19999 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
20000 Interface}.
20001
20002 @item mi2
20003 @cindex mi2 interpreter
20004 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
20005
20006 @item mi1
20007 @cindex mi1 interpreter
20008 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
20009
20010 @end table
20011
20012 @cindex invoke another interpreter
20013 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
20014 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
20015 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
20016 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
20017 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
20018 the IDE inoperable!
20019
20020 @kindex interpreter-exec
20021 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
20022 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
20023 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
20024 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
20025
20026 @smallexample
20027 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
20031 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
20032
20033 @node TUI
20034 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
20035 @cindex TUI
20036 @cindex Text User Interface
20037
20038 @menu
20039 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
20040 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
20041 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
20042 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
20043 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
20044 @end menu
20045
20046 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
20047 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
20048 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
20049 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
20050 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
20051 is available.
20052
20053 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
20054 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
20055 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
20056 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
20057 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
20058 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
20059
20060 @node TUI Overview
20061 @section TUI Overview
20062
20063 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
20064
20065 @table @emph
20066 @item command
20067 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
20068 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
20069 managed using readline.
20070
20071 @item source
20072 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
20073 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
20074
20075 @item assembly
20076 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
20077
20078 @item register
20079 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
20080 when their values change.
20081 @end table
20082
20083 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
20084 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
20085 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
20086 indicates the breakpoint type:
20087
20088 @table @code
20089 @item B
20090 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20091
20092 @item b
20093 Breakpoint which was never hit.
20094
20095 @item H
20096 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
20097
20098 @item h
20099 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
20100 @end table
20101
20102 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
20103
20104 @table @code
20105 @item +
20106 Breakpoint is enabled.
20107
20108 @item -
20109 Breakpoint is disabled.
20110 @end table
20111
20112 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
20113 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
20114 changes.
20115
20116 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
20117 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
20118 layouts:
20119
20120 @itemize @bullet
20121 @item
20122 source only,
20123
20124 @item
20125 assembly only,
20126
20127 @item
20128 source and assembly,
20129
20130 @item
20131 source and registers, or
20132
20133 @item
20134 assembly and registers.
20135 @end itemize
20136
20137 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
20138
20139 @table @emph
20140 @item target
20141 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
20142 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20143
20144 @item process
20145 Gives the current process or thread number.
20146 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
20147
20148 @item function
20149 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
20150 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
20151 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
20152 the string @code{??} is displayed.
20153
20154 @item line
20155 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
20156 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
20157
20158 @item pc
20159 Indicates the current program counter address.
20160 @end table
20161
20162 @node TUI Keys
20163 @section TUI Key Bindings
20164 @cindex TUI key bindings
20165
20166 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
20167 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
20168 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
20169
20170 @table @kbd
20171 @kindex C-x C-a
20172 @item C-x C-a
20173 @kindex C-x a
20174 @itemx C-x a
20175 @kindex C-x A
20176 @itemx C-x A
20177 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
20178 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
20179 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
20180 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
20181 The screen is then refreshed.
20182
20183 @kindex C-x 1
20184 @item C-x 1
20185 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
20186 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
20187 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
20188
20189 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
20190
20191 @kindex C-x 2
20192 @item C-x 2
20193 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
20194 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
20195 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
20196 previous layout and the new one.
20197
20198 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
20199
20200 @kindex C-x o
20201 @item C-x o
20202 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
20203 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
20204 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
20205
20206 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
20207
20208 @kindex C-x s
20209 @item C-x s
20210 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
20211 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
20212 @end table
20213
20214 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
20215
20216 @table @asis
20217 @kindex PgUp
20218 @item @key{PgUp}
20219 Scroll the active window one page up.
20220
20221 @kindex PgDn
20222 @item @key{PgDn}
20223 Scroll the active window one page down.
20224
20225 @kindex Up
20226 @item @key{Up}
20227 Scroll the active window one line up.
20228
20229 @kindex Down
20230 @item @key{Down}
20231 Scroll the active window one line down.
20232
20233 @kindex Left
20234 @item @key{Left}
20235 Scroll the active window one column left.
20236
20237 @kindex Right
20238 @item @key{Right}
20239 Scroll the active window one column right.
20240
20241 @kindex C-L
20242 @item @kbd{C-L}
20243 Refresh the screen.
20244 @end table
20245
20246 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
20247 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
20248 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
20249 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
20250 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
20251
20252 @node TUI Single Key Mode
20253 @section TUI Single Key Mode
20254 @cindex TUI single key mode
20255
20256 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
20257 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
20258 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
20259
20260 @table @kbd
20261 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20262 @item c
20263 continue
20264
20265 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20266 @item d
20267 down
20268
20269 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20270 @item f
20271 finish
20272
20273 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20274 @item n
20275 next
20276
20277 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20278 @item q
20279 exit the SingleKey mode.
20280
20281 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20282 @item r
20283 run
20284
20285 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20286 @item s
20287 step
20288
20289 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20290 @item u
20291 up
20292
20293 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20294 @item v
20295 info locals
20296
20297 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
20298 @item w
20299 where
20300 @end table
20301
20302 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
20303 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
20304 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
20305 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
20306 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
20307 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
20308
20309
20310 @node TUI Commands
20311 @section TUI-specific Commands
20312 @cindex TUI commands
20313
20314 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
20315 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
20316 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
20317 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
20318
20319 @table @code
20320 @item info win
20321 @kindex info win
20322 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
20323
20324 @item layout next
20325 @kindex layout
20326 Display the next layout.
20327
20328 @item layout prev
20329 Display the previous layout.
20330
20331 @item layout src
20332 Display the source window only.
20333
20334 @item layout asm
20335 Display the assembly window only.
20336
20337 @item layout split
20338 Display the source and assembly window.
20339
20340 @item layout regs
20341 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
20342
20343 @item focus next
20344 @kindex focus
20345 Make the next window active for scrolling.
20346
20347 @item focus prev
20348 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
20349
20350 @item focus src
20351 Make the source window active for scrolling.
20352
20353 @item focus asm
20354 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
20355
20356 @item focus regs
20357 Make the register window active for scrolling.
20358
20359 @item focus cmd
20360 Make the command window active for scrolling.
20361
20362 @item refresh
20363 @kindex refresh
20364 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
20365
20366 @item tui reg float
20367 @kindex tui reg
20368 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
20369
20370 @item tui reg general
20371 Show the general registers in the register window.
20372
20373 @item tui reg next
20374 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
20375 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
20376 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
20377 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
20378
20379 @item tui reg system
20380 Show the system registers in the register window.
20381
20382 @item update
20383 @kindex update
20384 Update the source window and the current execution point.
20385
20386 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
20387 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
20388 @kindex winheight
20389 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
20390 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
20391 decrease it.
20392
20393 @item tabset @var{nchars}
20394 @kindex tabset
20395 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
20396 @end table
20397
20398 @node TUI Configuration
20399 @section TUI Configuration Variables
20400 @cindex TUI configuration variables
20401
20402 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
20403
20404 @table @code
20405 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
20406 @kindex set tui border-kind
20407 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
20408 The possible values are the following:
20409 @table @code
20410 @item space
20411 Use a space character to draw the border.
20412
20413 @item ascii
20414 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
20415
20416 @item acs
20417 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
20418 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
20419 @end table
20420
20421 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
20422 @kindex set tui border-mode
20423 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
20424 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
20425 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
20426 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
20427 @table @code
20428 @item normal
20429 Use normal attributes to display the border.
20430
20431 @item standout
20432 Use standout mode.
20433
20434 @item reverse
20435 Use reverse video mode.
20436
20437 @item half
20438 Use half bright mode.
20439
20440 @item half-standout
20441 Use half bright and standout mode.
20442
20443 @item bold
20444 Use extra bright or bold mode.
20445
20446 @item bold-standout
20447 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
20448 @end table
20449 @end table
20450
20451 @node Emacs
20452 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
20453
20454 @cindex Emacs
20455 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
20456 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
20457 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
20458 @value{GDBN}.
20459
20460 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
20461 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
20462 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
20463 created Emacs buffer.
20464 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
20465
20466 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
20467 things:
20468
20469 @itemize @bullet
20470 @item
20471 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
20472 the GUD buffer.
20473
20474 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
20475 and output done by the program you are debugging.
20476
20477 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
20478 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
20479 in this way.
20480
20481 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
20482 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
20483 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
20484 stop.
20485
20486 @item
20487 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
20488
20489 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
20490 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
20491 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
20492 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
20493 and the source.
20494
20495 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
20496 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
20497 @end itemize
20498
20499 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
20500 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
20501 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
20502 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
20503
20504 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
20505 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
20506 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
20507 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
20508 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
20509 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
20510 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
20511 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
20512 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
20513
20514 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
20515 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
20516 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
20517 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
20518
20519 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
20520 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
20521 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
20522 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
20523 one you want.
20524
20525 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
20526 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
20527
20528 @table @kbd
20529 @item C-h m
20530 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
20531
20532 @item C-c C-s
20533 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
20534 update the display window to show the current file and location.
20535
20536 @item C-c C-n
20537 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
20538 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
20539 to show the current file and location.
20540
20541 @item C-c C-i
20542 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
20543 display window accordingly.
20544
20545 @item C-c C-f
20546 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
20547 @code{finish} command.
20548
20549 @item C-c C-r
20550 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
20551 command.
20552
20553 @item C-c <
20554 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
20555 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
20556 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
20557
20558 @item C-c >
20559 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
20560 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
20561 @end table
20562
20563 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
20564 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
20565
20566 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
20567 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
20568 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
20569 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
20570 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
20571 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
20572 speedbar displays watch expressions.
20573
20574 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
20575 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
20576 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
20577 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
20578 frame.
20579
20580 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
20581 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
20582 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
20583 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
20584 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
20585 to correspond properly with the code.
20586
20587 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
20588 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
20589 Emacs Manual}).
20590
20591 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
20592 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
20593 @ignore
20594 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
20595 @kindex Epoch
20596 @kindex inspect
20597
20598 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
20599 called the @code{epoch}
20600 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
20601 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
20602 each value is printed in its own window.
20603 @end ignore
20604
20605
20606 @node GDB/MI
20607 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
20608
20609 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
20610
20611 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
20612 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
20613 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
20614 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
20615 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
20616 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
20617
20618 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
20619 in the form of a reference manual.
20620
20621 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
20622 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
20623 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
20624
20625 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
20626
20627 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
20628 This chapter uses the following notation:
20629
20630 @itemize @bullet
20631 @item
20632 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
20633
20634 @item
20635 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
20636 it may or may not be given.
20637
20638 @item
20639 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
20640 may repeat zero or more times.
20641
20642 @item
20643 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
20644 may repeat one or more times.
20645
20646 @item
20647 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
20648 @end itemize
20649
20650 @ignore
20651 @heading Dependencies
20652 @end ignore
20653
20654 @menu
20655 * GDB/MI General Design::
20656 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
20657 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
20658 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
20659 * GDB/MI Output Records::
20660 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
20661 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
20662 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
20663 * GDB/MI Program Context::
20664 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
20665 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
20666 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
20667 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
20668 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
20669 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
20670 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
20671 * GDB/MI File Commands::
20672 @ignore
20673 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
20674 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
20675 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
20676 @end ignore
20677 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
20678 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
20679 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
20680 @end menu
20681
20682 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20683 @node GDB/MI General Design
20684 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
20685 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
20686
20687 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
20688 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
20689 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
20690 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
20691 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
20692 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
20693 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
20694 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
20695 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
20696 a command and reported as part of that command response.
20697
20698 The important examples of notifications are:
20699 @itemize @bullet
20700
20701 @item
20702 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
20703 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
20704 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
20705 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
20706 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
20707 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
20708 command itself was successfully executed.
20709
20710 @item
20711 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
20712 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
20713 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
20714 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
20715 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
20716 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
20717
20718 @item
20719 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
20720 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
20721 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
20722 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
20723 orthogonal frontend design.
20724
20725 @end itemize
20726
20727 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
20728 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
20729 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
20730 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
20731 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
20732 the user interface.
20733
20734
20735 @menu
20736 * Context management::
20737 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
20738 * Thread groups::
20739 @end menu
20740
20741 @node Context management
20742 @subsection Context management
20743
20744 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
20745 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
20746 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
20747 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
20748 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
20749 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
20750 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
20751 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
20752 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
20753
20754 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
20755 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
20756 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
20757 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
20758 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
20759 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
20760 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
20761 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
20762 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
20763 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
20764 for thread and frame to operate on.
20765
20766 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
20767 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
20768 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
20769 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
20770 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
20771 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
20772 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
20773 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
20774 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
20775 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
20776
20777 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
20778 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
20779 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
20780 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
20781 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
20782 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
20783 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
20784 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
20785 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
20786 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
20787 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
20788 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
20789 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
20790 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
20791 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
20792 @samp{--frame} options.
20793
20794 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
20795 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
20796
20797 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
20798 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
20799 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
20800 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
20801 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
20802 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
20803 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
20804 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
20805 @code{-list-target-features} command.
20806
20807 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
20808 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
20809 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
20810 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
20811 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
20812 are running.
20813
20814 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
20815 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
20816 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
20817 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
20818 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
20819 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
20820 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
20821 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
20822 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
20823 @samp{--thread} option).
20824
20825 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
20826 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
20827 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
20828 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
20829
20830 @node Thread groups
20831 @subsection Thread groups
20832 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
20833 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
20834 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
20835 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
20836 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
20837
20838 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
20839 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
20840 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
20841 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
20842 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
20843 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
20844 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
20845 into processes.
20846
20847 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
20848 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
20849 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
20850 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
20851 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
20852 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
20853 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
20854 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
20855 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
20856 the members of specific thread group.
20857
20858 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
20859 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
20860 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
20861 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
20862 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
20863 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
20864 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
20865 after attaching to that thread group.
20866
20867 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20868 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
20869 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
20870
20871 @menu
20872 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
20873 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
20874 @end menu
20875
20876 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
20877 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
20878
20879 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
20880 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
20881 @table @code
20882 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
20883 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
20884
20885 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
20886 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
20887 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20888
20889 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
20890 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
20891 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
20892
20893 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
20894 "any sequence of digits"
20895
20896 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
20897 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
20898
20899 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
20900 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
20901
20902 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
20903 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
20904
20905 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
20906 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
20907 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
20908
20909 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
20910 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
20911
20912 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
20913 @code{CR | CR-LF}
20914 @end table
20915
20916 @noindent
20917 Notes:
20918
20919 @itemize @bullet
20920 @item
20921 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
20922 output is described below.
20923
20924 @item
20925 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
20926 finishes.
20927
20928 @item
20929 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
20930 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
20931 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
20932 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
20933 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
20934 @end itemize
20935
20936 Pragmatics:
20937
20938 @itemize @bullet
20939 @item
20940 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
20941
20942 @item
20943 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
20944 @end itemize
20945
20946 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
20947 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
20948
20949 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
20950 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
20951 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
20952 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
20953 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
20954 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
20955
20956 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
20957 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
20958 @var{token}.
20959
20960 @table @code
20961 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
20962 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
20963
20964 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
20965 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20966
20967 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
20968 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
20969
20970 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
20971 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
20972
20973 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
20974 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
20975
20976 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
20977 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
20978
20979 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
20980 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
20981
20982 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
20983 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20984
20985 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
20986 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
20987
20988 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
20989 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
20990 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
20991
20992 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
20993 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
20994
20995 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
20996 @code{ @var{string} }
20997
20998 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
20999 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
21000
21001 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
21002 @code{@var{c-string}}
21003
21004 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
21005 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
21006
21007 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
21008 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
21009 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
21010
21011 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
21012 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
21013
21014 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
21015 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
21016
21017 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
21018 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
21019
21020 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
21021 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
21022
21023 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
21024 @code{CR | CR-LF}
21025
21026 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
21027 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
21028 @end table
21029
21030 @noindent
21031 Notes:
21032
21033 @itemize @bullet
21034 @item
21035 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
21036
21037 @item
21038 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
21039 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
21040 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
21041 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
21042 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
21043 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
21044 prior command.
21045
21046 @item
21047 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21048 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
21049 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
21050 prefixed by @samp{+}.
21051
21052 @item
21053 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21054 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
21055 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
21056 @samp{*}.
21057
21058 @item
21059 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21060 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
21061 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
21062 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
21063
21064 @item
21065 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21066 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
21067 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
21068 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
21069
21070 @item
21071 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21072 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
21073 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
21074
21075 @item
21076 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21077 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
21078 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
21079 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
21080
21081 @item
21082 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
21083 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
21084 @var{values}.
21085
21086
21087 @end itemize
21088
21089 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
21090 details about the various output records.
21091
21092 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21093 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
21094 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
21095
21096 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
21097 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
21098
21099 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
21100 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
21101 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
21102 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
21103 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
21104 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
21105
21106 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
21107 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
21108 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
21109
21110 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21111 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
21112 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
21113 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
21114
21115 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
21116 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
21117
21118 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
21119 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
21120 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
21121 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
21122 might change.
21123
21124 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
21125 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
21126 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
21127 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
21128
21129 @itemize @bullet
21130 @item
21131 New MI commands may be added.
21132
21133 @item
21134 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
21135
21136 @item
21137 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
21138 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
21139
21140 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
21141 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
21142
21143 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
21144 @c resolve inconsistencies.
21145 @end itemize
21146
21147 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
21148 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
21149 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
21150 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
21151 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
21152
21153 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
21154 @c version?
21155
21156 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
21157 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
21158 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
21159 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
21160 @cindex mailing lists
21161
21162 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21163 @node GDB/MI Output Records
21164 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
21165
21166 @menu
21167 * GDB/MI Result Records::
21168 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
21169 * GDB/MI Async Records::
21170 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
21171 @end menu
21172
21173 @node GDB/MI Result Records
21174 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
21175
21176 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21177 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
21178 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
21179 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
21180
21181 @table @code
21182 @findex ^done
21183 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
21184 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
21185 values.
21186
21187 @item "^running"
21188 @findex ^running
21189 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
21190 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
21191 running.
21192
21193 @item "^connected"
21194 @findex ^connected
21195 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
21196
21197 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
21198 @findex ^error
21199 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
21200 error message.
21201
21202 @item "^exit"
21203 @findex ^exit
21204 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
21205
21206 @end table
21207
21208 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
21209 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
21210
21211 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
21212 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21213 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
21214 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
21215 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
21216
21217 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
21218 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
21219 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
21220 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
21221 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
21222
21223 @table @code
21224 @item "~" @var{string-output}
21225 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
21226 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
21227
21228 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
21229 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
21230 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
21231 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
21232
21233 @item "&" @var{string-output}
21234 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
21235 internals.
21236 @end table
21237
21238 @node GDB/MI Async Records
21239 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
21240
21241 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
21242 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
21243 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
21244 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
21245 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
21246 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
21247
21248 The following is the list of possible async records:
21249
21250 @table @code
21251
21252 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
21253 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
21254 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
21255 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
21256 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
21257 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
21258 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
21259 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
21260 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
21261 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
21262
21263 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
21264 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
21265 following values:
21266
21267 @table @code
21268 @item breakpoint-hit
21269 A breakpoint was reached.
21270 @item watchpoint-trigger
21271 A watchpoint was triggered.
21272 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
21273 A read watchpoint was triggered.
21274 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
21275 An access watchpoint was triggered.
21276 @item function-finished
21277 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
21278 @item location-reached
21279 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
21280 @item watchpoint-scope
21281 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
21282 @item end-stepping-range
21283 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
21284 similar CLI command was accomplished.
21285 @item exited-signalled
21286 The inferior exited because of a signal.
21287 @item exited
21288 The inferior exited.
21289 @item exited-normally
21290 The inferior exited normally.
21291 @item signal-received
21292 A signal was received by the inferior.
21293 @end table
21294
21295 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
21296 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
21297 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
21298 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
21299 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
21300 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
21301 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
21302 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
21303 several threads in the list.
21304
21305 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
21306 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
21307 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
21308 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
21309 thread group.
21310
21311 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
21312 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
21313 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
21314 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
21315 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
21316
21317 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
21318 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
21319 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
21320 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
21321 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
21322 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
21323 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
21324
21325 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
21326 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
21327 that thread.
21328
21329 @item =library-loaded,...
21330 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
21331 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
21332 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
21333 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
21334 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
21335 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
21336 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
21337 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
21338 library are loaded.
21339
21340 @item =library-unloaded,...
21341 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
21342 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
21343 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
21344
21345 @end table
21346
21347 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
21348 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
21349
21350 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
21351 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
21352 fields:
21353
21354 @table @code
21355 @item level
21356 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
21357 zero. This field is always present.
21358
21359 @item func
21360 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
21361 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
21362
21363 @item addr
21364 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
21365
21366 @item file
21367 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
21368 address. This field may be absent.
21369
21370 @item line
21371 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
21372 may be absent.
21373
21374 @item from
21375 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
21376 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
21377
21378 @end table
21379
21380
21381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21382 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
21383 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
21384 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
21385
21386 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
21387 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
21388 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
21389 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
21390
21391 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
21392 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
21393
21394 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
21395
21396 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
21397 information of the breakpoint.
21398
21399 @smallexample
21400 -> -break-insert main
21401 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
21402 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21403 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
21404 <- (gdb)
21405 @end smallexample
21406
21407 @subheading Program Execution
21408
21409 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
21410 reason that execution stopped.
21411
21412 @smallexample
21413 -> -exec-run
21414 <- ^running
21415 <- (gdb)
21416 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21417 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
21418 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
21419 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
21420 <- (gdb)
21421 -> -exec-continue
21422 <- ^running
21423 <- (gdb)
21424 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21425 <- (gdb)
21426 @end smallexample
21427
21428 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
21429
21430 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
21431
21432 @smallexample
21433 -> (gdb)
21434 <- -gdb-exit
21435 <- ^exit
21436 @end smallexample
21437
21438 @subheading A Bad Command
21439
21440 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
21441
21442 @smallexample
21443 -> -rubbish
21444 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
21445 <- (gdb)
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448
21449 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21450 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
21451 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
21452
21453 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
21454 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
21455
21456 @subheading Motivation
21457
21458 The motivation for this collection of commands.
21459
21460 @subheading Introduction
21461
21462 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
21463
21464 @subheading Commands
21465
21466 For each command in the block, the following is described:
21467
21468 @subsubheading Synopsis
21469
21470 @smallexample
21471 -command @var{args}@dots{}
21472 @end smallexample
21473
21474 @subsubheading Result
21475
21476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21477
21478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
21479
21480 @subsubheading Example
21481
21482 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
21483 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
21484
21485
21486 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21487 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
21488 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
21489
21490 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
21491 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
21492 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
21493 breakpoints.
21494
21495 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
21496 @findex -break-after
21497
21498 @subsubheading Synopsis
21499
21500 @smallexample
21501 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
21502 @end smallexample
21503
21504 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
21505 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
21506 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
21507 @samp{-break-list} command below.
21508
21509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21510
21511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
21512
21513 @subsubheading Example
21514
21515 @smallexample
21516 (gdb)
21517 -break-insert main
21518 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
21519 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
21520 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
21521 (gdb)
21522 -break-after 1 3
21523 ~
21524 ^done
21525 (gdb)
21526 -break-list
21527 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21528 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21529 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21530 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21531 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21532 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21533 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21534 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21535 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21536 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
21537 (gdb)
21538 @end smallexample
21539
21540 @ignore
21541 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
21542 @findex -break-catch
21543 @end ignore
21544
21545 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
21546 @findex -break-commands
21547
21548 @subsubheading Synopsis
21549
21550 @smallexample
21551 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
21552 @end smallexample
21553
21554 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
21555 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
21556 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
21557 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
21558 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
21559 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
21560
21561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21562
21563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
21564
21565 @subsubheading Example
21566
21567 @smallexample
21568 (gdb)
21569 -break-insert main
21570 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
21571 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
21572 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
21573 (gdb)
21574 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
21575 ^done
21576 (gdb)
21577 @end smallexample
21578
21579 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
21580 @findex -break-condition
21581
21582 @subsubheading Synopsis
21583
21584 @smallexample
21585 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
21586 @end smallexample
21587
21588 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
21589 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
21590 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
21591 command below).
21592
21593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21594
21595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
21596
21597 @subsubheading Example
21598
21599 @smallexample
21600 (gdb)
21601 -break-condition 1 1
21602 ^done
21603 (gdb)
21604 -break-list
21605 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21606 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21607 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21608 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21609 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21610 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21611 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21612 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21613 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21614 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
21615 (gdb)
21616 @end smallexample
21617
21618 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
21619 @findex -break-delete
21620
21621 @subsubheading Synopsis
21622
21623 @smallexample
21624 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
21625 @end smallexample
21626
21627 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
21628 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
21629
21630 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21631
21632 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
21633
21634 @subsubheading Example
21635
21636 @smallexample
21637 (gdb)
21638 -break-delete 1
21639 ^done
21640 (gdb)
21641 -break-list
21642 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
21643 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21644 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21645 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21646 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21647 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21648 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21649 body=[]@}
21650 (gdb)
21651 @end smallexample
21652
21653 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
21654 @findex -break-disable
21655
21656 @subsubheading Synopsis
21657
21658 @smallexample
21659 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
21663 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
21664
21665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21666
21667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
21668
21669 @subsubheading Example
21670
21671 @smallexample
21672 (gdb)
21673 -break-disable 2
21674 ^done
21675 (gdb)
21676 -break-list
21677 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21678 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21679 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21680 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21681 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21682 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21683 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21684 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
21685 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21686 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
21687 (gdb)
21688 @end smallexample
21689
21690 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
21691 @findex -break-enable
21692
21693 @subsubheading Synopsis
21694
21695 @smallexample
21696 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
21697 @end smallexample
21698
21699 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
21700
21701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21702
21703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
21704
21705 @subsubheading Example
21706
21707 @smallexample
21708 (gdb)
21709 -break-enable 2
21710 ^done
21711 (gdb)
21712 -break-list
21713 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21714 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21715 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21716 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21717 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21718 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21719 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21720 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21721 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21722 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
21723 (gdb)
21724 @end smallexample
21725
21726 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
21727 @findex -break-info
21728
21729 @subsubheading Synopsis
21730
21731 @smallexample
21732 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
21733 @end smallexample
21734
21735 @c REDUNDANT???
21736 Get information about a single breakpoint.
21737
21738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21739
21740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
21741
21742 @subsubheading Example
21743 N.A.
21744
21745 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
21746 @findex -break-insert
21747
21748 @subsubheading Synopsis
21749
21750 @smallexample
21751 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
21752 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
21753 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
21754 @end smallexample
21755
21756 @noindent
21757 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
21758
21759 @itemize @bullet
21760 @item function
21761 @c @item +offset
21762 @c @item -offset
21763 @c @item linenum
21764 @item filename:linenum
21765 @item filename:function
21766 @item *address
21767 @end itemize
21768
21769 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
21770
21771 @table @samp
21772 @item -t
21773 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
21774 @item -h
21775 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
21776 @item -c @var{condition}
21777 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
21778 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
21779 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
21780 @item -f
21781 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
21782 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
21783 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
21784 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
21785 cannot be parsed.
21786 @item -d
21787 Create a disabled breakpoint.
21788 @end table
21789
21790 @subsubheading Result
21791
21792 The result is in the form:
21793
21794 @smallexample
21795 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
21796 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
21797 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
21798 times="@var{times}"@}
21799 @end smallexample
21800
21801 @noindent
21802 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
21803 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
21804 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
21805 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
21806 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
21807 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
21808 which use the same output).
21809
21810 Note: this format is open to change.
21811 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
21812
21813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21814
21815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
21816 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
21817
21818 @subsubheading Example
21819
21820 @smallexample
21821 (gdb)
21822 -break-insert main
21823 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
21824 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
21825 (gdb)
21826 -break-insert -t foo
21827 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
21828 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
21829 (gdb)
21830 -break-list
21831 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21832 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21833 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21834 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21835 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21836 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21837 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21838 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21839 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
21840 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
21841 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
21842 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
21843 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
21844 (gdb)
21845 -break-insert -r foo.*
21846 ~int foo(int, int);
21847 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
21848 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
21849 (gdb)
21850 @end smallexample
21851
21852 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
21853 @findex -break-list
21854
21855 @subsubheading Synopsis
21856
21857 @smallexample
21858 -break-list
21859 @end smallexample
21860
21861 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
21862
21863 @table @samp
21864 @item Number
21865 number of the breakpoint
21866 @item Type
21867 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
21868 @item Disposition
21869 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
21870 or @samp{nokeep}
21871 @item Enabled
21872 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
21873 @item Address
21874 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
21875 @item What
21876 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
21877 name, line number
21878 @item Times
21879 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
21880 @end table
21881
21882 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
21883 @code{body} field is an empty list.
21884
21885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21886
21887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
21888
21889 @subsubheading Example
21890
21891 @smallexample
21892 (gdb)
21893 -break-list
21894 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21895 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21896 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21897 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21898 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21899 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21900 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21901 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21902 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
21903 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21904 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
21905 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
21906 (gdb)
21907 @end smallexample
21908
21909 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
21910
21911 @smallexample
21912 (gdb)
21913 -break-list
21914 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
21915 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21916 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21917 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21918 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21919 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21920 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21921 body=[]@}
21922 (gdb)
21923 @end smallexample
21924
21925 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
21926 @findex -break-watch
21927
21928 @subsubheading Synopsis
21929
21930 @smallexample
21931 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
21932 @end smallexample
21933
21934 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
21935 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
21936 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
21937 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
21938 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
21939 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
21940 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
21941 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
21942
21943 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
21944 breakpoints inserted.
21945
21946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21947
21948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
21949 @samp{rwatch}.
21950
21951 @subsubheading Example
21952
21953 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
21954
21955 @smallexample
21956 (gdb)
21957 -break-watch x
21958 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
21959 (gdb)
21960 -exec-continue
21961 ^running
21962 (gdb)
21963 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
21964 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
21965 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21966 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
21967 (gdb)
21968 @end smallexample
21969
21970 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
21971 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
21972 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
21973
21974 @smallexample
21975 (gdb)
21976 -break-watch C
21977 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
21978 (gdb)
21979 -exec-continue
21980 ^running
21981 (gdb)
21982 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
21983 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
21984 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21986 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
21987 (gdb)
21988 -exec-continue
21989 ^running
21990 (gdb)
21991 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
21992 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
21993 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21994 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21996 (gdb)
21997 @end smallexample
21998
21999 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
22000 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
22001 deleted.
22002
22003 @smallexample
22004 (gdb)
22005 -break-watch C
22006 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
22007 (gdb)
22008 -break-list
22009 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22010 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22011 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22012 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22013 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22014 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22015 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22016 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22017 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22018 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22019 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
22020 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22021 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
22022 (gdb)
22023 -exec-continue
22024 ^running
22025 (gdb)
22026 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
22027 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
22028 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22029 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22030 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
22031 (gdb)
22032 -break-list
22033 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
22034 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22035 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22036 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22037 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22038 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22039 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22040 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22041 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22042 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22043 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
22044 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
22045 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
22046 (gdb)
22047 -exec-continue
22048 ^running
22049 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
22050 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
22051 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22052 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22053 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22054 (gdb)
22055 -break-list
22056 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
22057 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
22058 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
22059 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
22060 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
22061 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
22062 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
22063 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22064 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22065 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22066 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
22067 times="1"@}]@}
22068 (gdb)
22069 @end smallexample
22070
22071 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22072 @node GDB/MI Program Context
22073 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
22074
22075 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
22076 @findex -exec-arguments
22077
22078
22079 @subsubheading Synopsis
22080
22081 @smallexample
22082 -exec-arguments @var{args}
22083 @end smallexample
22084
22085 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
22086 @samp{-exec-run}.
22087
22088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22089
22090 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
22091
22092 @subsubheading Example
22093
22094 @smallexample
22095 (gdb)
22096 -exec-arguments -v word
22097 ^done
22098 (gdb)
22099 @end smallexample
22100
22101
22102 @ignore
22103 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
22104 @findex -exec-show-arguments
22105
22106 @subsubheading Synopsis
22107
22108 @smallexample
22109 -exec-show-arguments
22110 @end smallexample
22111
22112 Print the arguments of the program.
22113
22114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22115
22116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
22117
22118 @subsubheading Example
22119 N.A.
22120 @end ignore
22121
22122
22123 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
22124 @findex -environment-cd
22125
22126 @subsubheading Synopsis
22127
22128 @smallexample
22129 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
22130 @end smallexample
22131
22132 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
22133
22134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22135
22136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
22137
22138 @subsubheading Example
22139
22140 @smallexample
22141 (gdb)
22142 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22143 ^done
22144 (gdb)
22145 @end smallexample
22146
22147
22148 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
22149 @findex -environment-directory
22150
22151 @subsubheading Synopsis
22152
22153 @smallexample
22154 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22155 @end smallexample
22156
22157 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
22158 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
22159 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
22160 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22161 occurs as normal.
22162 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22163 multiple directories in a single command
22164 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22165 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22166 If blanks are needed as
22167 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
22168 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
22169 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
22170 character must not be used
22171 in any directory name.
22172 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
22173
22174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22175
22176 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
22177
22178 @subsubheading Example
22179
22180 @smallexample
22181 (gdb)
22182 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
22183 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22184 (gdb)
22185 -environment-directory ""
22186 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
22187 (gdb)
22188 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
22189 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
22190 (gdb)
22191 -environment-directory -r
22192 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
22193 (gdb)
22194 @end smallexample
22195
22196
22197 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
22198 @findex -environment-path
22199
22200 @subsubheading Synopsis
22201
22202 @smallexample
22203 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
22204 @end smallexample
22205
22206 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
22207 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
22208 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
22209 supplied in addition to the
22210 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
22211 occurs as normal.
22212 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
22213 multiple directories in a single command
22214 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
22215 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
22216 If blanks are needed as
22217 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
22218 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
22219 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
22220 character must not be used
22221 in any directory name.
22222 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
22223
22224
22225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22226
22227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
22228
22229 @subsubheading Example
22230
22231 @smallexample
22232 (gdb)
22233 -environment-path
22234 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
22235 (gdb)
22236 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
22237 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
22238 (gdb)
22239 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
22240 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
22241 (gdb)
22242 @end smallexample
22243
22244
22245 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
22246 @findex -environment-pwd
22247
22248 @subsubheading Synopsis
22249
22250 @smallexample
22251 -environment-pwd
22252 @end smallexample
22253
22254 Show the current working directory.
22255
22256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22257
22258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
22259
22260 @subsubheading Example
22261
22262 @smallexample
22263 (gdb)
22264 -environment-pwd
22265 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
22266 (gdb)
22267 @end smallexample
22268
22269 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22270 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
22271 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
22272
22273
22274 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
22275 @findex -thread-info
22276
22277 @subsubheading Synopsis
22278
22279 @smallexample
22280 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
22281 @end smallexample
22282
22283 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
22284 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
22285 threads. When printing information about all threads,
22286 also reports the current thread.
22287
22288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22289
22290 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
22291 about all threads.
22292
22293 @subsubheading Example
22294
22295 @smallexample
22296 -thread-info
22297 ^done,threads=[
22298 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
22299 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
22300 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
22301 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
22302 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
22303 current-thread-id="1"
22304 (gdb)
22305 @end smallexample
22306
22307 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
22308
22309 @table @code
22310 @item stopped
22311 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
22312 threads.
22313
22314 @item running
22315 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
22316 threads.
22317
22318 @end table
22319
22320 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
22321 @findex -thread-list-ids
22322
22323 @subsubheading Synopsis
22324
22325 @smallexample
22326 -thread-list-ids
22327 @end smallexample
22328
22329 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
22330 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
22331
22332 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
22333 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
22334
22335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22336
22337 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
22338
22339 @subsubheading Example
22340
22341 @smallexample
22342 (gdb)
22343 -thread-list-ids
22344 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
22345 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
22346 (gdb)
22347 @end smallexample
22348
22349
22350 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
22351 @findex -thread-select
22352
22353 @subsubheading Synopsis
22354
22355 @smallexample
22356 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
22357 @end smallexample
22358
22359 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
22360 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
22361
22362 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
22363 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
22364
22365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22366
22367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
22368
22369 @subsubheading Example
22370
22371 @smallexample
22372 (gdb)
22373 -exec-next
22374 ^running
22375 (gdb)
22376 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
22377 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
22378 (gdb)
22379 -thread-list-ids
22380 ^done,
22381 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
22382 number-of-threads="3"
22383 (gdb)
22384 -thread-select 3
22385 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
22386 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
22387 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
22388 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
22389 (gdb)
22390 @end smallexample
22391
22392 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22393 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
22394 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
22395
22396 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
22397 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
22398 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
22399 other cases.
22400
22401 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
22402 @findex -exec-continue
22403
22404 @subsubheading Synopsis
22405
22406 @smallexample
22407 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
22408 @end smallexample
22409
22410 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
22411 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
22412 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
22413 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
22414 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
22415 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
22416 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
22417 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
22418 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
22419 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
22420 thread group are resumed.
22421
22422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22423
22424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
22425
22426 @subsubheading Example
22427
22428 @smallexample
22429 -exec-continue
22430 ^running
22431 (gdb)
22432 @@Hello world
22433 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
22434 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
22435 line="13"@}
22436 (gdb)
22437 @end smallexample
22438
22439
22440 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
22441 @findex -exec-finish
22442
22443 @subsubheading Synopsis
22444
22445 @smallexample
22446 -exec-finish
22447 @end smallexample
22448
22449 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
22450 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
22451
22452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22453
22454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
22455
22456 @subsubheading Example
22457
22458 Function returning @code{void}.
22459
22460 @smallexample
22461 -exec-finish
22462 ^running
22463 (gdb)
22464 @@hello from foo
22465 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
22466 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
22467 (gdb)
22468 @end smallexample
22469
22470 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
22471 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
22472 value itself.
22473
22474 @smallexample
22475 -exec-finish
22476 ^running
22477 (gdb)
22478 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
22479 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
22480 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22481 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
22482 (gdb)
22483 @end smallexample
22484
22485
22486 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
22487 @findex -exec-interrupt
22488
22489 @subsubheading Synopsis
22490
22491 @smallexample
22492 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
22493 @end smallexample
22494
22495 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
22496 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
22497 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
22498 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
22499 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
22500
22501 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
22502 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
22503 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
22504 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
22505
22506 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
22507 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
22508 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
22509 threads in that group will be interrupted.
22510
22511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22512
22513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
22514
22515 @subsubheading Example
22516
22517 @smallexample
22518 (gdb)
22519 111-exec-continue
22520 111^running
22521
22522 (gdb)
22523 222-exec-interrupt
22524 222^done
22525 (gdb)
22526 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
22527 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
22528 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
22529 (gdb)
22530
22531 (gdb)
22532 -exec-interrupt
22533 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
22534 (gdb)
22535 @end smallexample
22536
22537 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
22538 @findex -exec-jump
22539
22540 @subsubheading Synopsis
22541
22542 @smallexample
22543 -exec-jump @var{location}
22544 @end smallexample
22545
22546 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
22547 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
22548 different forms of @var{location}.
22549
22550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22551
22552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
22553
22554 @subsubheading Example
22555
22556 @smallexample
22557 -exec-jump foo.c:10
22558 *running,thread-id="all"
22559 ^running
22560 @end smallexample
22561
22562
22563 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
22564 @findex -exec-next
22565
22566 @subsubheading Synopsis
22567
22568 @smallexample
22569 -exec-next
22570 @end smallexample
22571
22572 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
22573 of the next source line is reached.
22574
22575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22576
22577 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
22578
22579 @subsubheading Example
22580
22581 @smallexample
22582 -exec-next
22583 ^running
22584 (gdb)
22585 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
22586 (gdb)
22587 @end smallexample
22588
22589
22590 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
22591 @findex -exec-next-instruction
22592
22593 @subsubheading Synopsis
22594
22595 @smallexample
22596 -exec-next-instruction
22597 @end smallexample
22598
22599 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
22600 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
22601 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
22602 printed as well.
22603
22604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22605
22606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
22607
22608 @subsubheading Example
22609
22610 @smallexample
22611 (gdb)
22612 -exec-next-instruction
22613 ^running
22614
22615 (gdb)
22616 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22617 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
22618 (gdb)
22619 @end smallexample
22620
22621
22622 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
22623 @findex -exec-return
22624
22625 @subsubheading Synopsis
22626
22627 @smallexample
22628 -exec-return
22629 @end smallexample
22630
22631 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
22632 Displays the new current frame.
22633
22634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22635
22636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
22637
22638 @subsubheading Example
22639
22640 @smallexample
22641 (gdb)
22642 200-break-insert callee4
22643 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
22644 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
22645 (gdb)
22646 000-exec-run
22647 000^running
22648 (gdb)
22649 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
22650 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
22651 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22652 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
22653 (gdb)
22654 205-break-delete
22655 205^done
22656 (gdb)
22657 111-exec-return
22658 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
22659 args=[@{name="strarg",
22660 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
22661 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22662 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
22663 (gdb)
22664 @end smallexample
22665
22666
22667 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
22668 @findex -exec-run
22669
22670 @subsubheading Synopsis
22671
22672 @smallexample
22673 -exec-run
22674 @end smallexample
22675
22676 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
22677 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
22678 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
22679 the program has exited exceptionally.
22680
22681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22682
22683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
22684
22685 @subsubheading Examples
22686
22687 @smallexample
22688 (gdb)
22689 -break-insert main
22690 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
22691 (gdb)
22692 -exec-run
22693 ^running
22694 (gdb)
22695 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
22696 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
22697 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
22698 (gdb)
22699 @end smallexample
22700
22701 @noindent
22702 Program exited normally:
22703
22704 @smallexample
22705 (gdb)
22706 -exec-run
22707 ^running
22708 (gdb)
22709 x = 55
22710 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
22711 (gdb)
22712 @end smallexample
22713
22714 @noindent
22715 Program exited exceptionally:
22716
22717 @smallexample
22718 (gdb)
22719 -exec-run
22720 ^running
22721 (gdb)
22722 x = 55
22723 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
22724 (gdb)
22725 @end smallexample
22726
22727 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
22728 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
22729
22730 @smallexample
22731 (gdb)
22732 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
22733 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
22734 @end smallexample
22735
22736
22737 @c @subheading -exec-signal
22738
22739
22740 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
22741 @findex -exec-step
22742
22743 @subsubheading Synopsis
22744
22745 @smallexample
22746 -exec-step
22747 @end smallexample
22748
22749 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
22750 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
22751 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
22752 function.
22753
22754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22755
22756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
22757
22758 @subsubheading Example
22759
22760 Stepping into a function:
22761
22762 @smallexample
22763 -exec-step
22764 ^running
22765 (gdb)
22766 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22767 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
22768 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
22769 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
22770 (gdb)
22771 @end smallexample
22772
22773 Regular stepping:
22774
22775 @smallexample
22776 -exec-step
22777 ^running
22778 (gdb)
22779 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
22780 (gdb)
22781 @end smallexample
22782
22783
22784 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
22785 @findex -exec-step-instruction
22786
22787 @subsubheading Synopsis
22788
22789 @smallexample
22790 -exec-step-instruction
22791 @end smallexample
22792
22793 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
22794 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
22795 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
22796 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
22797 well.
22798
22799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22800
22801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
22802
22803 @subsubheading Example
22804
22805 @smallexample
22806 (gdb)
22807 -exec-step-instruction
22808 ^running
22809
22810 (gdb)
22811 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22812 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
22813 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
22814 (gdb)
22815 -exec-step-instruction
22816 ^running
22817
22818 (gdb)
22819 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
22820 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
22821 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
22822 (gdb)
22823 @end smallexample
22824
22825
22826 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
22827 @findex -exec-until
22828
22829 @subsubheading Synopsis
22830
22831 @smallexample
22832 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
22833 @end smallexample
22834
22835 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
22836 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
22837 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
22838 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
22839
22840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22841
22842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
22843
22844 @subsubheading Example
22845
22846 @smallexample
22847 (gdb)
22848 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
22849 ^running
22850 (gdb)
22851 x = 55
22852 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
22853 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
22854 (gdb)
22855 @end smallexample
22856
22857 @ignore
22858 @subheading -file-clear
22859 Is this going away????
22860 @end ignore
22861
22862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22863 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
22864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
22865
22866
22867 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
22868 @findex -stack-info-frame
22869
22870 @subsubheading Synopsis
22871
22872 @smallexample
22873 -stack-info-frame
22874 @end smallexample
22875
22876 Get info on the selected frame.
22877
22878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22879
22880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
22881 (without arguments).
22882
22883 @subsubheading Example
22884
22885 @smallexample
22886 (gdb)
22887 -stack-info-frame
22888 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
22889 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22890 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
22891 (gdb)
22892 @end smallexample
22893
22894 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
22895 @findex -stack-info-depth
22896
22897 @subsubheading Synopsis
22898
22899 @smallexample
22900 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
22901 @end smallexample
22902
22903 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
22904 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
22905
22906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22907
22908 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
22909
22910 @subsubheading Example
22911
22912 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
22913
22914 @smallexample
22915 (gdb)
22916 -stack-info-depth
22917 ^done,depth="12"
22918 (gdb)
22919 -stack-info-depth 4
22920 ^done,depth="4"
22921 (gdb)
22922 -stack-info-depth 12
22923 ^done,depth="12"
22924 (gdb)
22925 -stack-info-depth 11
22926 ^done,depth="11"
22927 (gdb)
22928 -stack-info-depth 13
22929 ^done,depth="12"
22930 (gdb)
22931 @end smallexample
22932
22933 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
22934 @findex -stack-list-arguments
22935
22936 @subsubheading Synopsis
22937
22938 @smallexample
22939 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
22940 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
22941 @end smallexample
22942
22943 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
22944 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
22945 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
22946 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
22947 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
22948 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
22949 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
22950 which case only existing frames will be returned.
22951
22952 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
22953 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
22954 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
22955
22956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22957
22958 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
22959 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
22960 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
22961
22962 @subsubheading Example
22963
22964 @smallexample
22965 (gdb)
22966 -stack-list-frames
22967 ^done,
22968 stack=[
22969 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
22970 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
22972 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
22973 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22974 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
22975 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
22976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
22978 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
22979 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22980 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
22981 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
22982 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22983 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
22984 (gdb)
22985 -stack-list-arguments 0
22986 ^done,
22987 stack-args=[
22988 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22989 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
22990 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
22991 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
22992 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
22993 (gdb)
22994 -stack-list-arguments 1
22995 ^done,
22996 stack-args=[
22997 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22998 frame=@{level="1",
22999 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23000 frame=@{level="2",args=[
23001 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23002 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
23003 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
23004 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23005 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
23006 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
23007 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
23008 (gdb)
23009 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
23010 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
23011 (gdb)
23012 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
23013 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
23014 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
23015 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
23016 (gdb)
23017 @end smallexample
23018
23019 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
23020
23021
23022 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
23023 @findex -stack-list-frames
23024
23025 @subsubheading Synopsis
23026
23027 @smallexample
23028 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
23029 @end smallexample
23030
23031 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
23032 following info:
23033
23034 @table @samp
23035 @item @var{level}
23036 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
23037 @item @var{addr}
23038 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
23039 @item @var{func}
23040 Function name.
23041 @item @var{file}
23042 File name of the source file where the function lives.
23043 @item @var{line}
23044 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
23045 @end table
23046
23047 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
23048 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
23049 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
23050 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
23051 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
23052 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
23053 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
23054
23055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23056
23057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
23058
23059 @subsubheading Example
23060
23061 Full stack backtrace:
23062
23063 @smallexample
23064 (gdb)
23065 -stack-list-frames
23066 ^done,stack=
23067 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
23068 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
23069 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23070 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23071 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23072 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23073 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23074 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23075 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23076 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23077 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23078 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23079 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23081 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23082 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23083 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23084 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23085 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23086 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23087 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23089 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
23090 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
23091 (gdb)
23092 @end smallexample
23093
23094 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
23095
23096 @smallexample
23097 (gdb)
23098 -stack-list-frames 3 5
23099 ^done,stack=
23100 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23101 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23102 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23103 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
23104 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23105 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23106 (gdb)
23107 @end smallexample
23108
23109 Show a single frame:
23110
23111 @smallexample
23112 (gdb)
23113 -stack-list-frames 3 3
23114 ^done,stack=
23115 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
23116 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
23117 (gdb)
23118 @end smallexample
23119
23120
23121 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
23122 @findex -stack-list-locals
23123
23124 @subsubheading Synopsis
23125
23126 @smallexample
23127 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
23128 @end smallexample
23129
23130 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
23131 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
23132 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
23133 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
23134 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
23135 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
23136 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
23137 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
23138 more detail.
23139
23140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23141
23142 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
23143
23144 @subsubheading Example
23145
23146 @smallexample
23147 (gdb)
23148 -stack-list-locals 0
23149 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
23150 (gdb)
23151 -stack-list-locals --all-values
23152 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
23153 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
23154 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
23155 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
23156 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
23157 (gdb)
23158 @end smallexample
23159
23160
23161 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
23162 @findex -stack-select-frame
23163
23164 @subsubheading Synopsis
23165
23166 @smallexample
23167 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
23168 @end smallexample
23169
23170 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
23171 the stack.
23172
23173 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
23174 option to every command.
23175
23176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23177
23178 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
23179 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
23180
23181 @subsubheading Example
23182
23183 @smallexample
23184 (gdb)
23185 -stack-select-frame 2
23186 ^done
23187 (gdb)
23188 @end smallexample
23189
23190 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23191 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
23192 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
23193
23194 @ignore
23195
23196 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
23197
23198 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
23199 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
23200 used by @code{Insight}.
23201
23202 The two main reasons for that are:
23203
23204 @enumerate 1
23205 @item
23206 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
23207
23208 @item
23209 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
23210 now).
23211 @end enumerate
23212
23213 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
23214 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
23215 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
23216 hints about their use.
23217
23218 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
23219 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
23220 least, the following operations:
23221
23222 @itemize @bullet
23223 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
23224 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
23225 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
23226 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
23227 @end itemize
23228
23229 @end ignore
23230
23231 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
23232
23233 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
23234
23235 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
23236 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
23237 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
23238 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
23239 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
23240 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
23241 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
23242 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
23243 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
23244 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
23245 object, or to change display format.
23246
23247 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
23248 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
23249 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
23250 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
23251 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
23252 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
23253 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
23254 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
23255 child will be created.
23256
23257 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
23258 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
23259 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
23260 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
23261 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
23262
23263 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
23264 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
23265 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
23266 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
23267 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
23268 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
23269 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
23270 variables that frontend has created.
23271
23272 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
23273 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
23274 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
23275 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
23276 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
23277 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
23278 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
23279 implicitly updated.
23280
23281 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
23282 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
23283 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
23284 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
23285 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
23286 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
23287 frame. Consider this example:
23288
23289 @smallexample
23290 void do_work(...)
23291 @{
23292 struct work_state state;
23293
23294 if (...)
23295 do_work(...);
23296 @}
23297 @end smallexample
23298
23299 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
23300 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
23301 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
23302 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
23303 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
23304
23305 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
23306 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
23307 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
23308 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
23309 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
23310 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
23311
23312 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
23313 access this functionality:
23314
23315 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
23316 @item @strong{Operation}
23317 @tab @strong{Description}
23318
23319 @item @code{-var-create}
23320 @tab create a variable object
23321 @item @code{-var-delete}
23322 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
23323 @item @code{-var-set-format}
23324 @tab set the display format of this variable
23325 @item @code{-var-show-format}
23326 @tab show the display format of this variable
23327 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
23328 @tab tells how many children this object has
23329 @item @code{-var-list-children}
23330 @tab return a list of the object's children
23331 @item @code{-var-info-type}
23332 @tab show the type of this variable object
23333 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
23334 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
23335 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
23336 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
23337 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
23338 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
23339 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
23340 @tab get the value of this variable
23341 @item @code{-var-assign}
23342 @tab set the value of this variable
23343 @item @code{-var-update}
23344 @tab update the variable and its children
23345 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
23346 @tab set frozeness attribute
23347 @end multitable
23348
23349 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
23350 how it can be used.
23351
23352 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
23353
23354 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
23355 @findex -var-create
23356
23357 @subsubheading Synopsis
23358
23359 @smallexample
23360 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
23361 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
23362 @end smallexample
23363
23364 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
23365 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
23366 register.
23367
23368 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
23369 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
23370 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
23371 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
23372 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
23373
23374 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
23375 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
23376 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
23377 object must be created.
23378
23379 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
23380 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
23381
23382 @itemize @bullet
23383 @item
23384 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
23385
23386 @item
23387 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
23388
23389 @item
23390 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
23391 @end itemize
23392
23393 @subsubheading Result
23394
23395 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
23396 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
23397 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
23398 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
23399
23400 @smallexample
23401 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
23402 @end smallexample
23403
23404
23405 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
23406 @findex -var-delete
23407
23408 @subsubheading Synopsis
23409
23410 @smallexample
23411 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
23412 @end smallexample
23413
23414 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
23415 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
23416
23417 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
23418
23419
23420 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
23421 @findex -var-set-format
23422
23423 @subsubheading Synopsis
23424
23425 @smallexample
23426 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
23427 @end smallexample
23428
23429 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
23430 @var{format-spec}.
23431
23432 @anchor{-var-set-format}
23433 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
23434
23435 @smallexample
23436 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
23437 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
23438 @end smallexample
23439
23440 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
23441 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
23442 for pointers, etc.).
23443
23444 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
23445 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
23446
23447 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
23448 @findex -var-show-format
23449
23450 @subsubheading Synopsis
23451
23452 @smallexample
23453 -var-show-format @var{name}
23454 @end smallexample
23455
23456 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
23457
23458 @smallexample
23459 @var{format} @expansion{}
23460 @var{format-spec}
23461 @end smallexample
23462
23463
23464 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
23465 @findex -var-info-num-children
23466
23467 @subsubheading Synopsis
23468
23469 @smallexample
23470 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
23471 @end smallexample
23472
23473 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
23474
23475 @smallexample
23476 numchild=@var{n}
23477 @end smallexample
23478
23479
23480 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
23481 @findex -var-list-children
23482
23483 @subsubheading Synopsis
23484
23485 @smallexample
23486 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
23487 @end smallexample
23488 @anchor{-var-list-children}
23489
23490 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
23491 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
23492 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
23493 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
23494 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
23495 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
23496 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
23497 and unions.
23498
23499 For each child the following results are returned:
23500
23501 @table @var
23502
23503 @item name
23504 Name of the variable object created for this child.
23505
23506 @item exp
23507 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
23508 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
23509
23510 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
23511 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
23512 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
23513 type and value are not present.
23514
23515 @item numchild
23516 Number of children this child has.
23517
23518 @item type
23519 The type of the child.
23520
23521 @item value
23522 If values were requested, this is the value.
23523
23524 @item thread-id
23525 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
23526 Otherwise this result is not present.
23527
23528 @item frozen
23529 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
23530 @end table
23531
23532 @subsubheading Example
23533
23534 @smallexample
23535 (gdb)
23536 -var-list-children n
23537 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
23538 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
23539 (gdb)
23540 -var-list-children --all-values n
23541 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
23542 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
23543 @end smallexample
23544
23545
23546 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
23547 @findex -var-info-type
23548
23549 @subsubheading Synopsis
23550
23551 @smallexample
23552 -var-info-type @var{name}
23553 @end smallexample
23554
23555 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
23556 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
23557 @value{GDBN} CLI:
23558
23559 @smallexample
23560 type=@var{typename}
23561 @end smallexample
23562
23563
23564 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
23565 @findex -var-info-expression
23566
23567 @subsubheading Synopsis
23568
23569 @smallexample
23570 -var-info-expression @var{name}
23571 @end smallexample
23572
23573 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
23574 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
23575 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
23576
23577 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
23578 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
23579
23580 @smallexample
23581 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
23582 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
23583 @end smallexample
23584
23585 @noindent
23586 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
23587
23588 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
23589 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
23590 is of limited use.
23591
23592 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
23593 @findex -var-info-path-expression
23594
23595 @subsubheading Synopsis
23596
23597 @smallexample
23598 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
23599 @end smallexample
23600
23601 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
23602 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
23603 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
23604 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
23605 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
23606 watchpoint from a variable object.
23607
23608 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
23609 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
23610 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
23611 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
23612 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
23613 @smallexample
23614 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
23615 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
23616 @end smallexample
23617
23618 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
23619 @findex -var-show-attributes
23620
23621 @subsubheading Synopsis
23622
23623 @smallexample
23624 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
23625 @end smallexample
23626
23627 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
23628
23629 @smallexample
23630 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
23631 @end smallexample
23632
23633 @noindent
23634 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
23635
23636 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
23637 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
23638
23639 @subsubheading Synopsis
23640
23641 @smallexample
23642 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
23643 @end smallexample
23644
23645 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
23646 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
23647 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
23648 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
23649 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
23650 the current display format will be used. The current display format
23651 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
23652
23653 @smallexample
23654 value=@var{value}
23655 @end smallexample
23656
23657 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
23658 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
23659
23660 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
23661 @findex -var-assign
23662
23663 @subsubheading Synopsis
23664
23665 @smallexample
23666 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
23667 @end smallexample
23668
23669 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
23670 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
23671 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
23672 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
23673
23674 @subsubheading Example
23675
23676 @smallexample
23677 (gdb)
23678 -var-assign var1 3
23679 ^done,value="3"
23680 (gdb)
23681 -var-update *
23682 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
23683 (gdb)
23684 @end smallexample
23685
23686 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
23687 @findex -var-update
23688
23689 @subsubheading Synopsis
23690
23691 @smallexample
23692 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
23693 @end smallexample
23694
23695 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
23696 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
23697 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
23698 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
23699 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
23700 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
23701 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
23702 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
23703 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
23704 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
23705 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
23706 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
23707 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
23708
23709 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
23710 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
23711 diagnostic.
23712
23713 @subsubheading Example
23714
23715 @smallexample
23716 (gdb)
23717 -var-assign var1 3
23718 ^done,value="3"
23719 (gdb)
23720 -var-update --all-values var1
23721 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
23722 type_changed="false"@}]
23723 (gdb)
23724 @end smallexample
23725
23726 @anchor{-var-update}
23727 The field in_scope may take three values:
23728
23729 @table @code
23730 @item "true"
23731 The variable object's current value is valid.
23732
23733 @item "false"
23734 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
23735 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
23736 scope.
23737
23738 @item "invalid"
23739 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
23740 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
23741 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
23742 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
23743 objects.
23744 @end table
23745
23746 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
23747 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
23748
23749 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
23750 @findex -var-set-frozen
23751 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
23752
23753 @subsubheading Synopsis
23754
23755 @smallexample
23756 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
23757 @end smallexample
23758
23759 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
23760 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
23761 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
23762 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
23763 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
23764 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
23765 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
23766 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
23767 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
23768 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
23769 @code{-var-update} does.
23770
23771 @subsubheading Example
23772
23773 @smallexample
23774 (gdb)
23775 -var-set-frozen V 1
23776 ^done
23777 (gdb)
23778 @end smallexample
23779
23780 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
23781 @findex -var-set-visualizer
23782 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
23783
23784 @subsubheading Synopsis
23785
23786 @smallexample
23787 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
23788 @end smallexample
23789
23790 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
23791
23792 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
23793 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
23794
23795 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
23796 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
23797 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
23798 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
23799 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
23800 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
23801 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
23802
23803 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
23804 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
23805 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
23806 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
23807
23808 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
23809 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
23810 can be used to check this.
23811
23812 @subsubheading Example
23813
23814 Resetting the visualizer:
23815
23816 @smallexample
23817 (gdb)
23818 -var-set-visualizer V None
23819 ^done
23820 @end smallexample
23821
23822 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
23823
23824 @smallexample
23825 (gdb)
23826 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
23827 ^done
23828 @end smallexample
23829
23830 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
23831 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
23832
23833 @smallexample
23834 (gdb)
23835 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
23836 ^done
23837 @end smallexample
23838
23839 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23840 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
23841 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
23842
23843 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
23844 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
23845 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
23846 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
23847
23848 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
23849 @c @subheading -data-assign
23850 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
23851 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
23852 @c set variable
23853 @c @subsubheading Example
23854 @c N.A.
23855
23856 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
23857 @findex -data-disassemble
23858
23859 @subsubheading Synopsis
23860
23861 @smallexample
23862 -data-disassemble
23863 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
23864 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
23865 -- @var{mode}
23866 @end smallexample
23867
23868 @noindent
23869 Where:
23870
23871 @table @samp
23872 @item @var{start-addr}
23873 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
23874 @item @var{end-addr}
23875 is the end address
23876 @item @var{filename}
23877 is the name of the file to disassemble
23878 @item @var{linenum}
23879 is the line number to disassemble around
23880 @item @var{lines}
23881 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
23882 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
23883 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
23884 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
23885 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
23886 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
23887 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
23888 are displayed.
23889 @item @var{mode}
23890 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
23891 disassembly).
23892 @end table
23893
23894 @subsubheading Result
23895
23896 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
23897
23898 @itemize @bullet
23899 @item Address
23900 @item Func-name
23901 @item Offset
23902 @item Instruction
23903 @end itemize
23904
23905 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
23906 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
23907
23908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23909
23910 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
23911
23912 @subsubheading Example
23913
23914 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
23915
23916 @smallexample
23917 (gdb)
23918 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
23919 ^done,
23920 asm_insns=[
23921 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23922 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23923 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23924 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23925 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
23926 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
23927 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
23928 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23929 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
23930 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
23931 (gdb)
23932 @end smallexample
23933
23934 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
23935 @code{main}.
23936
23937 @smallexample
23938 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
23939 ^done,asm_insns=[
23940 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23941 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
23942 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23943 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23944 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23945 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
23946 [@dots{}]
23947 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
23948 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
23949 (gdb)
23950 @end smallexample
23951
23952 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
23953
23954 @smallexample
23955 (gdb)
23956 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
23957 ^done,asm_insns=[
23958 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23959 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
23960 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23961 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23962 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23963 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
23964 (gdb)
23965 @end smallexample
23966
23967 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
23968
23969 @smallexample
23970 (gdb)
23971 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
23972 ^done,asm_insns=[
23973 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
23974 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
23975 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
23976 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
23977 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
23978 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
23979 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
23980 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
23981 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
23982 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
23983 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
23984 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
23985 (gdb)
23986 @end smallexample
23987
23988
23989 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
23990 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
23991
23992 @subsubheading Synopsis
23993
23994 @smallexample
23995 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
23996 @end smallexample
23997
23998 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
23999 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
24000 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
24001
24002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24003
24004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
24005 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
24006 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
24007
24008 @subsubheading Example
24009
24010 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
24011 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
24012 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
24013 output.
24014
24015 @smallexample
24016 211-data-evaluate-expression A
24017 211^done,value="1"
24018 (gdb)
24019 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
24020 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
24021 (gdb)
24022 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
24023 411^done,value="4"
24024 (gdb)
24025 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
24026 511^done,value="4"
24027 (gdb)
24028 @end smallexample
24029
24030
24031 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
24032 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
24033
24034 @subsubheading Synopsis
24035
24036 @smallexample
24037 -data-list-changed-registers
24038 @end smallexample
24039
24040 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
24041
24042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24043
24044 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
24045 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
24046
24047 @subsubheading Example
24048
24049 On a PPC MBX board:
24050
24051 @smallexample
24052 (gdb)
24053 -exec-continue
24054 ^running
24055
24056 (gdb)
24057 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
24058 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
24059 line="5"@}
24060 (gdb)
24061 -data-list-changed-registers
24062 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
24063 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
24064 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
24065 (gdb)
24066 @end smallexample
24067
24068
24069 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
24070 @findex -data-list-register-names
24071
24072 @subsubheading Synopsis
24073
24074 @smallexample
24075 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
24076 @end smallexample
24077
24078 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
24079 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
24080 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
24081 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
24082 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
24083 include empty register names.
24084
24085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24086
24087 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
24088 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
24089 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
24090
24091 @subsubheading Example
24092
24093 For the PPC MBX board:
24094 @smallexample
24095 (gdb)
24096 -data-list-register-names
24097 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
24098 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
24099 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
24100 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
24101 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
24102 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
24103 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
24104 (gdb)
24105 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
24106 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
24107 (gdb)
24108 @end smallexample
24109
24110 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
24111 @findex -data-list-register-values
24112
24113 @subsubheading Synopsis
24114
24115 @smallexample
24116 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
24117 @end smallexample
24118
24119 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
24120 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
24121 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
24122 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
24123
24124 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
24125
24126 @table @code
24127 @item x
24128 Hexadecimal
24129 @item o
24130 Octal
24131 @item t
24132 Binary
24133 @item d
24134 Decimal
24135 @item r
24136 Raw
24137 @item N
24138 Natural
24139 @end table
24140
24141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24142
24143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
24144 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
24145
24146 @subsubheading Example
24147
24148 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
24149 don't appear in the actual output):
24150
24151 @smallexample
24152 (gdb)
24153 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
24154 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
24155 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
24156 (gdb)
24157 -data-list-register-values x
24158 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
24159 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
24160 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
24161 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
24162 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
24163 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
24164 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
24165 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
24166 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
24167 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
24168 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
24169 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
24170 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
24171 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
24172 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
24173 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
24174 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
24175 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
24176 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
24177 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
24178 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
24179 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
24180 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
24181 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
24182 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
24183 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
24184 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
24185 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
24186 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
24187 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
24188 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
24189 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
24190 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
24191 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
24192 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
24193 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
24194 (gdb)
24195 @end smallexample
24196
24197
24198 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
24199 @findex -data-read-memory
24200
24201 @subsubheading Synopsis
24202
24203 @smallexample
24204 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
24205 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
24206 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
24207 @end smallexample
24208
24209 @noindent
24210 where:
24211
24212 @table @samp
24213 @item @var{address}
24214 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
24215 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
24216 quoted using the C convention.
24217
24218 @item @var{word-format}
24219 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
24220 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
24221 ,Output Formats}).
24222
24223 @item @var{word-size}
24224 The size of each memory word in bytes.
24225
24226 @item @var{nr-rows}
24227 The number of rows in the output table.
24228
24229 @item @var{nr-cols}
24230 The number of columns in the output table.
24231
24232 @item @var{aschar}
24233 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
24234 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
24235 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
24236 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
24237
24238 @item @var{byte-offset}
24239 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
24240 @end table
24241
24242 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
24243 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
24244 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
24245 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
24246 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
24247 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
24248 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
24249 @samp{addr}.
24250
24251 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
24252 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
24253 @samp{prev-page}.
24254
24255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24256
24257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
24258 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
24259
24260 @subsubheading Example
24261
24262 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
24263 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
24264 word. Display each word in hex.
24265
24266 @smallexample
24267 (gdb)
24268 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
24269 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
24270 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
24271 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
24272 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
24273 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
24274 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
24275 (gdb)
24276 @end smallexample
24277
24278 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
24279 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
24280
24281 @smallexample
24282 (gdb)
24283 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
24284 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
24285 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
24286 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
24287 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
24288 (gdb)
24289 @end smallexample
24290
24291 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
24292 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
24293 used as the non-printable character.
24294
24295 @smallexample
24296 (gdb)
24297 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
24298 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
24299 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
24300 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
24301 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
24302 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
24303 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
24304 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
24305 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
24306 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
24307 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
24308 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
24309 (gdb)
24310 @end smallexample
24311
24312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24313 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
24314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
24315
24316 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
24317
24318 @c @subheading -trace-actions
24319
24320 @c @subheading -trace-delete
24321
24322 @c @subheading -trace-disable
24323
24324 @c @subheading -trace-dump
24325
24326 @c @subheading -trace-enable
24327
24328 @c @subheading -trace-exists
24329
24330 @c @subheading -trace-find
24331
24332 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
24333
24334 @c @subheading -trace-info
24335
24336 @c @subheading -trace-insert
24337
24338 @c @subheading -trace-list
24339
24340 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
24341
24342 @c @subheading -trace-save
24343
24344 @c @subheading -trace-start
24345
24346 @c @subheading -trace-stop
24347
24348
24349 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24350 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
24351 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
24352
24353
24354 @ignore
24355 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
24356 @findex -symbol-info-address
24357
24358 @subsubheading Synopsis
24359
24360 @smallexample
24361 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
24362 @end smallexample
24363
24364 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
24365
24366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24367
24368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
24369
24370 @subsubheading Example
24371 N.A.
24372
24373
24374 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
24375 @findex -symbol-info-file
24376
24377 @subsubheading Synopsis
24378
24379 @smallexample
24380 -symbol-info-file
24381 @end smallexample
24382
24383 Show the file for the symbol.
24384
24385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24386
24387 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
24388 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
24389
24390 @subsubheading Example
24391 N.A.
24392
24393
24394 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
24395 @findex -symbol-info-function
24396
24397 @subsubheading Synopsis
24398
24399 @smallexample
24400 -symbol-info-function
24401 @end smallexample
24402
24403 Show which function the symbol lives in.
24404
24405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24406
24407 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
24408
24409 @subsubheading Example
24410 N.A.
24411
24412
24413 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
24414 @findex -symbol-info-line
24415
24416 @subsubheading Synopsis
24417
24418 @smallexample
24419 -symbol-info-line
24420 @end smallexample
24421
24422 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
24423
24424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24425
24426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
24427 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
24428
24429 @subsubheading Example
24430 N.A.
24431
24432
24433 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
24434 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
24435
24436 @subsubheading Synopsis
24437
24438 @smallexample
24439 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
24440 @end smallexample
24441
24442 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
24443
24444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24445
24446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
24447
24448 @subsubheading Example
24449 N.A.
24450
24451
24452 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
24453 @findex -symbol-list-functions
24454
24455 @subsubheading Synopsis
24456
24457 @smallexample
24458 -symbol-list-functions
24459 @end smallexample
24460
24461 List the functions in the executable.
24462
24463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24464
24465 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
24466 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
24467
24468 @subsubheading Example
24469 N.A.
24470 @end ignore
24471
24472
24473 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
24474 @findex -symbol-list-lines
24475
24476 @subsubheading Synopsis
24477
24478 @smallexample
24479 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
24480 @end smallexample
24481
24482 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
24483 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
24484 ascending PC order.
24485
24486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24487
24488 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
24489
24490 @subsubheading Example
24491 @smallexample
24492 (gdb)
24493 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
24494 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
24495 (gdb)
24496 @end smallexample
24497
24498
24499 @ignore
24500 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
24501 @findex -symbol-list-types
24502
24503 @subsubheading Synopsis
24504
24505 @smallexample
24506 -symbol-list-types
24507 @end smallexample
24508
24509 List all the type names.
24510
24511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24512
24513 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
24514 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
24515
24516 @subsubheading Example
24517 N.A.
24518
24519
24520 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
24521 @findex -symbol-list-variables
24522
24523 @subsubheading Synopsis
24524
24525 @smallexample
24526 -symbol-list-variables
24527 @end smallexample
24528
24529 List all the global and static variable names.
24530
24531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24532
24533 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
24534
24535 @subsubheading Example
24536 N.A.
24537
24538
24539 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
24540 @findex -symbol-locate
24541
24542 @subsubheading Synopsis
24543
24544 @smallexample
24545 -symbol-locate
24546 @end smallexample
24547
24548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24549
24550 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
24551
24552 @subsubheading Example
24553 N.A.
24554
24555
24556 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
24557 @findex -symbol-type
24558
24559 @subsubheading Synopsis
24560
24561 @smallexample
24562 -symbol-type @var{variable}
24563 @end smallexample
24564
24565 Show type of @var{variable}.
24566
24567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24568
24569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
24570 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
24571
24572 @subsubheading Example
24573 N.A.
24574 @end ignore
24575
24576
24577 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24578 @node GDB/MI File Commands
24579 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
24580
24581 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
24582 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
24583
24584 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
24585 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
24586
24587 @subsubheading Synopsis
24588
24589 @smallexample
24590 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
24591 @end smallexample
24592
24593 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
24594 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
24595 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
24596 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
24597 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
24598 notification.
24599
24600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24601
24602 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
24603
24604 @subsubheading Example
24605
24606 @smallexample
24607 (gdb)
24608 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
24609 ^done
24610 (gdb)
24611 @end smallexample
24612
24613
24614 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
24615 @findex -file-exec-file
24616
24617 @subsubheading Synopsis
24618
24619 @smallexample
24620 -file-exec-file @var{file}
24621 @end smallexample
24622
24623 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
24624 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
24625 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
24626 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
24627 notification.
24628
24629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24630
24631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
24632
24633 @subsubheading Example
24634
24635 @smallexample
24636 (gdb)
24637 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
24638 ^done
24639 (gdb)
24640 @end smallexample
24641
24642
24643 @ignore
24644 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
24645 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
24646
24647 @subsubheading Synopsis
24648
24649 @smallexample
24650 -file-list-exec-sections
24651 @end smallexample
24652
24653 List the sections of the current executable file.
24654
24655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24656
24657 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
24658 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
24659 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
24660
24661 @subsubheading Example
24662 N.A.
24663 @end ignore
24664
24665
24666 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
24667 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
24668
24669 @subsubheading Synopsis
24670
24671 @smallexample
24672 -file-list-exec-source-file
24673 @end smallexample
24674
24675 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
24676 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
24677 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
24678 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
24679
24680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24681
24682 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
24683
24684 @subsubheading Example
24685
24686 @smallexample
24687 (gdb)
24688 123-file-list-exec-source-file
24689 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
24690 (gdb)
24691 @end smallexample
24692
24693
24694 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
24695 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
24696
24697 @subsubheading Synopsis
24698
24699 @smallexample
24700 -file-list-exec-source-files
24701 @end smallexample
24702
24703 List the source files for the current executable.
24704
24705 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
24706 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
24707
24708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24709
24710 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
24711 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
24712
24713 @subsubheading Example
24714 @smallexample
24715 (gdb)
24716 -file-list-exec-source-files
24717 ^done,files=[
24718 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
24719 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
24720 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
24721 (gdb)
24722 @end smallexample
24723
24724 @ignore
24725 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
24726 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
24727
24728 @subsubheading Synopsis
24729
24730 @smallexample
24731 -file-list-shared-libraries
24732 @end smallexample
24733
24734 List the shared libraries in the program.
24735
24736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24737
24738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
24739
24740 @subsubheading Example
24741 N.A.
24742
24743
24744 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
24745 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
24746
24747 @subsubheading Synopsis
24748
24749 @smallexample
24750 -file-list-symbol-files
24751 @end smallexample
24752
24753 List symbol files.
24754
24755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24756
24757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
24758
24759 @subsubheading Example
24760 N.A.
24761 @end ignore
24762
24763
24764 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
24765 @findex -file-symbol-file
24766
24767 @subsubheading Synopsis
24768
24769 @smallexample
24770 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
24771 @end smallexample
24772
24773 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
24774 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
24775 produced, except for a completion notification.
24776
24777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24778
24779 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
24780
24781 @subsubheading Example
24782
24783 @smallexample
24784 (gdb)
24785 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
24786 ^done
24787 (gdb)
24788 @end smallexample
24789
24790 @ignore
24791 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24792 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
24793 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
24794
24795 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
24796
24797 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
24798
24799 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
24800
24801 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
24802
24803 @c @subheading -overlay-map
24804
24805 @c @subheading -overlay-off
24806
24807 @c @subheading -overlay-on
24808
24809 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
24810
24811 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24812 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
24813 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
24814
24815 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
24816
24817 @c @subheading -signal-handle
24818
24819 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
24820
24821 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
24822 @end ignore
24823
24824
24825 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24826 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
24827 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
24828
24829
24830 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
24831 @findex -target-attach
24832
24833 @subsubheading Synopsis
24834
24835 @smallexample
24836 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
24837 @end smallexample
24838
24839 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
24840 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
24841 group, the id previously returned by
24842 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
24843
24844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24845
24846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
24847
24848 @subsubheading Example
24849 @smallexample
24850 (gdb)
24851 -target-attach 34
24852 =thread-created,id="1"
24853 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
24854 ^done
24855 (gdb)
24856 @end smallexample
24857
24858 @ignore
24859 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
24860 @findex -target-compare-sections
24861
24862 @subsubheading Synopsis
24863
24864 @smallexample
24865 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
24866 @end smallexample
24867
24868 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
24869 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
24870
24871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24872
24873 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
24874
24875 @subsubheading Example
24876 N.A.
24877 @end ignore
24878
24879
24880 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
24881 @findex -target-detach
24882
24883 @subsubheading Synopsis
24884
24885 @smallexample
24886 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
24887 @end smallexample
24888
24889 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
24890 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
24891 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
24892
24893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24894
24895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
24896
24897 @subsubheading Example
24898
24899 @smallexample
24900 (gdb)
24901 -target-detach
24902 ^done
24903 (gdb)
24904 @end smallexample
24905
24906
24907 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
24908 @findex -target-disconnect
24909
24910 @subsubheading Synopsis
24911
24912 @smallexample
24913 -target-disconnect
24914 @end smallexample
24915
24916 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
24917 generally not resumed.
24918
24919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24920
24921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
24922
24923 @subsubheading Example
24924
24925 @smallexample
24926 (gdb)
24927 -target-disconnect
24928 ^done
24929 (gdb)
24930 @end smallexample
24931
24932
24933 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
24934 @findex -target-download
24935
24936 @subsubheading Synopsis
24937
24938 @smallexample
24939 -target-download
24940 @end smallexample
24941
24942 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
24943 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
24944
24945 @table @samp
24946 @item section
24947 The name of the section.
24948 @item section-sent
24949 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
24950 @item section-size
24951 The size of the section.
24952 @item total-sent
24953 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
24954 @item total-size
24955 The size of the overall executable to download.
24956 @end table
24957
24958 @noindent
24959 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
24960 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
24961
24962 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
24963 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
24964
24965 @table @samp
24966 @item section
24967 The name of the section.
24968 @item section-size
24969 The size of the section.
24970 @item total-size
24971 The size of the overall executable to download.
24972 @end table
24973
24974 @noindent
24975 At the end, a summary is printed.
24976
24977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24978
24979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
24980
24981 @subsubheading Example
24982
24983 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
24984 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
24985
24986 @smallexample
24987 (gdb)
24988 -target-download
24989 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
24990 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
24991 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
24992 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
24993 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
24994 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
24995 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
24996 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
24997 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
24998 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
24999 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
25000 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
25001 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
25002 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
25003 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
25004 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
25005 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
25006 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
25007 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
25008 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
25009 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
25010 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
25011 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
25012 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
25013 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
25014 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
25015 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
25016 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
25017 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
25018 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
25019 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
25020 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
25021 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
25022 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
25023 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
25024 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
25025 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
25026 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
25027 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
25028 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
25029 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
25030 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
25031 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
25032 write-rate="429"
25033 (gdb)
25034 @end smallexample
25035
25036
25037 @ignore
25038 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
25039 @findex -target-exec-status
25040
25041 @subsubheading Synopsis
25042
25043 @smallexample
25044 -target-exec-status
25045 @end smallexample
25046
25047 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
25048 not, for instance).
25049
25050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25051
25052 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
25053
25054 @subsubheading Example
25055 N.A.
25056
25057
25058 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
25059 @findex -target-list-available-targets
25060
25061 @subsubheading Synopsis
25062
25063 @smallexample
25064 -target-list-available-targets
25065 @end smallexample
25066
25067 List the possible targets to connect to.
25068
25069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25070
25071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
25072
25073 @subsubheading Example
25074 N.A.
25075
25076
25077 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
25078 @findex -target-list-current-targets
25079
25080 @subsubheading Synopsis
25081
25082 @smallexample
25083 -target-list-current-targets
25084 @end smallexample
25085
25086 Describe the current target.
25087
25088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25089
25090 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
25091 other things).
25092
25093 @subsubheading Example
25094 N.A.
25095
25096
25097 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
25098 @findex -target-list-parameters
25099
25100 @subsubheading Synopsis
25101
25102 @smallexample
25103 -target-list-parameters
25104 @end smallexample
25105
25106 @c ????
25107 @end ignore
25108
25109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25110
25111 No equivalent.
25112
25113 @subsubheading Example
25114 N.A.
25115
25116
25117 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
25118 @findex -target-select
25119
25120 @subsubheading Synopsis
25121
25122 @smallexample
25123 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
25124 @end smallexample
25125
25126 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
25127
25128 @table @samp
25129 @item @var{type}
25130 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
25131 @item @var{parameters}
25132 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
25133 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
25134 @end table
25135
25136 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
25137 which the target program is, in the following form:
25138
25139 @smallexample
25140 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
25141 args=[@var{arg list}]
25142 @end smallexample
25143
25144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25145
25146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
25147
25148 @subsubheading Example
25149
25150 @smallexample
25151 (gdb)
25152 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
25153 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
25154 (gdb)
25155 @end smallexample
25156
25157 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25158 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
25159 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
25160
25161
25162 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
25163 @findex -target-file-put
25164
25165 @subsubheading Synopsis
25166
25167 @smallexample
25168 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
25169 @end smallexample
25170
25171 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
25172 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
25173
25174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25175
25176 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
25177
25178 @subsubheading Example
25179
25180 @smallexample
25181 (gdb)
25182 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
25183 ^done
25184 (gdb)
25185 @end smallexample
25186
25187
25188 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
25189 @findex -target-file-get
25190
25191 @subsubheading Synopsis
25192
25193 @smallexample
25194 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
25195 @end smallexample
25196
25197 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
25198 on the host system.
25199
25200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25201
25202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
25203
25204 @subsubheading Example
25205
25206 @smallexample
25207 (gdb)
25208 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
25209 ^done
25210 (gdb)
25211 @end smallexample
25212
25213
25214 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
25215 @findex -target-file-delete
25216
25217 @subsubheading Synopsis
25218
25219 @smallexample
25220 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
25221 @end smallexample
25222
25223 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
25224
25225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25226
25227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
25228
25229 @subsubheading Example
25230
25231 @smallexample
25232 (gdb)
25233 -target-file-delete remotefile
25234 ^done
25235 (gdb)
25236 @end smallexample
25237
25238
25239 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25240 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
25241 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
25242
25243 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
25244
25245 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
25246 @findex -gdb-exit
25247
25248 @subsubheading Synopsis
25249
25250 @smallexample
25251 -gdb-exit
25252 @end smallexample
25253
25254 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
25255
25256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25257
25258 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
25259
25260 @subsubheading Example
25261
25262 @smallexample
25263 (gdb)
25264 -gdb-exit
25265 ^exit
25266 @end smallexample
25267
25268
25269 @ignore
25270 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
25271 @findex -exec-abort
25272
25273 @subsubheading Synopsis
25274
25275 @smallexample
25276 -exec-abort
25277 @end smallexample
25278
25279 Kill the inferior running program.
25280
25281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25282
25283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
25284
25285 @subsubheading Example
25286 N.A.
25287 @end ignore
25288
25289
25290 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
25291 @findex -gdb-set
25292
25293 @subsubheading Synopsis
25294
25295 @smallexample
25296 -gdb-set
25297 @end smallexample
25298
25299 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
25300 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
25301
25302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25303
25304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
25305
25306 @subsubheading Example
25307
25308 @smallexample
25309 (gdb)
25310 -gdb-set $foo=3
25311 ^done
25312 (gdb)
25313 @end smallexample
25314
25315
25316 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
25317 @findex -gdb-show
25318
25319 @subsubheading Synopsis
25320
25321 @smallexample
25322 -gdb-show
25323 @end smallexample
25324
25325 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
25326
25327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25328
25329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
25330
25331 @subsubheading Example
25332
25333 @smallexample
25334 (gdb)
25335 -gdb-show annotate
25336 ^done,value="0"
25337 (gdb)
25338 @end smallexample
25339
25340 @c @subheading -gdb-source
25341
25342
25343 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
25344 @findex -gdb-version
25345
25346 @subsubheading Synopsis
25347
25348 @smallexample
25349 -gdb-version
25350 @end smallexample
25351
25352 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
25353
25354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25355
25356 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
25357 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
25358
25359 @subsubheading Example
25360
25361 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
25362 @c box in TeX.
25363 @smallexample
25364 (gdb)
25365 -gdb-version
25366 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
25367 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25368 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
25369 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
25370 ~ certain conditions.
25371 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
25372 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
25373 ~ details.
25374 ~This GDB was configured as
25375 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
25376 ^done
25377 (gdb)
25378 @end smallexample
25379
25380 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
25381 @findex -list-features
25382
25383 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
25384 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
25385 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
25386 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
25387 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
25388 startup.
25389
25390 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
25391 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
25392 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
25393 is given below.
25394
25395 Example output:
25396
25397 @smallexample
25398 (gdb) -list-features
25399 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
25400 @end smallexample
25401
25402 The current list of features is:
25403
25404 @table @samp
25405 @item frozen-varobjs
25406 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
25407 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
25408 of @code{-varobj-create}.
25409 @item pending-breakpoints
25410 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
25411 @item python
25412 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
25413 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
25414 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
25415 @item thread-info
25416 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
25417
25418 @end table
25419
25420 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
25421 @findex -list-target-features
25422
25423 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
25424 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
25425 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
25426 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
25427 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
25428 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
25429 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
25430 Example output:
25431
25432 @smallexample
25433 (gdb) -list-features
25434 ^done,result=["async"]
25435 @end smallexample
25436
25437 The current list of features is:
25438
25439 @table @samp
25440 @item async
25441 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
25442 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
25443 while the target is running.
25444
25445 @end table
25446
25447 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
25448 @findex -list-thread-groups
25449
25450 @subheading Synopsis
25451
25452 @smallexample
25453 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
25454 @end smallexample
25455
25456 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
25457 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
25458 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
25459 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
25460 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
25461 the same time, but it may change in future.
25462
25463 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
25464 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
25465 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
25466 is not allowed.
25467
25468 @subheading Example
25469
25470 @smallexample
25471 @value{GDBP}
25472 -list-thread-groups
25473 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
25474 -list-thread-groups 17
25475 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
25476 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
25477 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
25478 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
25479 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
25480 @end smallexample
25481
25482 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
25483 @findex -interpreter-exec
25484
25485 @subheading Synopsis
25486
25487 @smallexample
25488 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
25489 @end smallexample
25490 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
25491
25492 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
25493
25494 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
25495
25496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
25497
25498 @subheading Example
25499
25500 @smallexample
25501 (gdb)
25502 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
25503 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
25504 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
25505 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
25506 ^done
25507 (gdb)
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
25511 @findex -inferior-tty-set
25512
25513 @subheading Synopsis
25514
25515 @smallexample
25516 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
25517 @end smallexample
25518
25519 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
25520
25521 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
25522
25523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
25524
25525 @subheading Example
25526
25527 @smallexample
25528 (gdb)
25529 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
25530 ^done
25531 (gdb)
25532 @end smallexample
25533
25534 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
25535 @findex -inferior-tty-show
25536
25537 @subheading Synopsis
25538
25539 @smallexample
25540 -inferior-tty-show
25541 @end smallexample
25542
25543 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
25544
25545 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
25546
25547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
25548
25549 @subheading Example
25550
25551 @smallexample
25552 (gdb)
25553 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
25554 ^done
25555 (gdb)
25556 -inferior-tty-show
25557 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
25558 (gdb)
25559 @end smallexample
25560
25561 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
25562 @findex -enable-timings
25563
25564 @subheading Synopsis
25565
25566 @smallexample
25567 -enable-timings [yes | no]
25568 @end smallexample
25569
25570 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
25571 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
25572 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
25573 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
25574
25575 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
25576
25577 No equivalent.
25578
25579 @subheading Example
25580
25581 @smallexample
25582 (gdb)
25583 -enable-timings
25584 ^done
25585 (gdb)
25586 -break-insert main
25587 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25588 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25589 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
25590 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
25591 (gdb)
25592 -enable-timings no
25593 ^done
25594 (gdb)
25595 -exec-run
25596 ^running
25597 (gdb)
25598 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25599 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
25600 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
25601 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
25602 (gdb)
25603 @end smallexample
25604
25605 @node Annotations
25606 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
25607
25608 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
25609 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
25610 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
25611 relatively high level.
25612
25613 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
25614 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
25615
25616 @ignore
25617 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
25618 @end ignore
25619
25620 @menu
25621 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
25622 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
25623 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
25624 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
25625 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
25626 * Annotations for Running::
25627 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
25628 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
25629 @end menu
25630
25631 @node Annotations Overview
25632 @section What is an Annotation?
25633 @cindex annotations
25634
25635 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
25636 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
25637 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
25638 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
25639 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
25640 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
25641 cannot contain newline characters.
25642
25643 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
25644 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
25645 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
25646 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
25647 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
25648 means those three characters as output.
25649
25650 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
25651 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
25652 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
25653 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
25654 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
25655 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
25656 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
25657 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
25658 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
25659
25660 @table @code
25661 @kindex set annotate
25662 @item set annotate @var{level}
25663 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
25664 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
25665
25666 @item show annotate
25667 @kindex show annotate
25668 Show the current annotation level.
25669 @end table
25670
25671 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
25672
25673 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
25674
25675 @smallexample
25676 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
25677 GNU gdb 6.0
25678 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25679 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
25680 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
25681 under certain conditions.
25682 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
25683 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
25684 for details.
25685 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
25686
25687 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
25688 (@value{GDBP})
25689 ^Z^Zprompt
25690 @kbd{quit}
25691
25692 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
25693 $
25694 @end smallexample
25695
25696 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
25697 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
25698 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
25699 output from @value{GDBN}.
25700
25701 @node Server Prefix
25702 @section The Server Prefix
25703 @cindex server prefix
25704
25705 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
25706 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
25707 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
25708 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
25709 a transparent manner.
25710
25711 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
25712 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
25713 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
25714 @code{print} command.
25715
25716 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
25717 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
25718
25719 @node Prompting
25720 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
25721
25722 @cindex annotations for prompts
25723 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
25724 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
25725 over, etc.
25726
25727 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
25728 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
25729 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
25730 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
25731 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
25732 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
25733 features the following annotations:
25734
25735 @smallexample
25736 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
25737 ^Z^Zprompt
25738 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
25739 @end smallexample
25740
25741 The input types are
25742
25743 @table @code
25744 @findex pre-prompt annotation
25745 @findex prompt annotation
25746 @findex post-prompt annotation
25747 @item prompt
25748 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
25749
25750 @findex pre-commands annotation
25751 @findex commands annotation
25752 @findex post-commands annotation
25753 @item commands
25754 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
25755 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
25756
25757 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
25758 @findex overload-choice annotation
25759 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
25760 @item overload-choice
25761 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
25762
25763 @findex pre-query annotation
25764 @findex query annotation
25765 @findex post-query annotation
25766 @item query
25767 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
25768
25769 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
25770 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
25771 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
25772 @item prompt-for-continue
25773 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
25774 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
25775 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
25776 presence of annotations.
25777 @end table
25778
25779 @node Errors
25780 @section Errors
25781 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
25782
25783 @findex quit annotation
25784 @smallexample
25785 ^Z^Zquit
25786 @end smallexample
25787
25788 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
25789
25790 @findex error annotation
25791 @smallexample
25792 ^Z^Zerror
25793 @end smallexample
25794
25795 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
25796
25797 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
25798 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
25799 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
25800 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
25801 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
25802 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
25803 to the top level.
25804
25805 @findex error-begin annotation
25806 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
25807
25808 @smallexample
25809 ^Z^Zerror-begin
25810 @end smallexample
25811
25812 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
25813 message.
25814
25815 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
25816 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
25817 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
25818
25819 @node Invalidation
25820 @section Invalidation Notices
25821
25822 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
25823 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
25824 changed.
25825
25826 @table @code
25827 @findex frames-invalid annotation
25828 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
25829
25830 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
25831 have changed.
25832
25833 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
25834 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
25835
25836 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
25837 deleted a breakpoint.
25838 @end table
25839
25840 @node Annotations for Running
25841 @section Running the Program
25842 @cindex annotations for running programs
25843
25844 @findex starting annotation
25845 @findex stopping annotation
25846 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
25847 @code{step} or @code{continue},
25848
25849 @smallexample
25850 ^Z^Zstarting
25851 @end smallexample
25852
25853 is output. When the program stops,
25854
25855 @smallexample
25856 ^Z^Zstopped
25857 @end smallexample
25858
25859 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
25860 annotations describe how the program stopped.
25861
25862 @table @code
25863 @findex exited annotation
25864 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
25865 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
25866 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
25867
25868 @findex signalled annotation
25869 @findex signal-name annotation
25870 @findex signal-name-end annotation
25871 @findex signal-string annotation
25872 @findex signal-string-end annotation
25873 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
25874 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
25875 annotation continues:
25876
25877 @smallexample
25878 @var{intro-text}
25879 ^Z^Zsignal-name
25880 @var{name}
25881 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
25882 @var{middle-text}
25883 ^Z^Zsignal-string
25884 @var{string}
25885 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
25886 @var{end-text}
25887 @end smallexample
25888
25889 @noindent
25890 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
25891 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
25892 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
25893 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
25894 user's benefit and have no particular format.
25895
25896 @findex signal annotation
25897 @item ^Z^Zsignal
25898 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
25899 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
25900 terminated with it.
25901
25902 @findex breakpoint annotation
25903 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
25904 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
25905
25906 @findex watchpoint annotation
25907 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
25908 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
25909 @end table
25910
25911 @node Source Annotations
25912 @section Displaying Source
25913 @cindex annotations for source display
25914
25915 @findex source annotation
25916 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
25917
25918 @smallexample
25919 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
25920 @end smallexample
25921
25922 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
25923 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
25924 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
25925 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
25926 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
25927 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
25928 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
25929 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
25930 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
25931 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
25932 depend on the language).
25933
25934 @node JIT Interface
25935 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
25936 @cindex just-in-time compilation
25937 @cindex JIT compilation interface
25938
25939 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
25940 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
25941 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
25942 performance while maintaining platform independence.
25943
25944 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
25945 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
25946 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
25947 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
25948 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
25949 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
25950
25951 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
25952 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
25953 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
25954 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
25955 LLVM JIT.
25956
25957 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
25958 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
25959 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
25960 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
25961 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
25962 out about additional code.
25963
25964 @menu
25965 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
25966 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
25967 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
25968 @end menu
25969
25970 @node Declarations
25971 @section JIT Declarations
25972
25973 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
25974 implement the interface:
25975
25976 @smallexample
25977 typedef enum
25978 @{
25979 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
25980 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
25981 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
25982 @} jit_actions_t;
25983
25984 struct jit_code_entry
25985 @{
25986 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
25987 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
25988 const char *symfile_addr;
25989 uint64_t symfile_size;
25990 @};
25991
25992 struct jit_descriptor
25993 @{
25994 uint32_t version;
25995 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
25996 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
25997 uint32_t action_flag;
25998 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
25999 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
26000 @};
26001
26002 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
26003 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
26004
26005 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
26006 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
26007 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
26008 @end smallexample
26009
26010 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
26011 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
26012 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
26013
26014 @node Registering Code
26015 @section Registering Code
26016
26017 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
26018
26019 @itemize @bullet
26020 @item
26021 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
26022 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
26023
26024 @item
26025 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
26026 file.
26027
26028 @item
26029 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
26030
26031 @item
26032 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
26033
26034 @item
26035 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
26036 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
26037 @end itemize
26038
26039 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
26040 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
26041 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
26042 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
26043
26044 @node Unregistering Code
26045 @section Unregistering Code
26046
26047 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
26048
26049 @itemize @bullet
26050 @item
26051 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
26052
26053 @item
26054 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
26055
26056 @item
26057 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
26058 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
26059 @end itemize
26060
26061 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
26062 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
26063
26064 @node GDB Bugs
26065 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
26066 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
26067 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
26068
26069 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
26070
26071 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
26072 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
26073 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
26074 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
26075
26076 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
26077 information that enables us to fix the bug.
26078
26079 @menu
26080 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
26081 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
26082 @end menu
26083
26084 @node Bug Criteria
26085 @section Have You Found a Bug?
26086 @cindex bug criteria
26087
26088 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
26089
26090 @itemize @bullet
26091 @cindex fatal signal
26092 @cindex debugger crash
26093 @cindex crash of debugger
26094 @item
26095 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
26096 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
26097
26098 @cindex error on valid input
26099 @item
26100 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
26101 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
26102 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
26103
26104 @cindex invalid input
26105 @item
26106 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
26107 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
26108 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
26109 for traditional practice''.
26110
26111 @item
26112 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
26113 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
26114 @end itemize
26115
26116 @node Bug Reporting
26117 @section How to Report Bugs
26118 @cindex bug reports
26119 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
26120
26121 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
26122 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
26123 contact that organization first.
26124
26125 You can find contact information for many support companies and
26126 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
26127 distribution.
26128 @c should add a web page ref...
26129
26130 @ifset BUGURL
26131 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
26132 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
26133 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
26134 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
26135 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
26136 be used.
26137
26138 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
26139 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
26140 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
26141 @samp{bug-gdb}.
26142
26143 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
26144 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
26145 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
26146 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
26147 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
26148 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
26149 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
26150 bug reports to the mailing list.
26151 @end ifset
26152 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
26153 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
26154 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
26155 @end ifclear
26156 @end ifset
26157
26158 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
26159 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
26160 fact or leave it out, state it!
26161
26162 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
26163 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
26164 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
26165 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
26166 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
26167 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
26168 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
26169 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
26170 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
26171
26172 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
26173 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
26174 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
26175 self-contained.
26176
26177 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
26178 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
26179 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
26180 bugs properly.
26181
26182 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
26183
26184 @itemize @bullet
26185 @item
26186 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
26187 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
26188 version}.
26189
26190 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
26191 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
26192
26193 @item
26194 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
26195 version number.
26196
26197 @item
26198 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
26199 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
26200
26201 @item
26202 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
26203 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
26204 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
26205 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
26206 those compilers.
26207
26208 @item
26209 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
26210 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
26211 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
26212 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
26213
26214 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
26215 and then we might not encounter the bug.
26216
26217 @item
26218 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
26219 reproduce the bug.
26220
26221 @item
26222 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
26223 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
26224
26225 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
26226 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
26227 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
26228 a chance to make a mistake.
26229
26230 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
26231 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
26232 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
26233 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
26234 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
26235 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
26236 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
26237 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
26238
26239 @pindex script
26240 @cindex recording a session script
26241 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
26242 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
26243 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
26244 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
26245
26246 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
26247 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
26248
26249 @item
26250 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
26251 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
26252 it by context, not by line number.
26253
26254 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
26255 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
26256
26257 @end itemize
26258
26259 Here are some things that are not necessary:
26260
26261 @itemize @bullet
26262 @item
26263 A description of the envelope of the bug.
26264
26265 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
26266 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
26267 changes will not affect it.
26268
26269 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
26270 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
26271 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
26272 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
26273
26274 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
26275 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
26276 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
26277 less time, and so on.
26278
26279 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
26280 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
26281
26282 @item
26283 A patch for the bug.
26284
26285 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
26286 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
26287 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
26288 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
26289
26290 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
26291 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
26292 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
26293 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
26294
26295 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
26296 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
26297 help us to understand.
26298
26299 @item
26300 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
26301
26302 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
26303 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
26304 @end itemize
26305
26306 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
26307 @c and consists of the two following files:
26308 @c rluser.texinfo
26309 @c inc-hist.texinfo
26310 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
26311 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
26312 @include rluser.texi
26313 @include inc-hist.texinfo
26314
26315
26316 @node Formatting Documentation
26317 @appendix Formatting Documentation
26318
26319 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
26320 @cindex reference card
26321 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
26322 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
26323 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
26324 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
26325 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
26326 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
26327
26328 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
26329 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
26330
26331 @smallexample
26332 make refcard.dvi
26333 @end smallexample
26334
26335 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
26336 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
26337 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
26338 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
26339 your @sc{dvi} output program.
26340
26341 @cindex documentation
26342
26343 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
26344 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
26345 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
26346 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
26347 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
26348 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
26349
26350 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
26351 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
26352 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
26353 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
26354 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
26355 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
26356 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
26357 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
26358
26359 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
26360 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
26361 @code{makeinfo}.
26362
26363 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
26364 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
26365 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
26366
26367 @smallexample
26368 cd gdb
26369 make gdb.info
26370 @end smallexample
26371
26372 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
26373 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
26374 Texinfo definitions file.
26375
26376 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
26377 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
26378 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
26379 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
26380 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
26381 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
26382 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
26383
26384 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
26385 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
26386 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
26387 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
26388 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
26389 directory.
26390
26391 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
26392 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
26393 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
26394 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
26395
26396 @smallexample
26397 make gdb.dvi
26398 @end smallexample
26399
26400 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
26401
26402 @node Installing GDB
26403 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
26404 @cindex installation
26405
26406 @menu
26407 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
26408 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
26409 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
26410 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
26411 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
26412 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
26413 @end menu
26414
26415 @node Requirements
26416 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
26417 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
26418
26419 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
26420 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
26421
26422 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
26423 @table @asis
26424 @item ISO C90 compiler
26425 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
26426 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
26427
26428 @end table
26429
26430 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
26431 @table @asis
26432 @item Expat
26433 @anchor{Expat}
26434 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
26435 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
26436 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
26437 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
26438 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
26439 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
26440
26441 Expat is used for:
26442
26443 @itemize @bullet
26444 @item
26445 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
26446 @item
26447 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
26448 @item
26449 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
26450 @item
26451 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
26452 @end itemize
26453
26454 @item zlib
26455 @cindex compressed debug sections
26456 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
26457 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
26458 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
26459 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
26460 information in such binaries.
26461
26462 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
26463 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
26464 @url{http://zlib.net}.
26465
26466 @item iconv
26467 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
26468 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
26469 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
26470 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
26471
26472 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
26473 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
26474 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
26475
26476 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
26477 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
26478 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
26479 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
26480 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
26481 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
26482 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
26483 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
26484 @end table
26485
26486 @node Running Configure
26487 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
26488 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
26489 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
26490 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
26491 build the @code{gdb} program.
26492 @iftex
26493 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
26494 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
26495 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
26496 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
26497 @end iftex
26498
26499 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
26500 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
26501 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
26502
26503 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
26504 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
26505
26506 @table @code
26507 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
26508 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
26509
26510 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
26511 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
26512
26513 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
26514 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
26515
26516 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
26517 @sc{gnu} include files
26518
26519 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
26520 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
26521
26522 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
26523 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
26524
26525 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
26526 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
26527
26528 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
26529 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
26530
26531 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
26532 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
26533 @end table
26534
26535 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
26536 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
26537 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
26538
26539 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
26540 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
26541 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
26542 argument.
26543
26544 For example:
26545
26546 @smallexample
26547 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
26548 ./configure @var{host}
26549 make
26550 @end smallexample
26551
26552 @noindent
26553 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
26554 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
26555 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
26556 correct value by examining your system.)
26557
26558 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
26559 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
26560 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
26561 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
26562
26563 @need 750
26564 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
26565 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
26566 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
26567
26568 @smallexample
26569 sh configure @var{host}
26570 @end smallexample
26571
26572 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
26573 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
26574 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
26575 @file{configure}
26576 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
26577 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
26578
26579 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
26580 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
26581 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
26582 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
26583 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
26584 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
26585 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
26586 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
26587 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
26588
26589 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
26590 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
26591 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
26592 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
26593 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
26594
26595 @node Separate Objdir
26596 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
26597
26598 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
26599 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
26600 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
26601 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
26602 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
26603 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
26604 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
26605 program specified there.
26606
26607 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
26608 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
26609 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
26610 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
26611 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
26612 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
26613
26614 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
26615 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
26616
26617 @smallexample
26618 @group
26619 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
26620 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
26621 cd ../gdb-sun4
26622 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
26623 make
26624 @end group
26625 @end smallexample
26626
26627 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
26628 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
26629 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
26630 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
26631 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
26632 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
26633
26634 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
26635 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
26636 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
26637 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
26638 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
26639
26640 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
26641 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
26642 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
26643 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
26644 You specify a cross-debugging target by
26645 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
26646
26647 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
26648 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
26649 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
26650
26651 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
26652 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
26653 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
26654 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
26655 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
26656
26657 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
26658 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
26659 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
26660 with each other.
26661
26662 @node Config Names
26663 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
26664
26665 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
26666 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
26667 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
26668 of information in the following pattern:
26669
26670 @smallexample
26671 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
26672 @end smallexample
26673
26674 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
26675 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
26676 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
26677
26678 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
26679 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
26680 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
26681 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
26682 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
26683 abbreviations---for example:
26684
26685 @smallexample
26686 % sh config.sub i386-linux
26687 i386-pc-linux-gnu
26688 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
26689 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
26690 % sh config.sub hp9k700
26691 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
26692 % sh config.sub sun4
26693 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
26694 % sh config.sub sun3
26695 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
26696 % sh config.sub i986v
26697 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
26698 @end smallexample
26699
26700 @noindent
26701 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
26702 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
26703
26704 @node Configure Options
26705 @section @file{configure} Options
26706
26707 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
26708 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
26709 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
26710 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
26711
26712 @smallexample
26713 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
26714 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
26715 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
26716 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
26717 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
26718 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
26719 @var{host}
26720 @end smallexample
26721
26722 @noindent
26723 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
26724 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
26725 @samp{--}.
26726
26727 @table @code
26728 @item --help
26729 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
26730
26731 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
26732 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
26733 @file{@var{dir}}.
26734
26735 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
26736 Configure the source to install programs under directory
26737 @file{@var{dir}}.
26738
26739 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
26740 @need 2000
26741 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
26742 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
26743 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
26744 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
26745 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
26746 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
26747 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
26748 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
26749 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
26750 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
26751 @var{dirname}.
26752
26753 @item --norecursion
26754 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
26755 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
26756
26757 @item --target=@var{target}
26758 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
26759 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
26760 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
26761
26762 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
26763
26764 @item @var{host} @dots{}
26765 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
26766
26767 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
26768 @end table
26769
26770 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
26771 needed for special purposes only.
26772
26773 @node System-wide configuration
26774 @section System-wide configuration and settings
26775 @cindex system-wide init file
26776
26777 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
26778 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
26779 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
26780
26781 Here is the corresponding configure option:
26782
26783 @table @code
26784 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
26785 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
26786 @var{file}.
26787 @end table
26788
26789 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
26790 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
26791
26792 @itemize @bullet
26793 @item
26794 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
26795 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
26796 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
26797 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
26798 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
26799 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
26800
26801 @item
26802 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
26803 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
26804 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
26805 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
26806 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
26807 @end itemize
26808
26809 @node Maintenance Commands
26810 @appendix Maintenance Commands
26811 @cindex maintenance commands
26812 @cindex internal commands
26813
26814 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
26815 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
26816 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
26817 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
26818 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
26819
26820 @table @code
26821 @kindex maint agent
26822 @kindex maint agent-eval
26823 @item maint agent @var{expression}
26824 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
26825 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
26826 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
26827 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
26828 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
26829 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
26830 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
26831 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
26832 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
26833 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
26834 addition and return the sum.
26835
26836 @kindex maint info breakpoints
26837 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
26838 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
26839 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
26840 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
26841 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
26842 is shown:
26843
26844 @table @code
26845 @item breakpoint
26846 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
26847
26848 @item watchpoint
26849 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
26850
26851 @item longjmp
26852 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
26853 @code{longjmp} calls.
26854
26855 @item longjmp resume
26856 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
26857
26858 @item until
26859 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
26860
26861 @item finish
26862 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
26863
26864 @item shlib events
26865 Shared library events.
26866
26867 @end table
26868
26869 @kindex set displaced-stepping
26870 @kindex show displaced-stepping
26871 @cindex displaced stepping support
26872 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
26873 @item set displaced-stepping
26874 @itemx show displaced-stepping
26875 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
26876 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
26877 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
26878 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
26879 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
26880
26881 @table @code
26882 @item set displaced-stepping on
26883 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
26884 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
26885
26886 @item set displaced-stepping off
26887 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
26888 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
26889
26890 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
26891 @item set displaced-stepping auto
26892 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
26893 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
26894 architecture supports displaced stepping.
26895 @end table
26896
26897 @kindex maint check-symtabs
26898 @item maint check-symtabs
26899 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
26900
26901 @kindex maint cplus first_component
26902 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
26903 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
26904
26905 @kindex maint cplus namespace
26906 @item maint cplus namespace
26907 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
26908
26909 @kindex maint demangle
26910 @item maint demangle @var{name}
26911 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
26912
26913 @kindex maint deprecate
26914 @kindex maint undeprecate
26915 @cindex deprecated commands
26916 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
26917 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
26918 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
26919 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
26920 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
26921 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
26922 the replacement as part of the warning.
26923
26924 @kindex maint dump-me
26925 @item maint dump-me
26926 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
26927 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
26928 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
26929 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
26930
26931 @kindex maint internal-error
26932 @kindex maint internal-warning
26933 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
26934 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
26935 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
26936 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
26937 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
26938 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
26939 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
26940 @value{GDBN} session.
26941
26942 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
26943 used as the text of the error or warning message.
26944
26945 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
26946
26947 @smallexample
26948 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
26949 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
26950 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
26951 debugging may prove unreliable.
26952 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
26953 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
26954 (@value{GDBP})
26955 @end smallexample
26956
26957 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
26958 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
26959
26960 @kindex maint set internal-error
26961 @kindex maint show internal-error
26962 @kindex maint set internal-warning
26963 @kindex maint show internal-warning
26964 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
26965 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
26966 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
26967 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
26968 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
26969 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
26970 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
26971 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
26972 described in the table below.
26973
26974 @table @samp
26975 @item quit
26976 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
26977 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
26978
26979 @item corefile
26980 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
26981 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
26982 @end table
26983
26984 @kindex maint packet
26985 @item maint packet @var{text}
26986 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
26987 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
26988 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
26989 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
26990 checksum.
26991
26992 @kindex maint print architecture
26993 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
26994 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
26995 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
26996
26997 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
26998 @item maint print c-tdesc
26999 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
27000 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
27001 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
27002
27003 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
27004 @item maint print dummy-frames
27005 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
27006
27007 @smallexample
27008 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
27009 @dots{}
27010 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
27011 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
27012 58 return (a + b);
27013 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
27014 @dots{}
27015 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
27016 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
27017 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
27018 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
27019 (@value{GDBP})
27020 @end smallexample
27021
27022 Takes an optional file parameter.
27023
27024 @kindex maint print registers
27025 @kindex maint print raw-registers
27026 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
27027 @kindex maint print register-groups
27028 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27029 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27030 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27031 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27032 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
27033
27034 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
27035 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
27036 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
27037 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
27038 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
27039 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
27040
27041 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
27042 write the information.
27043
27044 @kindex maint print reggroups
27045 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
27046 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
27047 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
27048 information.
27049
27050 The register groups info looks like this:
27051
27052 @smallexample
27053 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
27054 Group Type
27055 general user
27056 float user
27057 all user
27058 vector user
27059 system user
27060 save internal
27061 restore internal
27062 @end smallexample
27063
27064 @kindex flushregs
27065 @item flushregs
27066 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
27067
27068 @kindex maint print objfiles
27069 @cindex info for known object files
27070 @item maint print objfiles
27071 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
27072 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
27073 and symtabs.
27074
27075 @kindex maint print statistics
27076 @cindex bcache statistics
27077 @item maint print statistics
27078 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
27079 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
27080 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
27081 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
27082 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
27083 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
27084 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
27085 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
27086 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
27087 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
27088 lengths.
27089
27090 @kindex maint print target-stack
27091 @cindex target stack description
27092 @item maint print target-stack
27093 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
27094 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
27095 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
27096 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
27097 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
27098 address.
27099
27100 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
27101 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
27102
27103 @kindex maint print type
27104 @cindex type chain of a data type
27105 @item maint print type @var{expr}
27106 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
27107 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
27108 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
27109 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
27110 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
27111
27112 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
27113 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
27114 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
27115 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
27116 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
27117
27118 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
27119 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
27120 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
27121 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
27122 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
27123 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
27124 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
27125 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
27126 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
27127
27128 @kindex maint set profile
27129 @kindex maint show profile
27130 @cindex profiling GDB
27131 @item maint set profile
27132 @itemx maint show profile
27133 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
27134
27135 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
27136 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
27137 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
27138 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
27139 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
27140 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
27141 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
27142
27143 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
27144 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
27145
27146 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
27147 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
27148 @cindex hardware debug registers
27149 @item maint set show-debug-regs
27150 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
27151 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
27152 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
27153 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
27154 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
27155 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
27156
27157 @kindex maint space
27158 @cindex memory used by commands
27159 @item maint space
27160 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
27161 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
27162 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
27163 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
27164 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
27165
27166 @kindex maint time
27167 @cindex time of command execution
27168 @item maint time
27169 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
27170 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
27171 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
27172 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
27173 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
27174 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
27175 it's not possibly currently
27176 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
27177 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
27178
27179 @kindex maint translate-address
27180 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
27181 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
27182 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
27183 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
27184 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
27185 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
27186 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
27187
27188 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
27189 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
27190 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
27191
27192 @end table
27193
27194 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
27195 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
27196
27197 @table @code
27198 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
27199 @kindex set watchdog
27200 @cindex watchdog timer
27201 @cindex timeout for commands
27202 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
27203 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
27204 reports and error and the command is aborted.
27205
27206 @item show watchdog
27207 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
27208 @end table
27209
27210 @node Remote Protocol
27211 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
27212
27213 @menu
27214 * Overview::
27215 * Packets::
27216 * Stop Reply Packets::
27217 * General Query Packets::
27218 * Register Packet Format::
27219 * Tracepoint Packets::
27220 * Host I/O Packets::
27221 * Interrupts::
27222 * Notification Packets::
27223 * Remote Non-Stop::
27224 * Packet Acknowledgment::
27225 * Examples::
27226 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
27227 * Library List Format::
27228 * Memory Map Format::
27229 @end menu
27230
27231 @node Overview
27232 @section Overview
27233
27234 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
27235 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
27236 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
27237 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
27238
27239 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
27240 transmitted and received data, respectively.
27241
27242 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
27243 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
27244 @cindex remote serial protocol
27245 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
27246 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
27247 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
27248 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
27249 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
27250
27251 @smallexample
27252 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27253 @end smallexample
27254 @noindent
27255
27256 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
27257 @noindent
27258 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
27259 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
27260 eight bit unsigned checksum).
27261
27262 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
27263 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
27264
27265 @smallexample
27266 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27267 @end smallexample
27268
27269 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
27270 @noindent
27271 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
27272 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
27273 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
27274
27275 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
27276 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
27277 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
27278 retransmission):
27279
27280 @smallexample
27281 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
27282 <- @code{+}
27283 @end smallexample
27284 @noindent
27285
27286 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
27287 once a connection is established.
27288 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
27289
27290 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
27291 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
27292 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
27293 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
27294 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
27295 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
27296 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
27297
27298 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
27299 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
27300 exceptions).
27301
27302 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
27303 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
27304 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
27305 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
27306
27307 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
27308 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
27309 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
27310
27311 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
27312 @anchor{Binary Data}
27313 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
27314 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
27315 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
27316 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
27317 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
27318 binary data.
27319
27320 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
27321 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
27322 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
27323 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
27324 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
27325 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
27326 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
27327 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
27328 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
27329 (described next).
27330
27331 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
27332 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
27333 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
27334 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
27335 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
27336 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
27337 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
27338 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
27339 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
27340 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
27341 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
27342 3}} more times.
27343
27344 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
27345 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
27346 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
27347 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
27348 @samp{0*"00}.
27349
27350 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
27351 error number. That number is not well defined.
27352
27353 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
27354 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
27355 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
27356 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
27357 on that response.
27358
27359 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
27360 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
27361 optional.
27362
27363 @node Packets
27364 @section Packets
27365
27366 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
27367 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
27368 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
27369 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
27370
27371 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
27372 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
27373 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
27374 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
27375 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
27376 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
27377 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
27378 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
27379 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
27380 @var{baz}.
27381
27382 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
27383 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
27384 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
27385 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
27386 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
27387 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
27388 pick any thread.
27389
27390 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
27391 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
27392 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
27393 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
27394 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
27395 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
27396 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
27397 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
27398 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
27399 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
27400 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
27401 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
27402 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
27403
27404 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
27405 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
27406 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
27407 more information.
27408
27409 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
27410 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
27411
27412 Here are the packet descriptions.
27413
27414 @table @samp
27415
27416 @item !
27417 @cindex @samp{!} packet
27418 @anchor{extended mode}
27419 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
27420 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
27421 debugged.
27422
27423 Reply:
27424 @table @samp
27425 @item OK
27426 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
27427 @end table
27428
27429 @item ?
27430 @cindex @samp{?} packet
27431 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
27432 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
27433 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
27434
27435 Reply:
27436 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27437
27438 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
27439 @cindex @samp{A} packet
27440 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
27441 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
27442 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
27443
27444 Reply:
27445 @table @samp
27446 @item OK
27447 The arguments were set.
27448 @item E @var{NN}
27449 An error occurred.
27450 @end table
27451
27452 @item b @var{baud}
27453 @cindex @samp{b} packet
27454 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
27455 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
27456
27457 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
27458 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
27459 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
27460
27461 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
27462 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
27463 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
27464 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
27465 of view, nothing actually happened.}
27466
27467 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
27468 @cindex @samp{B} packet
27469 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
27470 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
27471
27472 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
27473 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
27474
27475 @item bc
27476 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
27477 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
27478 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
27479
27480 Reply:
27481 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27482
27483 @item bs
27484 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
27485 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
27486 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
27487
27488 Reply:
27489 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27490
27491 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
27492 @cindex @samp{c} packet
27493 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
27494 resume at current address.
27495
27496 Reply:
27497 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27498
27499 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
27500 @cindex @samp{C} packet
27501 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
27502 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
27503
27504 Reply:
27505 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27506
27507 @item d
27508 @cindex @samp{d} packet
27509 Toggle debug flag.
27510
27511 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
27512 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
27513
27514 @item D
27515 @itemx D;@var{pid}
27516 @cindex @samp{D} packet
27517 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
27518 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
27519 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
27520
27521 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
27522 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
27523 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
27524 big-endian hex string.
27525
27526 Reply:
27527 @table @samp
27528 @item OK
27529 for success
27530 @item E @var{NN}
27531 for an error
27532 @end table
27533
27534 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
27535 @cindex @samp{F} packet
27536 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
27537 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
27538 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
27539
27540 @item g
27541 @anchor{read registers packet}
27542 @cindex @samp{g} packet
27543 Read general registers.
27544
27545 Reply:
27546 @table @samp
27547 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
27548 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
27549 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
27550 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
27551 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
27552 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
27553 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
27554 @item E @var{NN}
27555 for an error.
27556 @end table
27557
27558 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
27559 @cindex @samp{G} packet
27560 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
27561 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
27562
27563 Reply:
27564 @table @samp
27565 @item OK
27566 for success
27567 @item E @var{NN}
27568 for an error
27569 @end table
27570
27571 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
27572 @cindex @samp{H} packet
27573 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
27574 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
27575 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
27576 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
27577 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
27578
27579 Reply:
27580 @table @samp
27581 @item OK
27582 for success
27583 @item E @var{NN}
27584 for an error
27585 @end table
27586
27587 @c FIXME: JTC:
27588 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
27589 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
27590 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
27591 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
27592 @c described. For example:
27593 @c
27594 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
27595 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
27596 @c otherwise returns current registers.
27597 @c
27598 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
27599 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
27600 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
27601
27602 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
27603 @anchor{cycle step packet}
27604 @cindex @samp{i} packet
27605 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
27606 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
27607 step starting at that address.
27608
27609 @item I
27610 @cindex @samp{I} packet
27611 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
27612 step packet}.
27613
27614 @item k
27615 @cindex @samp{k} packet
27616 Kill request.
27617
27618 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
27619 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
27620 thread?)}.
27621
27622 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
27623 @cindex @samp{m} packet
27624 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
27625 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
27626
27627 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
27628 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
27629 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
27630 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
27631 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
27632 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
27633 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
27634 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
27635
27636 Reply:
27637 @table @samp
27638 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
27639 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
27640 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
27641 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
27642 @item E @var{NN}
27643 @var{NN} is errno
27644 @end table
27645
27646 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
27647 @cindex @samp{M} packet
27648 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
27649 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
27650 hexadecimal number.
27651
27652 Reply:
27653 @table @samp
27654 @item OK
27655 for success
27656 @item E @var{NN}
27657 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
27658 written).
27659 @end table
27660
27661 @item p @var{n}
27662 @cindex @samp{p} packet
27663 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
27664 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
27665 register value is encoded.
27666
27667 Reply:
27668 @table @samp
27669 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
27670 the register's value
27671 @item E @var{NN}
27672 for an error
27673 @item
27674 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
27675 @end table
27676
27677 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
27678 @anchor{write register packet}
27679 @cindex @samp{P} packet
27680 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
27681 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
27682 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
27683
27684 Reply:
27685 @table @samp
27686 @item OK
27687 for success
27688 @item E @var{NN}
27689 for an error
27690 @end table
27691
27692 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
27693 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
27694 @cindex @samp{q} packet
27695 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
27696 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
27697 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
27698
27699 @item r
27700 @cindex @samp{r} packet
27701 Reset the entire system.
27702
27703 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
27704
27705 @item R @var{XX}
27706 @cindex @samp{R} packet
27707 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
27708 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
27709
27710 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
27711
27712 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
27713 @cindex @samp{s} packet
27714 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
27715 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
27716
27717 Reply:
27718 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27719
27720 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
27721 @anchor{step with signal packet}
27722 @cindex @samp{S} packet
27723 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
27724 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
27725
27726 Reply:
27727 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27728
27729 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
27730 @cindex @samp{t} packet
27731 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
27732 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
27733 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
27734
27735 @item T @var{thread-id}
27736 @cindex @samp{T} packet
27737 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
27738
27739 Reply:
27740 @table @samp
27741 @item OK
27742 thread is still alive
27743 @item E @var{NN}
27744 thread is dead
27745 @end table
27746
27747 @item v
27748 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
27749 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
27750
27751 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
27752 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
27753 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
27754 The process ID is a
27755 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
27756 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
27757 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
27758
27759 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
27760 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
27761 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
27762 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
27763 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
27764 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
27765 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
27766 @c stopping or restarting threads.
27767
27768 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
27769
27770 Reply:
27771 @table @samp
27772 @item E @var{nn}
27773 for an error
27774 @item @r{Any stop packet}
27775 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
27776 @item OK
27777 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
27778 @end table
27779
27780 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
27781 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
27782 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
27783 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
27784 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
27785 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
27786 in their current state in non-stop mode.
27787 Specifying multiple
27788 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
27789 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
27790
27791 Currently supported actions are:
27792
27793 @table @samp
27794 @item c
27795 Continue.
27796 @item C @var{sig}
27797 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
27798 @item s
27799 Step.
27800 @item S @var{sig}
27801 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
27802 @item t
27803 Stop.
27804 @item T @var{sig}
27805 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
27806 @end table
27807
27808 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
27809 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
27810 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
27811
27812 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
27813 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
27814 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
27815 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
27816 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
27817 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
27818 as an implementation detail.
27819
27820 Reply:
27821 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
27822
27823 @item vCont?
27824 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
27825 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
27826
27827 Reply:
27828 @table @samp
27829 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
27830 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
27831 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
27832 @item
27833 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
27834 @end table
27835
27836 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
27837 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
27838 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
27839 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
27840
27841 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
27842 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
27843 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
27844 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
27845 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
27846 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
27847 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
27848 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
27849 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
27850 packet is received.
27851
27852 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
27853 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
27854 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
27855 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
27856 @var{thread-id}.
27857
27858 Reply:
27859 @table @samp
27860 @item OK
27861 for success
27862 @item E @var{NN}
27863 for an error
27864 @end table
27865
27866 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
27867 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
27868 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
27869 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
27870 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
27871 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
27872 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
27873 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
27874 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
27875 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
27876 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
27877 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
27878
27879
27880 Reply:
27881 @table @samp
27882 @item OK
27883 for success
27884 @item E.memtype
27885 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
27886 @item E @var{NN}
27887 for an error
27888 @end table
27889
27890 @item vFlashDone
27891 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
27892 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
27893 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
27894 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
27895 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
27896 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
27897 request is completed.
27898
27899 @item vKill;@var{pid}
27900 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
27901 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
27902 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
27903 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
27904 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
27905
27906 Reply:
27907 @table @samp
27908 @item E @var{nn}
27909 for an error
27910 @item OK
27911 for success
27912 @end table
27913
27914 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
27915 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
27916 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
27917 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
27918 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
27919 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
27920 state.
27921
27922 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
27923
27924 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
27925
27926 Reply:
27927 @table @samp
27928 @item E @var{nn}
27929 for an error
27930 @item @r{Any stop packet}
27931 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
27932 @end table
27933
27934 @item vStopped
27935 @anchor{vStopped packet}
27936 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
27937
27938 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
27939 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
27940
27941 Reply:
27942 @table @samp
27943 @item @r{Any stop packet}
27944 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
27945 @item OK
27946 if there are no unreported stop events
27947 @end table
27948
27949 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
27950 @anchor{X packet}
27951 @cindex @samp{X} packet
27952 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
27953 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
27954 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
27955
27956 Reply:
27957 @table @samp
27958 @item OK
27959 for success
27960 @item E @var{NN}
27961 for an error
27962 @end table
27963
27964 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
27965 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
27966 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
27967 @cindex @samp{z} packet
27968 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
27969 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
27970 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
27971 @var{length} bytes.
27972
27973 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
27974 separately.
27975
27976 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
27977 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
27978 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
27979 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
27980 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
27981 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
27982
27983 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
27984 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
27985 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
27986 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
27987 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
27988 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
27989
27990 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
27991 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
27992 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
27993 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
27994 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
27995
27996 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
27997 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
27998 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
27999 target, is not defined.}
28000
28001 Reply:
28002 @table @samp
28003 @item OK
28004 success
28005 @item
28006 not supported
28007 @item E @var{NN}
28008 for an error
28009 @end table
28010
28011 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
28012 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
28013 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
28014 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
28015 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
28016 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
28017
28018 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
28019 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
28020
28021 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
28022 movement.}
28023
28024 Reply:
28025 @table @samp
28026 @item OK
28027 success
28028 @item
28029 not supported
28030 @item E @var{NN}
28031 for an error
28032 @end table
28033
28034 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
28035 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
28036 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
28037 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
28038 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
28039
28040 Reply:
28041 @table @samp
28042 @item OK
28043 success
28044 @item
28045 not supported
28046 @item E @var{NN}
28047 for an error
28048 @end table
28049
28050 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
28051 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
28052 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
28053 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
28054 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
28055
28056 Reply:
28057 @table @samp
28058 @item OK
28059 success
28060 @item
28061 not supported
28062 @item E @var{NN}
28063 for an error
28064 @end table
28065
28066 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
28067 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
28068 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
28069 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
28070 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
28071
28072 Reply:
28073 @table @samp
28074 @item OK
28075 success
28076 @item
28077 not supported
28078 @item E @var{NN}
28079 for an error
28080 @end table
28081
28082 @end table
28083
28084 @node Stop Reply Packets
28085 @section Stop Reply Packets
28086 @cindex stop reply packets
28087
28088 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
28089 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
28090 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
28091 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
28092 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
28093 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
28094 @value{GDBN} source code.
28095
28096 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
28097 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
28098 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
28099 components.
28100
28101 @table @samp
28102
28103 @item S @var{AA}
28104 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
28105 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
28106 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
28107
28108 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
28109 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
28110 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
28111 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
28112 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
28113 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
28114 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
28115 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
28116
28117 @itemize @bullet
28118 @item
28119 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
28120 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
28121 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
28122 two-digit hex number.
28123
28124 @item
28125 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
28126 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28127
28128 @item
28129 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
28130 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
28131 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
28132 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
28133
28134 @item
28135 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
28136 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
28137 future.
28138 @end itemize
28139
28140 The currently defined stop reasons are:
28141
28142 @table @samp
28143 @item watch
28144 @itemx rwatch
28145 @itemx awatch
28146 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
28147 hex.
28148
28149 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
28150 @item library
28151 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
28152 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
28153 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
28154
28155 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
28156 @item replaylog
28157 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
28158 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
28159 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
28160 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
28161 for more information.
28162
28163
28164 @end table
28165
28166 @item W @var{AA}
28167 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
28168 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
28169 applicable to certain targets.
28170
28171 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
28172 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
28173 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
28174 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
28175
28176 @item X @var{AA}
28177 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
28178 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
28179
28180 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
28181 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
28182 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
28183 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
28184
28185 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
28186 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
28187 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
28188 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
28189 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
28190
28191 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
28192 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
28193 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
28194 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
28195 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
28196 system calls.
28197
28198 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
28199 this very system call.
28200
28201 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
28202 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
28203 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
28204 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
28205 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
28206 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
28207
28208 @end table
28209
28210 @node General Query Packets
28211 @section General Query Packets
28212 @cindex remote query requests
28213
28214 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
28215 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
28216 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
28217 sending information to and from the stub.
28218
28219 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
28220 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
28221 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
28222 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
28223 conventions:
28224
28225 @itemize @bullet
28226 @item
28227 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
28228 @item
28229 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
28230 letter.
28231 @item
28232 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
28233 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
28234 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
28235 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
28236 @end itemize
28237
28238 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
28239 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
28240 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
28241 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
28242 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
28243 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
28244 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
28245 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
28246 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
28247 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
28248 packet.}.
28249
28250 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
28251 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
28252 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
28253 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
28254 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
28255
28256 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
28257
28258 @table @samp
28259
28260 @item qC
28261 @cindex current thread, remote request
28262 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
28263 Return the current thread ID.
28264
28265 Reply:
28266 @table @samp
28267 @item QC @var{thread-id}
28268 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
28269 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
28270 @item @r{(anything else)}
28271 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
28272 @end table
28273
28274 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
28275 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
28276 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
28277 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
28278 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
28279 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
28280 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
28281
28282 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
28283 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
28284 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
28285 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
28286 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
28287 detect trailing zeros.
28288
28289 Reply:
28290 @table @samp
28291 @item E @var{NN}
28292 An error (such as memory fault)
28293 @item C @var{crc32}
28294 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
28295 @end table
28296
28297 @item qfThreadInfo
28298 @itemx qsThreadInfo
28299 @cindex list active threads, remote request
28300 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
28301 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
28302 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
28303 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
28304 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
28305 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
28306 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
28307 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
28308
28309 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
28310
28311 Reply:
28312 @table @samp
28313 @item m @var{thread-id}
28314 A single thread ID
28315 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
28316 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
28317 @item l
28318 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
28319 @end table
28320
28321 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
28322 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
28323 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
28324 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
28325 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
28326 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
28327 fields.
28328
28329 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
28330 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
28331 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
28332 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
28333 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
28334
28335 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
28336 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
28337
28338 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
28339 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
28340 information associated with the variable.)
28341
28342 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
28343 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
28344 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
28345 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
28346 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
28347 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
28348
28349 Reply:
28350 @table @samp
28351 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
28352 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
28353 local storage requested.
28354
28355 @item E @var{nn}
28356 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
28357
28358 @item
28359 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
28360 @end table
28361
28362 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
28363 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
28364 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
28365 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
28366 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
28367 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
28368 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
28369
28370 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
28371
28372 Reply:
28373 @table @samp
28374 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
28375 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
28376 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
28377 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
28378 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
28379 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
28380 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
28381 @end table
28382
28383 @item qOffsets
28384 @cindex section offsets, remote request
28385 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
28386 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
28387 image.
28388
28389 Reply:
28390 @table @samp
28391 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
28392 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
28393 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
28394 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
28395 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
28396 segments by the supplied offsets.
28397
28398 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
28399 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
28400 to the @code{Bss} section.}
28401
28402 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
28403 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
28404 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
28405 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
28406 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
28407 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
28408 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
28409 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
28410 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
28411 @end table
28412
28413 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
28414 @cindex thread information, remote request
28415 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
28416 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
28417 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
28418 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
28419
28420 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
28421 (see below).
28422
28423 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
28424
28425 @item QNonStop:1
28426 @item QNonStop:0
28427 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
28428 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
28429 @anchor{QNonStop}
28430 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
28431 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
28432
28433 Reply:
28434 @table @samp
28435 @item OK
28436 The request succeeded.
28437
28438 @item E @var{nn}
28439 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
28440
28441 @item
28442 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
28443 the stub.
28444 @end table
28445
28446 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28447 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28448 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
28449 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
28450
28451 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
28452 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
28453 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
28454 @anchor{QPassSignals}
28455 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
28456 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
28457 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
28458 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
28459 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
28460 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
28461 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
28462 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
28463 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
28464
28465 Reply:
28466 @table @samp
28467 @item OK
28468 The request succeeded.
28469
28470 @item E @var{nn}
28471 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
28472
28473 @item
28474 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
28475 the stub.
28476 @end table
28477
28478 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
28479 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
28480 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28481 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28482
28483 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
28484 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
28485 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
28486 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
28487 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
28488 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
28489 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
28490 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
28491 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
28492
28493 Reply:
28494 @table @samp
28495 @item OK
28496 A command response with no output.
28497 @item @var{OUTPUT}
28498 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
28499 @item E @var{NN}
28500 Indicate a badly formed request.
28501 @item
28502 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
28503 @end table
28504
28505 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
28506 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
28507 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
28508 packets.)
28509
28510 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
28511 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
28512 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
28513 @anchor{qSearch memory}
28514 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
28515 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
28516 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
28517
28518 Reply:
28519 @table @samp
28520 @item 0
28521 The pattern was not found.
28522 @item 1,address
28523 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
28524 @item E @var{NN}
28525 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
28526 @item
28527 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
28528 @end table
28529
28530 @item QStartNoAckMode
28531 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
28532 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
28533 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
28534 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
28535
28536 Reply:
28537 @table @samp
28538 @item OK
28539 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
28540 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
28541 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
28542 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
28543 @item
28544 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
28545 @end table
28546
28547 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
28548 @cindex supported packets, remote query
28549 @cindex features of the remote protocol
28550 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
28551 @anchor{qSupported}
28552 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
28553 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
28554 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
28555 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
28556 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
28557 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
28558 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
28559 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
28560 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
28561 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
28562 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
28563 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
28564 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
28565 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
28566
28567 Reply:
28568 @table @samp
28569 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
28570 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
28571 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
28572 possible forms).
28573 @item
28574 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
28575 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
28576 @end table
28577
28578 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
28579 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
28580 are:
28581
28582 @table @samp
28583 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
28584 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
28585 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
28586 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
28587 @item @var{name}+
28588 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
28589 need an associated value.
28590 @item @var{name}-
28591 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
28592 @item @var{name}?
28593 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
28594 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
28595 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
28596 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
28597 @end table
28598
28599 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
28600 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
28601 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
28602 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
28603 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
28604
28605 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
28606 are defined:
28607
28608 @table @samp
28609 @item multiprocess
28610 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
28611 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
28612 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
28613 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
28614 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
28615 @end table
28616
28617 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
28618 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
28619 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
28620 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
28621 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
28622 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
28623 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
28624 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
28625 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
28626 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
28627 all the features it supports.
28628
28629 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
28630 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
28631
28632 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
28633 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
28634 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
28635 form response.
28636
28637 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
28638 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
28639 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
28640 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
28641
28642 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
28643 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
28644 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
28645 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
28646 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
28647
28648 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
28649
28650 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
28651 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
28652 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
28653 @item Feature Name
28654 @tab Value Required
28655 @tab Default
28656 @tab Probe Allowed
28657
28658 @item @samp{PacketSize}
28659 @tab Yes
28660 @tab @samp{-}
28661 @tab No
28662
28663 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
28664 @tab No
28665 @tab @samp{-}
28666 @tab Yes
28667
28668 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
28669 @tab No
28670 @tab @samp{-}
28671 @tab Yes
28672
28673 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
28674 @tab No
28675 @tab @samp{-}
28676 @tab Yes
28677
28678 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
28679 @tab No
28680 @tab @samp{-}
28681 @tab Yes
28682
28683 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
28684 @tab No
28685 @tab @samp{-}
28686 @tab Yes
28687
28688 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
28689 @tab No
28690 @tab @samp{-}
28691 @tab Yes
28692
28693 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
28694 @tab No
28695 @tab @samp{-}
28696 @tab Yes
28697
28698 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
28699 @tab No
28700 @tab @samp{-}
28701 @tab Yes
28702
28703 @item @samp{QNonStop}
28704 @tab No
28705 @tab @samp{-}
28706 @tab Yes
28707
28708 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
28709 @tab No
28710 @tab @samp{-}
28711 @tab Yes
28712
28713 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
28714 @tab No
28715 @tab @samp{-}
28716 @tab Yes
28717
28718 @item @samp{multiprocess}
28719 @tab No
28720 @tab @samp{-}
28721 @tab No
28722
28723 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
28724 @tab No
28725 @tab @samp{-}
28726 @tab No
28727
28728 @end multitable
28729
28730 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
28731
28732 @table @samp
28733 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
28734 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
28735 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
28736 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
28737 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
28738 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
28739 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
28740 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
28741 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
28742 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
28743
28744 @item qXfer:auxv:read
28745 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
28746 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
28747
28748 @item qXfer:features:read
28749 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
28750 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
28751
28752 @item qXfer:libraries:read
28753 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
28754 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
28755
28756 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
28757 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
28758 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
28759
28760 @item qXfer:spu:read
28761 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
28762 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
28763
28764 @item qXfer:spu:write
28765 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
28766 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
28767
28768 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
28769 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
28770 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
28771
28772 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
28773 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
28774 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
28775
28776 @item QNonStop
28777 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
28778 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
28779
28780 @item QPassSignals
28781 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
28782 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
28783
28784 @item QStartNoAckMode
28785 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
28786 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
28787
28788 @item multiprocess
28789 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
28790 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
28791 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
28792 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
28793 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
28794 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
28795 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
28796 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
28797 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
28798 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
28799 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
28800
28801 @item qXfer:osdata:read
28802 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
28803 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
28804
28805 @item ConditionalTracepoints
28806 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
28807 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
28808
28809 @end table
28810
28811 @item qSymbol::
28812 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
28813 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
28814 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
28815 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
28816
28817 Reply:
28818 @table @samp
28819 @item OK
28820 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
28821 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
28822 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
28823 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
28824 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
28825 below.
28826 @end table
28827
28828 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
28829 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
28830
28831 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
28832 target has previously requested.
28833
28834 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
28835 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
28836 will be empty.
28837
28838 Reply:
28839 @table @samp
28840 @item OK
28841 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
28842 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
28843 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
28844 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
28845 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
28846 @end table
28847
28848 @item QTDP
28849 @itemx QTFrame
28850 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
28851
28852 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
28853 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
28854 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
28855 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
28856 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
28857 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
28858 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
28859 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
28860 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
28861 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
28862 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
28863
28864 Reply:
28865 @table @samp
28866 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
28867 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
28868 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
28869 the thread's attributes.
28870 @end table
28871
28872 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
28873 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
28874 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
28875 packets.)
28876
28877 @item QTStart
28878 @itemx QTStop
28879 @itemx QTinit
28880 @itemx QTro
28881 @itemx qTStatus
28882 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
28883
28884 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
28885 @cindex read special object, remote request
28886 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
28887 @anchor{qXfer read}
28888 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
28889 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
28890 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
28891 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
28892 additional details about what data to access.
28893
28894 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
28895 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
28896 formats, listed below.
28897
28898 @table @samp
28899 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
28900 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
28901 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
28902 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
28903
28904 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28905 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28906
28907 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
28908 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
28909 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
28910 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
28911 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
28912
28913 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28914 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28915
28916 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
28917 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
28918 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
28919 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
28920 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
28921
28922 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
28923 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
28924 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
28925
28926 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28927 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28928
28929 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
28930 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
28931 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
28932 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
28933 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
28934
28935 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28936 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28937
28938 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
28939 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
28940 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
28941 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
28942 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
28943
28944 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28945 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
28946 (@pxref{qSupported}).
28947
28948 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
28949 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
28950 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
28951 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
28952 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
28953 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
28954 in that context to be accessed.
28955
28956 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
28957 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
28958 (@pxref{qSupported}).
28959
28960 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
28961 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
28962 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
28963 @xref{Operating System Information}.
28964
28965 @end table
28966
28967 Reply:
28968 @table @samp
28969 @item m @var{data}
28970 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
28971 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
28972 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
28973 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
28974 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
28975 request.
28976
28977 @item l @var{data}
28978 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
28979 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
28980 than the @var{length} in the request.
28981
28982 @item l
28983 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
28984 There is no more data to be read.
28985
28986 @item E00
28987 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
28988
28989 @item E @var{nn}
28990 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
28991 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
28992
28993 @item
28994 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
28995 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
28996 @end table
28997
28998 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
28999 @cindex write data into object, remote request
29000 @anchor{qXfer write}
29001 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
29002 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
29003 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
29004 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
29005 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
29006 to access.
29007
29008 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
29009 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
29010 formats, listed below.
29011
29012 @table @samp
29013 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
29014 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
29015 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
29016 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
29017 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
29018
29019 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29020 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
29021 (@pxref{qSupported}).
29022
29023 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
29024 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
29025 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
29026 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
29027 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
29028 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
29029 in that context to be accessed.
29030
29031 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
29032 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29033 @end table
29034
29035 Reply:
29036 @table @samp
29037 @item @var{nn}
29038 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
29039 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
29040
29041 @item E00
29042 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
29043
29044 @item E @var{nn}
29045 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
29046 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
29047
29048 @item
29049 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
29050 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
29051 @end table
29052
29053 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
29054 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
29055 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
29056 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
29057 must respond with an empty packet.
29058
29059 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
29060 @cindex query attached, remote request
29061 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
29062 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
29063 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
29064 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
29065 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
29066 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
29067 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
29068
29069 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
29070 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
29071 the @code{quit} command.
29072
29073 Reply:
29074 @table @samp
29075 @item 1
29076 The remote server attached to an existing process.
29077 @item 0
29078 The remote server created a new process.
29079 @item E @var{NN}
29080 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
29081 @end table
29082
29083 @end table
29084
29085 @node Register Packet Format
29086 @section Register Packet Format
29087
29088 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
29089 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
29090 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
29091 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
29092 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
29093 most-significant - least-significant.
29094
29095 @table @r
29096
29097 @item MIPS32
29098
29099 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
29100 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
29101 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
29102
29103 @item MIPS64
29104
29105 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
29106 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
29107 as @code{MIPS32}.
29108
29109 @end table
29110
29111 @node Tracepoint Packets
29112 @section Tracepoint Packets
29113 @cindex tracepoint packets
29114 @cindex packets, tracepoint
29115
29116 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
29117 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
29118
29119 @table @samp
29120
29121 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
29122 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
29123 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
29124 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
29125 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{X} is present,
29126 it introduces a tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal
29127 length, followed by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar
29128 to action encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is
29129 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
29130 tracepoint's actions.
29131
29132 Replies:
29133 @table @samp
29134 @item OK
29135 The packet was understood and carried out.
29136 @item
29137 The packet was not recognized.
29138 @end table
29139
29140 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
29141 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
29142 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
29143 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
29144 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
29145 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
29146 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
29147
29148 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
29149 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
29150 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
29151 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
29152 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
29153 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
29154 tracepoint actions.
29155
29156 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
29157 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
29158 following forms:
29159
29160 @table @samp
29161
29162 @item R @var{mask}
29163 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
29164 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
29165 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
29166 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
29167 not fit in a 32-bit word.
29168
29169 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
29170 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
29171 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
29172 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
29173 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
29174 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
29175 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
29176
29177 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
29178 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
29179 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
29180 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
29181 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
29182 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
29183 packet).
29184
29185 @end table
29186
29187 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
29188 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
29189 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
29190 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
29191 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
29192 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
29193 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
29194 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
29195
29196 Replies:
29197 @table @samp
29198 @item OK
29199 The packet was understood and carried out.
29200 @item
29201 The packet was not recognized.
29202 @end table
29203
29204 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
29205 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
29206 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
29207 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
29208
29209 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
29210 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
29211 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
29212 one of the following forms:
29213
29214 @table @samp
29215 @item F @var{f}
29216 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
29217 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
29218 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
29219
29220 @item T @var{t}
29221 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
29222 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
29223
29224 @end table
29225
29226 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
29227 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29228 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
29229 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
29230
29231 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
29232 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29233 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
29234 is a hexadecimal number.
29235
29236 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
29237 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
29238 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
29239 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
29240 numbers.
29241
29242 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
29243 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
29244 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
29245
29246 @item QTStart
29247 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
29248 hits in the trace frame buffer.
29249
29250 @item QTStop
29251 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
29252
29253 @item QTinit
29254 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
29255
29256 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
29257 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
29258 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
29259 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
29260
29261 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
29262 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
29263 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
29264 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
29265
29266 @item qTStatus
29267 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
29268
29269 Replies:
29270 @table @samp
29271 @item T0
29272 There is no trace experiment running.
29273 @item T1
29274 There is a trace experiment running.
29275 @end table
29276
29277 @end table
29278
29279
29280 @node Host I/O Packets
29281 @section Host I/O Packets
29282 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
29283 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
29284
29285 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
29286 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
29287 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
29288 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
29289 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
29290 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
29291 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
29292 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
29293 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
29294 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
29295
29296 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
29297 its arguments. They have this format:
29298
29299 @table @samp
29300
29301 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
29302 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
29303 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
29304 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
29305 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
29306 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
29307 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
29308 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
29309 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
29310
29311 @end table
29312
29313 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
29314
29315 @table @samp
29316
29317 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
29318 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
29319 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
29320 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
29321 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
29322 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
29323 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
29324 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
29325 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
29326 @var{attachment}.
29327
29328 @item
29329 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
29330
29331 @end table
29332
29333 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
29334
29335 @table @samp
29336 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
29337 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
29338 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
29339 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
29340 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
29341 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
29342 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
29343
29344 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
29345 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
29346 -1 if an error occurs.
29347
29348 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
29349 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
29350 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
29351 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
29352 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
29353 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
29354 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
29355 @var{count} was zero.
29356
29357 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
29358 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
29359 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
29360 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
29361 some characters were escaped.
29362
29363 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
29364 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
29365 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
29366 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
29367 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
29368 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
29369 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
29370 error occurred.
29371
29372 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
29373 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
29374 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
29375
29376 @end table
29377
29378 @node Interrupts
29379 @section Interrupts
29380 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
29381
29382 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
29383 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
29384 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
29385 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
29386
29387 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
29388 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
29389 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
29390 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
29391 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
29392
29393 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
29394 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
29395 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
29396 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
29397 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
29398 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
29399 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
29400 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
29401
29402 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
29403 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
29404 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
29405 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
29406 currently-executing threads and processes.
29407 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
29408 running program, it should send one of the stop
29409 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
29410 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
29411 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
29412 Interrupts received while the
29413 program is stopped are discarded.
29414
29415 @node Notification Packets
29416 @section Notification Packets
29417 @cindex notification packets
29418 @cindex packets, notification
29419
29420 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
29421 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
29422 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
29423 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
29424 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
29425 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
29426 is not a problem.
29427
29428 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
29429 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
29430 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
29431 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
29432 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
29433 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
29434 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
29435
29436 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
29437 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
29438
29439 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
29440 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
29441 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
29442 not they understand it.
29443
29444 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
29445 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
29446 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
29447 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
29448 recipients.
29449
29450 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
29451 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
29452 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
29453 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
29454 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
29455
29456 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
29457 defined:
29458
29459 @table @samp
29460 @item Stop: @var{reply}
29461 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
29462 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
29463 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
29464 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
29465 @value{GDBN}.
29466 @end table
29467
29468 @node Remote Non-Stop
29469 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
29470
29471 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
29472 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
29473 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
29474 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
29475
29476 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
29477 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
29478 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
29479 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
29480 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
29481 probe the target state after a mode change.
29482
29483 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
29484 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
29485 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
29486 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
29487 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
29488 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
29489 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
29490 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
29491 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
29492 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
29493 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
29494
29495 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
29496 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
29497 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
29498 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
29499 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
29500 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
29501 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
29502 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
29503 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
29504 sending any queued stop events.
29505
29506 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
29507 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
29508 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
29509 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
29510 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
29511 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
29512 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
29513
29514 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
29515 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
29516 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
29517 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
29518 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
29519 process normally.
29520
29521 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
29522 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
29523 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
29524 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
29525 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
29526 should process normally.
29527
29528 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
29529 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
29530 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
29531 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
29532 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
29533
29534 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
29535 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
29536 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
29537 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
29538 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
29539 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
29540 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
29541 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
29542 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
29543 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
29544 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
29545 @samp{OK}.
29546
29547 @node Packet Acknowledgment
29548 @section Packet Acknowledgment
29549
29550 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
29551 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
29552 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
29553 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
29554 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
29555 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
29556 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
29557
29558 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
29559 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
29560 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
29561 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
29562 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
29563
29564 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
29565 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
29566 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
29567 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
29568
29569 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
29570 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
29571 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
29572 @pxref{qSupported}.
29573 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
29574 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
29575 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
29576 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
29577 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
29578 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
29579 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
29580
29581 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
29582 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
29583 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
29584 connection.
29585 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
29586 new connection is established,
29587 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
29588 for the current connection, once disabled.
29589
29590 @node Examples
29591 @section Examples
29592
29593 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
29594 does not get any direct output:
29595
29596 @smallexample
29597 -> @code{R00}
29598 <- @code{+}
29599 @emph{target restarts}
29600 -> @code{?}
29601 <- @code{+}
29602 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
29603 -> @code{+}
29604 @end smallexample
29605
29606 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
29607
29608 @smallexample
29609 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
29610 <- @code{+}
29611 -> @code{s}
29612 <- @code{+}
29613 @emph{time passes}
29614 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
29615 -> @code{+}
29616 -> @code{g}
29617 <- @code{+}
29618 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
29619 -> @code{+}
29620 @end smallexample
29621
29622 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
29623 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
29624 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
29625
29626 @menu
29627 * File-I/O Overview::
29628 * Protocol Basics::
29629 * The F Request Packet::
29630 * The F Reply Packet::
29631 * The Ctrl-C Message::
29632 * Console I/O::
29633 * List of Supported Calls::
29634 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
29635 * Constants::
29636 * File-I/O Examples::
29637 @end menu
29638
29639 @node File-I/O Overview
29640 @subsection File-I/O Overview
29641 @cindex file-i/o overview
29642
29643 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
29644 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
29645 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
29646 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
29647 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
29648 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
29649
29650 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
29651 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
29652 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
29653 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
29654 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
29655
29656 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
29657 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
29658 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
29659 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
29660 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
29661 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
29662 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
29663
29664 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
29665 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
29666 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
29667 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
29668 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
29669
29670 @smallexample
29671 (@value{GDBP}) continue
29672 <- target requests 'system call X'
29673 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
29674 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
29675 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
29676 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
29680 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
29681 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
29682 system are not supported by this protocol.
29683
29684 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
29685
29686 @node Protocol Basics
29687 @subsection Protocol Basics
29688 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
29689
29690 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
29691 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
29692 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
29693 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
29694 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
29695 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
29696 to call the appropriate host system call:
29697
29698 @itemize @bullet
29699 @item
29700 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
29701
29702 @item
29703 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
29704 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
29705 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
29706 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
29707
29708 @end itemize
29709
29710 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
29711
29712 @itemize @bullet
29713 @item
29714 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
29715 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
29716 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
29717 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
29718 packet.
29719
29720 @item
29721 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
29722 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
29723
29724 @item
29725 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
29726
29727 @item
29728 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
29729
29730 @item
29731 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
29732 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
29733 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
29734 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
29735 packet.
29736
29737 @end itemize
29738
29739 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
29740 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
29741
29742 @itemize @bullet
29743 @item
29744 Return value.
29745
29746 @item
29747 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
29748
29749 @item
29750 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
29751
29752 @end itemize
29753
29754 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
29755 the latest continue or step action.
29756
29757 @node The F Request Packet
29758 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
29759 @cindex file-i/o request packet
29760 @cindex @code{F} request packet
29761
29762 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
29763
29764 @table @samp
29765 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
29766
29767 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
29768 This is just the name of the function.
29769
29770 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
29771 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
29772 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
29773 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
29774 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
29775 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
29776 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
29777
29778 @end table
29779
29780
29781
29782 @node The F Reply Packet
29783 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
29784 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
29785 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
29786
29787 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
29788
29789 @table @samp
29790
29791 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
29792
29793 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
29794
29795 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
29796 representation.
29797 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
29798
29799 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
29800 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
29801 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
29802
29803 @smallexample
29804 F0,0,C
29805 @end smallexample
29806
29807 @noindent
29808 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
29809
29810 @smallexample
29811 F-1,4,C
29812 @end smallexample
29813
29814 @noindent
29815 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
29816
29817 @end table
29818
29819
29820 @node The Ctrl-C Message
29821 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
29822 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
29823
29824 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
29825 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
29826 the target should behave as if it had
29827 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
29828 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
29829 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
29830 packet.
29831
29832 It's important for the target to know in which
29833 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
29834
29835 @itemize @bullet
29836 @item
29837 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
29838
29839 @item
29840 The system call on the host has been finished.
29841
29842 @end itemize
29843
29844 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
29845 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
29846 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
29847 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
29848 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
29849 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
29850
29851 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
29852 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
29853 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
29854 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
29855 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
29856 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
29857 or the full action has been completed.
29858
29859 @node Console I/O
29860 @subsection Console I/O
29861 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
29862
29863 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
29864 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
29865 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
29866 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
29867 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
29868 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
29869 conditions is met:
29870
29871 @itemize @bullet
29872 @item
29873 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
29874 @code{read}
29875 system call is treated as finished.
29876
29877 @item
29878 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
29879 newline.
29880
29881 @item
29882 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
29883 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
29884
29885 @end itemize
29886
29887 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
29888 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
29889 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
29890 is stopped at the user's request.
29891
29892
29893 @node List of Supported Calls
29894 @subsection List of Supported Calls
29895 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
29896
29897 @menu
29898 * open::
29899 * close::
29900 * read::
29901 * write::
29902 * lseek::
29903 * rename::
29904 * unlink::
29905 * stat/fstat::
29906 * gettimeofday::
29907 * isatty::
29908 * system::
29909 @end menu
29910
29911 @node open
29912 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
29913 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
29914
29915 @table @asis
29916 @item Synopsis:
29917 @smallexample
29918 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
29919 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
29920 @end smallexample
29921
29922 @item Request:
29923 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
29924
29925 @noindent
29926 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
29927
29928 @table @code
29929 @item O_CREAT
29930 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
29931 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
29932 are concerned.
29933
29934 @item O_EXCL
29935 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
29936 an error and open() fails.
29937
29938 @item O_TRUNC
29939 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
29940 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
29941 truncated to zero length.
29942
29943 @item O_APPEND
29944 The file is opened in append mode.
29945
29946 @item O_RDONLY
29947 The file is opened for reading only.
29948
29949 @item O_WRONLY
29950 The file is opened for writing only.
29951
29952 @item O_RDWR
29953 The file is opened for reading and writing.
29954 @end table
29955
29956 @noindent
29957 Other bits are silently ignored.
29958
29959
29960 @noindent
29961 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
29962
29963 @table @code
29964 @item S_IRUSR
29965 User has read permission.
29966
29967 @item S_IWUSR
29968 User has write permission.
29969
29970 @item S_IRGRP
29971 Group has read permission.
29972
29973 @item S_IWGRP
29974 Group has write permission.
29975
29976 @item S_IROTH
29977 Others have read permission.
29978
29979 @item S_IWOTH
29980 Others have write permission.
29981 @end table
29982
29983 @noindent
29984 Other bits are silently ignored.
29985
29986
29987 @item Return value:
29988 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
29989 occurred.
29990
29991 @item Errors:
29992
29993 @table @code
29994 @item EEXIST
29995 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
29996
29997 @item EISDIR
29998 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
29999
30000 @item EACCES
30001 The requested access is not allowed.
30002
30003 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30004 @var{pathname} was too long.
30005
30006 @item ENOENT
30007 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
30008
30009 @item ENODEV
30010 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
30011
30012 @item EROFS
30013 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
30014 write access was requested.
30015
30016 @item EFAULT
30017 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
30018
30019 @item ENOSPC
30020 No space on device to create the file.
30021
30022 @item EMFILE
30023 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
30024
30025 @item ENFILE
30026 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
30027 has been reached.
30028
30029 @item EINTR
30030 The call was interrupted by the user.
30031 @end table
30032
30033 @end table
30034
30035 @node close
30036 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
30037 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
30038
30039 @table @asis
30040 @item Synopsis:
30041 @smallexample
30042 int close(int fd);
30043 @end smallexample
30044
30045 @item Request:
30046 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
30047
30048 @item Return value:
30049 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
30050
30051 @item Errors:
30052
30053 @table @code
30054 @item EBADF
30055 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
30056
30057 @item EINTR
30058 The call was interrupted by the user.
30059 @end table
30060
30061 @end table
30062
30063 @node read
30064 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
30065 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
30066
30067 @table @asis
30068 @item Synopsis:
30069 @smallexample
30070 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
30071 @end smallexample
30072
30073 @item Request:
30074 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
30075
30076 @item Return value:
30077 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
30078 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
30079 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
30080
30081 @item Errors:
30082
30083 @table @code
30084 @item EBADF
30085 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
30086 reading.
30087
30088 @item EFAULT
30089 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30090
30091 @item EINTR
30092 The call was interrupted by the user.
30093 @end table
30094
30095 @end table
30096
30097 @node write
30098 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
30099 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
30100
30101 @table @asis
30102 @item Synopsis:
30103 @smallexample
30104 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
30105 @end smallexample
30106
30107 @item Request:
30108 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
30109
30110 @item Return value:
30111 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
30112 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
30113 is returned.
30114
30115 @item Errors:
30116
30117 @table @code
30118 @item EBADF
30119 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
30120 writing.
30121
30122 @item EFAULT
30123 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30124
30125 @item EFBIG
30126 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
30127 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
30128
30129 @item ENOSPC
30130 No space on device to write the data.
30131
30132 @item EINTR
30133 The call was interrupted by the user.
30134 @end table
30135
30136 @end table
30137
30138 @node lseek
30139 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
30140 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
30141
30142 @table @asis
30143 @item Synopsis:
30144 @smallexample
30145 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
30146 @end smallexample
30147
30148 @item Request:
30149 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
30150
30151 @var{flag} is one of:
30152
30153 @table @code
30154 @item SEEK_SET
30155 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
30156
30157 @item SEEK_CUR
30158 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
30159 bytes.
30160
30161 @item SEEK_END
30162 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
30163 bytes.
30164 @end table
30165
30166 @item Return value:
30167 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
30168 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
30169 value of -1 is returned.
30170
30171 @item Errors:
30172
30173 @table @code
30174 @item EBADF
30175 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
30176
30177 @item ESPIPE
30178 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
30179
30180 @item EINVAL
30181 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
30182
30183 @item EINTR
30184 The call was interrupted by the user.
30185 @end table
30186
30187 @end table
30188
30189 @node rename
30190 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
30191 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
30192
30193 @table @asis
30194 @item Synopsis:
30195 @smallexample
30196 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
30197 @end smallexample
30198
30199 @item Request:
30200 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
30201
30202 @item Return value:
30203 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
30204
30205 @item Errors:
30206
30207 @table @code
30208 @item EISDIR
30209 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
30210 directory.
30211
30212 @item EEXIST
30213 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
30214
30215 @item EBUSY
30216 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
30217 process.
30218
30219 @item EINVAL
30220 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
30221 of itself.
30222
30223 @item ENOTDIR
30224 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
30225 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
30226 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
30227
30228 @item EFAULT
30229 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
30230
30231 @item EACCES
30232 No access to the file or the path of the file.
30233
30234 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30235
30236 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
30237
30238 @item ENOENT
30239 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
30240
30241 @item EROFS
30242 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
30243
30244 @item ENOSPC
30245 The device containing the file has no room for the new
30246 directory entry.
30247
30248 @item EINTR
30249 The call was interrupted by the user.
30250 @end table
30251
30252 @end table
30253
30254 @node unlink
30255 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
30256 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
30257
30258 @table @asis
30259 @item Synopsis:
30260 @smallexample
30261 int unlink(const char *pathname);
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 @item Request:
30265 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
30266
30267 @item Return value:
30268 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
30269
30270 @item Errors:
30271
30272 @table @code
30273 @item EACCES
30274 No access to the file or the path of the file.
30275
30276 @item EPERM
30277 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
30278
30279 @item EBUSY
30280 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
30281 being used by another process.
30282
30283 @item EFAULT
30284 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30285
30286 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30287 @var{pathname} was too long.
30288
30289 @item ENOENT
30290 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
30291
30292 @item ENOTDIR
30293 A component of the path is not a directory.
30294
30295 @item EROFS
30296 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
30297
30298 @item EINTR
30299 The call was interrupted by the user.
30300 @end table
30301
30302 @end table
30303
30304 @node stat/fstat
30305 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
30306 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
30307 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
30308
30309 @table @asis
30310 @item Synopsis:
30311 @smallexample
30312 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
30313 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
30314 @end smallexample
30315
30316 @item Request:
30317 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
30318 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
30319
30320 @item Return value:
30321 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
30322
30323 @item Errors:
30324
30325 @table @code
30326 @item EBADF
30327 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
30328
30329 @item ENOENT
30330 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
30331 path is an empty string.
30332
30333 @item ENOTDIR
30334 A component of the path is not a directory.
30335
30336 @item EFAULT
30337 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30338
30339 @item EACCES
30340 No access to the file or the path of the file.
30341
30342 @item ENAMETOOLONG
30343 @var{pathname} was too long.
30344
30345 @item EINTR
30346 The call was interrupted by the user.
30347 @end table
30348
30349 @end table
30350
30351 @node gettimeofday
30352 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
30353 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
30354
30355 @table @asis
30356 @item Synopsis:
30357 @smallexample
30358 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
30359 @end smallexample
30360
30361 @item Request:
30362 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
30363
30364 @item Return value:
30365 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
30366
30367 @item Errors:
30368
30369 @table @code
30370 @item EINVAL
30371 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
30372
30373 @item EFAULT
30374 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
30375 @end table
30376
30377 @end table
30378
30379 @node isatty
30380 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
30381 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
30382
30383 @table @asis
30384 @item Synopsis:
30385 @smallexample
30386 int isatty(int fd);
30387 @end smallexample
30388
30389 @item Request:
30390 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
30391
30392 @item Return value:
30393 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
30394
30395 @item Errors:
30396
30397 @table @code
30398 @item EINTR
30399 The call was interrupted by the user.
30400 @end table
30401
30402 @end table
30403
30404 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
30405 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
30406 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
30407 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
30408 needed.
30409
30410
30411 @node system
30412 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
30413 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
30414
30415 @table @asis
30416 @item Synopsis:
30417 @smallexample
30418 int system(const char *command);
30419 @end smallexample
30420
30421 @item Request:
30422 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
30423
30424 @item Return value:
30425 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
30426 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
30427 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
30428 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
30429 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
30430 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
30431 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
30432
30433 @item Errors:
30434
30435 @table @code
30436 @item EINTR
30437 The call was interrupted by the user.
30438 @end table
30439
30440 @end table
30441
30442 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
30443 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
30444 the host is simplified before it's returned
30445 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
30446 is discarded, and the return value consists
30447 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
30448
30449 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
30450 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
30451 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
30452
30453 @table @code
30454 @item set remote system-call-allowed
30455 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
30456 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
30457 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
30458
30459 @item show remote system-call-allowed
30460 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
30461 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
30462 protocol.
30463 @end table
30464
30465 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
30466 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
30467 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
30468
30469 @menu
30470 * Integral Datatypes::
30471 * Pointer Values::
30472 * Memory Transfer::
30473 * struct stat::
30474 * struct timeval::
30475 @end menu
30476
30477 @node Integral Datatypes
30478 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
30479 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
30480
30481 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
30482 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
30483 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
30484
30485 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
30486 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
30487
30488 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
30489
30490 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
30491 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
30492
30493 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
30494
30495 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
30496 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
30497 byte order.
30498
30499 @node Pointer Values
30500 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
30501 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
30502
30503 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
30504 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
30505 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
30506 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
30507
30508 @smallexample
30509 @code{1aaf/12}
30510 @end smallexample
30511
30512 @noindent
30513 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
30514 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
30515 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
30516 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
30517
30518 @smallexample
30519 @code{123456/d}
30520 @end smallexample
30521
30522 @node Memory Transfer
30523 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
30524 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
30525
30526 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
30527 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
30528 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
30529 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
30530 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
30531 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
30532 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
30533
30534
30535 @node struct stat
30536 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
30537 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
30538
30539 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
30540 is defined as follows:
30541
30542 @smallexample
30543 struct stat @{
30544 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
30545 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
30546 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
30547 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
30548 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
30549 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
30550 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
30551 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
30552 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
30553 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
30554 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
30555 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
30556 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
30557 @};
30558 @end smallexample
30559
30560 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
30561 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
30562 structure is of size 64 bytes.
30563
30564 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
30565 range of values.
30566
30567 @table @code
30568
30569 @item st_dev
30570 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
30571
30572 @item st_ino
30573 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
30574
30575 @item st_mode
30576 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
30577 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
30578
30579 @item st_uid
30580 @itemx st_gid
30581 @itemx st_rdev
30582 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
30583
30584 @item st_atime
30585 @itemx st_mtime
30586 @itemx st_ctime
30587 These values have a host and file system dependent
30588 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
30589 support exact timing values.
30590 @end table
30591
30592 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
30593 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
30594 continuing.
30595
30596 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
30597 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
30598 get truncated on the target.
30599
30600 @node struct timeval
30601 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
30602 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
30603
30604 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
30605 is defined as follows:
30606
30607 @smallexample
30608 struct timeval @{
30609 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
30610 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
30611 @};
30612 @end smallexample
30613
30614 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
30615 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
30616 structure is of size 8 bytes.
30617
30618 @node Constants
30619 @subsection Constants
30620 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
30621
30622 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
30623 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
30624 values before and after the call as needed.
30625
30626 @menu
30627 * Open Flags::
30628 * mode_t Values::
30629 * Errno Values::
30630 * Lseek Flags::
30631 * Limits::
30632 @end menu
30633
30634 @node Open Flags
30635 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
30636 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
30637
30638 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
30639
30640 @smallexample
30641 O_RDONLY 0x0
30642 O_WRONLY 0x1
30643 O_RDWR 0x2
30644 O_APPEND 0x8
30645 O_CREAT 0x200
30646 O_TRUNC 0x400
30647 O_EXCL 0x800
30648 @end smallexample
30649
30650 @node mode_t Values
30651 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
30652 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
30653
30654 All values are given in octal representation.
30655
30656 @smallexample
30657 S_IFREG 0100000
30658 S_IFDIR 040000
30659 S_IRUSR 0400
30660 S_IWUSR 0200
30661 S_IXUSR 0100
30662 S_IRGRP 040
30663 S_IWGRP 020
30664 S_IXGRP 010
30665 S_IROTH 04
30666 S_IWOTH 02
30667 S_IXOTH 01
30668 @end smallexample
30669
30670 @node Errno Values
30671 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
30672 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
30673
30674 All values are given in decimal representation.
30675
30676 @smallexample
30677 EPERM 1
30678 ENOENT 2
30679 EINTR 4
30680 EBADF 9
30681 EACCES 13
30682 EFAULT 14
30683 EBUSY 16
30684 EEXIST 17
30685 ENODEV 19
30686 ENOTDIR 20
30687 EISDIR 21
30688 EINVAL 22
30689 ENFILE 23
30690 EMFILE 24
30691 EFBIG 27
30692 ENOSPC 28
30693 ESPIPE 29
30694 EROFS 30
30695 ENAMETOOLONG 91
30696 EUNKNOWN 9999
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
30700 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
30701
30702 @node Lseek Flags
30703 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
30704 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
30705
30706 @smallexample
30707 SEEK_SET 0
30708 SEEK_CUR 1
30709 SEEK_END 2
30710 @end smallexample
30711
30712 @node Limits
30713 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
30714 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
30715
30716 All values are given in decimal representation.
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 INT_MIN -2147483648
30720 INT_MAX 2147483647
30721 UINT_MAX 4294967295
30722 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
30723 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
30724 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
30725 @end smallexample
30726
30727 @node File-I/O Examples
30728 @subsection File-I/O Examples
30729 @cindex file-i/o examples
30730
30731 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
30732 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
30733
30734 @smallexample
30735 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
30736 @emph{request memory read from target}
30737 -> @code{m1234,6}
30738 <- XXXXXX
30739 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
30740 -> @code{F6}
30741 @end smallexample
30742
30743 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
30744 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
30745
30746 @smallexample
30747 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
30748 @emph{request memory write to target}
30749 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
30750 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
30751 -> @code{F6}
30752 @end smallexample
30753
30754 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
30755 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
30759 -> @code{F-1,9}
30760 @end smallexample
30761
30762 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
30763 host is called:
30764
30765 @smallexample
30766 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
30767 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
30768 <- @code{T02}
30769 @end smallexample
30770
30771 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
30772 host is called:
30773
30774 @smallexample
30775 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
30776 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
30777 <- @code{T02}
30778 @end smallexample
30779
30780 @node Library List Format
30781 @section Library List Format
30782 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
30783
30784 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
30785 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
30786 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
30787 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
30788 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
30789 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
30790 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
30791 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
30792 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
30793 are loaded.
30794
30795 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
30796 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
30797 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
30798 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
30799
30800 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
30801 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
30802 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
30803 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
30804 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
30805 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
30806
30807 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
30808 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
30809
30810 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
30811 offset, looks like this:
30812
30813 @smallexample
30814 <library-list>
30815 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
30816 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
30817 </library>
30818 </library-list>
30819 @end smallexample
30820
30821 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
30822 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
30823
30824 @smallexample
30825 <library-list>
30826 <library name="sharedlib.o">
30827 <section address="0x10000000"/>
30828 <section address="0x20000000"/>
30829 <section address="0x30000000"/>
30830 </library>
30831 </library-list>
30832 @end smallexample
30833
30834 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
30835
30836 @smallexample
30837 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
30838 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
30839 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
30840 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
30841 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
30842 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
30843 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
30844 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
30845 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
30846 @end smallexample
30847
30848 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
30849 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
30850 section for each library.
30851
30852 @node Memory Map Format
30853 @section Memory Map Format
30854 @cindex memory map format
30855
30856 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
30857 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
30858 memory map.
30859
30860 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
30861 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
30862 lists memory regions.
30863
30864 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
30865 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
30866
30867 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
30868
30869 @smallexample
30870 <?xml version="1.0"?>
30871 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
30872 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
30873 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
30874 <memory-map>
30875 region...
30876 </memory-map>
30877 @end smallexample
30878
30879 Each region can be either:
30880
30881 @itemize
30882
30883 @item
30884 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
30885 bytes from there:
30886
30887 @smallexample
30888 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
30889 @end smallexample
30890
30891
30892 @item
30893 A region of read-only memory:
30894
30895 @smallexample
30896 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
30897 @end smallexample
30898
30899
30900 @item
30901 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
30902 bytes in length:
30903
30904 @smallexample
30905 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
30906 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
30907 </memory>
30908 @end smallexample
30909
30910 @end itemize
30911
30912 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
30913 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
30914 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
30915
30916 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
30917
30918 @smallexample
30919 <!-- ................................................... -->
30920 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
30921 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
30922 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
30923 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
30924 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
30925 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
30926 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
30927 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
30928 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
30929 and its type, or device. -->
30930 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
30931 start CDATA #REQUIRED
30932 length CDATA #REQUIRED
30933 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
30934 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
30935 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
30936 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
30937 @end smallexample
30938
30939 @include agentexpr.texi
30940
30941 @node Target Descriptions
30942 @appendix Target Descriptions
30943 @cindex target descriptions
30944
30945 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
30946 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
30947 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
30948
30949 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
30950 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
30951 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
30952 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
30953 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
30954 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
30955 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
30956
30957 @itemize @bullet
30958 @item
30959 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
30960 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
30961 @item
30962 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
30963 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
30964 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
30965 @item
30966 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
30967 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
30968 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
30969 @end itemize
30970
30971 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
30972 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
30973 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
30974 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
30975 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
30976
30977 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
30978 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
30979
30980 @menu
30981 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
30982 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
30983 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
30984 descriptions.
30985 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
30986 @end menu
30987
30988 @node Retrieving Descriptions
30989 @section Retrieving Descriptions
30990
30991 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
30992 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
30993 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
30994 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
30995 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
30996 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
30997 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
30998 Format}.
30999
31000 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
31001 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
31002 specify a file are:
31003
31004 @table @code
31005 @cindex set tdesc filename
31006 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
31007 Read the target description from @var{path}.
31008
31009 @cindex unset tdesc filename
31010 @item unset tdesc filename
31011 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
31012 will use the description supplied by the current target.
31013
31014 @cindex show tdesc filename
31015 @item show tdesc filename
31016 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
31017 @end table
31018
31019
31020 @node Target Description Format
31021 @section Target Description Format
31022 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
31023
31024 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
31025 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
31026 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
31027 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
31028 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
31029 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
31030 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
31031
31032 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
31033 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
31034 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
31035 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
31036 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
31037
31038 Here is a simple target description:
31039
31040 @smallexample
31041 <target version="1.0">
31042 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
31043 </target>
31044 @end smallexample
31045
31046 @noindent
31047 This minimal description only says that the target uses
31048 the x86-64 architecture.
31049
31050 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
31051 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
31052 are explained further below.
31053
31054 @smallexample
31055 <?xml version="1.0"?>
31056 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
31057 <target version="1.0">
31058 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
31059 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
31060 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
31061 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
31062 </target>
31063 @end smallexample
31064
31065 @noindent
31066 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
31067 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
31068 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
31069 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
31070 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
31071 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
31072 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
31073 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
31074 the version mismatch.
31075
31076 @subsection Inclusion
31077 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
31078 @cindex XInclude
31079 @ifnotinfo
31080 @cindex <xi:include>
31081 @end ifnotinfo
31082
31083 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
31084 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
31085 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
31086 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
31087 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
31088
31089 @smallexample
31090 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
31091 @end smallexample
31092
31093 @noindent
31094 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
31095 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
31096 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
31097 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
31098 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
31099 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
31100 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
31101 original description.
31102
31103 @subsection Architecture
31104 @cindex <architecture>
31105
31106 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
31107
31108 @smallexample
31109 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
31110 @end smallexample
31111
31112 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
31113 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
31114
31115 @subsection OS ABI
31116 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
31117
31118 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
31119 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
31120
31121 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
31122
31123 @smallexample
31124 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
31128 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
31129
31130 @subsection Compatible Architecture
31131 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
31132
31133 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
31134 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
31135
31136 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
31137
31138 @smallexample
31139 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
31140 @end smallexample
31141
31142 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
31143 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
31144
31145 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
31146 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
31147 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
31148 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
31149 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
31150 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
31151 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
31152
31153 @smallexample
31154 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
31155 <compatible>spu</compatible>
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 @subsection Features
31159 @cindex <feature>
31160
31161 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
31162 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
31163 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
31164 has this form:
31165
31166 @smallexample
31167 <feature name="@var{name}">
31168 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
31169 @var{reg}@dots{}
31170 </feature>
31171 @end smallexample
31172
31173 @noindent
31174 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
31175 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
31176 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
31177 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
31178
31179 @subsection Types
31180
31181 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
31182 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
31183 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
31184 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
31185 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
31186
31187 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
31188 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
31189 Types must be defined before they are used.
31190
31191 @cindex <vector>
31192 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
31193 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
31194 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
31195 @var{count}:
31196
31197 @smallexample
31198 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201 @cindex <union>
31202 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
31203 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
31204 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
31205 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 <union id="@var{id}">
31209 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
31210 @dots{}
31211 </union>
31212 @end smallexample
31213
31214 @subsection Registers
31215 @cindex <reg>
31216
31217 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 <reg name="@var{name}"
31221 bitsize="@var{size}"
31222 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
31223 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
31224 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
31225 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
31226 @end smallexample
31227
31228 @noindent
31229 The components are as follows:
31230
31231 @table @var
31232
31233 @item name
31234 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
31235
31236 @item bitsize
31237 The register's size, in bits.
31238
31239 @item regnum
31240 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
31241 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
31242 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
31243 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
31244 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
31245 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
31246 in order of increasing register number.
31247
31248 @item save-restore
31249 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
31250 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
31251 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
31252 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
31253 ABI.
31254
31255 @item type
31256 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
31257 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
31258 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
31259 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
31260 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
31261 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
31262
31263 @item group
31264 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
31265 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
31266 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
31267 in @code{info registers}.
31268
31269 @end table
31270
31271 @node Predefined Target Types
31272 @section Predefined Target Types
31273 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
31274
31275 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
31276 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
31277 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
31278 types. The currently supported types are:
31279
31280 @table @code
31281
31282 @item int8
31283 @itemx int16
31284 @itemx int32
31285 @itemx int64
31286 @itemx int128
31287 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
31288
31289 @item uint8
31290 @itemx uint16
31291 @itemx uint32
31292 @itemx uint64
31293 @itemx uint128
31294 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
31295
31296 @item code_ptr
31297 @itemx data_ptr
31298 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
31299 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
31300 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
31301 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
31302 may be marked as data pointers.
31303
31304 @item ieee_single
31305 Single precision IEEE floating point.
31306
31307 @item ieee_double
31308 Double precision IEEE floating point.
31309
31310 @item arm_fpa_ext
31311 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
31312
31313 @end table
31314
31315 @node Standard Target Features
31316 @section Standard Target Features
31317 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
31318
31319 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
31320 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
31321 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
31322 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
31323 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
31324 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
31325 can recognize them.
31326
31327 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
31328 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
31329 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
31330 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
31331 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
31332 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
31333 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
31334 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
31335
31336 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
31337 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
31338 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
31339
31340 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
31341 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
31342 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
31343 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
31344
31345 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
31346 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
31347 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
31348
31349 @menu
31350 * ARM Features::
31351 * MIPS Features::
31352 * M68K Features::
31353 * PowerPC Features::
31354 @end menu
31355
31356
31357 @node ARM Features
31358 @subsection ARM Features
31359 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
31360
31361 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
31362 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
31363 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
31364
31365 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
31366 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
31367
31368 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
31369 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
31370 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
31371 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
31372
31373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
31374 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
31375 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
31376 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
31377 halves of the double-precision registers.
31378
31379 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
31380 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
31381 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
31382 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
31383 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
31384 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
31385
31386 @node MIPS Features
31387 @subsection MIPS Features
31388 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
31389
31390 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
31391 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
31392 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
31393 on the target.
31394
31395 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
31396 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
31397 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
31398
31399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
31400 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
31401 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
31402 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
31403
31404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
31405 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
31406 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
31407
31408 @node M68K Features
31409 @subsection M68K Features
31410 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
31411
31412 @table @code
31413 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
31414 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
31415 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
31416 One of those features must be always present.
31417 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
31418 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
31419 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
31420 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
31421
31422 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
31423 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
31424 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
31425 @samp{fpiaddr}.
31426 @end table
31427
31428 @node PowerPC Features
31429 @subsection PowerPC Features
31430 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
31431
31432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
31433 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
31434 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
31435 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
31436
31437 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
31438 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
31439
31440 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
31441 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
31442 and @samp{vrsave}.
31443
31444 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
31445 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
31446 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
31447 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
31448 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
31449 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
31450
31451 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
31452 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
31453 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
31454 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
31455 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
31456 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
31457 user.
31458
31459 @node Operating System Information
31460 @appendix Operating System Information
31461 @cindex operating system information
31462
31463 @menu
31464 * Process list::
31465 @end menu
31466
31467 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
31468 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
31469 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
31470 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
31471 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
31472 on a different aspect of target.
31473
31474 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
31475 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
31476 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
31477 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
31478
31479 @node Process list
31480 @appendixsection Process list
31481 @cindex operating system information, process list
31482
31483 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
31484 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
31485 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
31486 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
31487
31488 An example document is:
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 <?xml version="1.0"?>
31492 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
31493 <osdata type="processes">
31494 <item>
31495 <column name="pid">1</column>
31496 <column name="user">root</column>
31497 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
31498 </item>
31499 </osdata>
31500 @end smallexample
31501
31502 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
31503 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
31504 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
31505 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
31506 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
31507
31508 @include gpl.texi
31509
31510 @raisesections
31511 @include fdl.texi
31512 @lowersections
31513
31514 @node Index
31515 @unnumbered Index
31516
31517 @printindex cp
31518
31519 @tex
31520 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
31521 % meantime:
31522 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
31523 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
31524 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
31525 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
31526 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
31527 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
31528 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
31529 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
31530 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
31531 \page\colophon
31532 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
31533 @end tex
31534
31535 @bye